Docs: Adjust on TLSA, dnssec_request_domains
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2018
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
379
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387 very wide interest.
388
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405 information.
406
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409 .cindex "change log"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427 directory are:
428
429 .table2 100pt
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
438 .endtable
439
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
443
444
445
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
447 .cindex "website"
448 .cindex "FTP site"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
452
453 .cindex "wiki"
454 .cindex "FAQ"
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
462
463 .cindex Bugzilla
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
468
469
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474 .table2 140pt
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
479 .endtable
480
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486 via this web page:
487 .display
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489 .endd
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
491 lists.
492
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
500
501
502
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
504 .cindex "FTP site"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
509 .display
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
511 .endd
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
514
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
518
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
523
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 .endd
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
540
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
557
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
559 .display
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563 .endd
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572 .display
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 .endd
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
580
581
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583 .ilist
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591 .next
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598 arrival.
599 .next
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608 .next
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612 other means.
613 .next
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
619 .endlist
620
621
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
656
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
665
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669 otherwise.
670
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674 until a later time.
675
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695 line.
696
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712 message's envelope.
713
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744 .cindex "PCRE"
745 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
747
748 .ilist
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755 .next
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
762
763 .blockquote
764 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769 version.
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
775 .endblockquote
776 .next
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783 under the Gnu GPL.
784 .next
785 .cindex "Cyrus"
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
792
793 .blockquote
794 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798 are met:
799
800 .olist
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803 .next
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
807 distribution.
808 .next
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
813 .display
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
816 5000 Forbes Avenue
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
820 .endd
821 .next
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
823 acknowledgment:
824
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
835 .endlist
836 .endblockquote
837
838 .next
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
840 .cindex "X-windows"
841 .cindex "Athena"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
846
847 .blockquote
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850
851 All Rights Reserved
852
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
860
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
867 SOFTWARE.
868 .endblockquote
869
870 .next
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876 source code.
877
878 .next
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882 .endlist
883
884
885
886
887
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
893
894
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
903
904
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
912
913 .ilist
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
923 error code.
924 .next
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927 .next
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932 .next
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938 .next
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942 .next
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
946 .endlist
947
948
949
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
959
960 .ilist
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
962 by RFC 3028.
963 .next
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
966 .endlist
967
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969
970
971
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
976 .cindex "base62"
977 .cindex "base36"
978 .cindex "Darwin"
979 .cindex "Cygwin"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
988
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
995 somewhat eccentric:
996
997 .ilist
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1002 .next
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1005 .next
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007 .olist
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013 .next
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1017 .endlist
1018 .endlist
1019
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025
1026
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1034
1035 .ilist
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039 .next
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046 .next
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052 .next
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1057 .endlist
1058
1059
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1073
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1112
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1131
1132
1133
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1149 to be sent.
1150
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1156
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1167 systems.
1168
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1185
1186
1187
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1207
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1212 to be bounced.
1213
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1231 configuration.
1232
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1242
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1256
1257
1258
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1267
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1288 the following:
1289
1290 .ilist
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1299 end of routing.
1300
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306 .next
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312 .next
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318 .next
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322 .next
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327 .next
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1330 .endlist
1331
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1343
1344
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1354
1355
1356
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1363
1364 .ilist
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .next
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 .vindex "&$home$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1419 .next
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1425 .next
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 .next
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1431 .next
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436 .endlist
1437
1438
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453 .ilist
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 filtering'&.
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469 filter.
1470 .next
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .next
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 .next
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1495 .next
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .next
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 .next
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1527 .next
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531 &'deferred'&.
1532 .next
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536 .endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560 as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573 also apply.
1574
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 deferred,
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584 one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603 automatically.
1604
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612 of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640 .table2 140pt
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649 .endtable
1650
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654 .table2 140pt
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662 .endtable
1663
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 system.
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729 possibilities:
1730
1731 .olist
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734 .next
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1740 .next
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745 .next
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749 .next
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1760 .next
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1765 .endlist
1766
1767 .cindex "USE_DB"
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1773 .code
1774 USE_DB=yes
1775 .endd
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1778
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1785
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1789 .code
1790 DBMLIB = -ldb
1791 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1792 .endd
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1797 this example:
1798 .code
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1801 .endd
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1804
1805
1806
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1819
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1826
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1833 be logged.
1834
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1839 .code
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1841 .endd
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1844
1845
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1853
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859 do this.
1860
1861
1862
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1865 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1873
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1879 .code
1880 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1881 .endd
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1883
1884
1885
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1896 line option).
1897
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1900 implementing SSL.
1901
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1903 .code
1904 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1906 .endd
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1909 .code
1910 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1913 .endd
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1916 .code
1917 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1926 .endd
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1934 .endd
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1937 .code
1938 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1939 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1941 .endd
1942
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1951
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1964 you might have
1965 .code
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1969 .endd
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1972 .code
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1974 .endd
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1981 further details.
1982
1983
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1990 library files.
1991
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1997 Exim used to
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1999 withdrawn.
2000
2001
2002
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2009 on demand.
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2012 dependencies.
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2014
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2021
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025 on demand:
2026 .code
2027 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2028 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2029 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2030 .endd
2031
2032
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2042
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2051
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2055
2056
2057
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2065 .code
2066 FULLECHO='' make -e
2067 .endd
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2071
2072
2073
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2081 order:
2082 .display
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2085 &_Local/Makefile_&
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2090 .endd
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2098
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2108
2109
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2114 default values are.
2115
2116
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2130 .code
2131 CC=cc
2132 CFLAGS=-std1
2133 .endd
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2136
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2140
2141
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152 .code
2153 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2154 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2155 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2156 .endd
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2165 errors.
2166
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2178 .code
2179 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2181 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2185 .endd
2186
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2190 .code
2191 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2192 .endd
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2195
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2202 .code
2203 X11=/usr/X11R6
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2206 .endd
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2209 .code
2210 X11=/usr/openwin
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2213 .endd
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2217
2218 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2223
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2229 libraries.
2230
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2236
2237
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2239 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2246
2247
2248
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2253 .display
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2260 .endd
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2268 .ecindex IIDbuex
2269
2270
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2285
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2293
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2302
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2308
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2314 over SMTP.
2315
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2318 command such as
2319 .code
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2321 .endd
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2334
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2342
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2349 .endd
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2354 command:
2355 .code
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2357 .endd
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2360
2361 .ilist
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2364 .next
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2366 installed binary.
2367 .endlist
2368
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2370 .code
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2372 .endd
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2376 .code
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2378 .endd
2379
2380
2381
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2387 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2388
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2392
2393
2394
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400 necessary.
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2410 .code
2411 exim -bV
2412 .endd
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2418 example,
2419 .display
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2421 .endd
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2423 .display
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2425 .endd
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2429 .code
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2434
2435 This is a test message.
2436 ^D
2437 .endd
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2441
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2448 .display
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2450 .endd
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2456
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2471
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2477 incoming SMTP mail.
2478
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2483 production version.
2484
2485
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2499
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2506 as follows:
2507 .code
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2512 .endd
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2516
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2523
2524
2525
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2532 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2533 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2534 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2535 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2536 configuration file.
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2542 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2543 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2544 .code
2545 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2546 .endd
2547 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2548 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2549 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2550 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2551 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2552 .code
2553 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2554 .endd
2555 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2556
2557 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2558 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2559 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2566
2567 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2568 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2569 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2570 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2571 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2572 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2573 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2574 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2575 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576
2577
2578 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2579 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2580 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2581 were present before any other options.
2582 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2583 standard output.
2584 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2585 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2586 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2590 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2591 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2592 format.
2593
2594 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2595 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2596 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2597 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598
2599 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2600 .cindex "queue runner"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2602 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2603 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2604
2605 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2606 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2607 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2608 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2609 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2610 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2611 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2612 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613
2614
2615 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2616 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2617 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2618 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2619 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2620 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621
2622 .ilist
2623 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2624 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2625 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2626 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2627 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2628 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2629
2630 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2631 .cindex "envelope from"
2632 .cindex "envelope sender"
2633 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2634 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2635 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2636 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2637 users to set envelope senders.
2638
2639 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2640 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2641 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2642 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2643 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2644 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2645 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2646
2647 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2648 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2649 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2650 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2651 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2652 that are available to trusted users.
2653 .next
2654 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2655 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2656 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2657 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2658 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2659
2660 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2661 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2662 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2663 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2664
2665 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2666 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2667 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2668 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2669
2670 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2671 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2672 false.
2673 .endlist
2674
2675
2676 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2677 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2678 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2679 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2685 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2686 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2687 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2688 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2689 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2690 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2691 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2692
2693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2694 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2695 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2696 . creates a man page for the options.
2697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698
2699 .literal xml
2700 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2701 .literal off
2702
2703
2704 .vlist
2705 .vitem &%--%&
2706 .oindex "--"
2707 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2708 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2709 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2710 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2711
2712 .vitem &%--help%&
2713 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2714 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2715 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2716 no arguments.
2717
2718 .vitem &%--version%&
2719 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2720 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2721 displayed.
2722
2723 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2724 &%-Am%&
2725 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2726 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2727 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2728 ignored by Exim.
2729
2730 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2731 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2732 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2733 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2734 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2735 clean; it ignores this option.
2736
2737 .vitem &%-bd%&
2738 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2739 .cindex "daemon"
2740 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2741 .cindex "queue runner"
2742 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2743 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2744 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2745
2746 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2747 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2748 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2749 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2750
2751 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2752 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2753 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2754 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2755
2756 When a listening daemon
2757 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2758 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2759 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2760 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2761 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2762 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2763 running as root.
2764
2765 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2766 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2767 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2768
2769 The SIGHUP signal
2770 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2771 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2772 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2773 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2774 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2775 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2776 .cindex reload configuration
2777 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2778 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2779 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2780 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2781 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2782 because these are reread each time they are used.
2783
2784 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2785 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2786 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2787 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2788
2789 .vitem &%-be%&
2790 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2791 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2792 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2793 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2794 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2795 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2796 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2797
2798 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2799 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2800 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2801 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2802 test data. A line history is supported.
2803
2804 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2805 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2806 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2807 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2808 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2809 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2810 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2811
2812 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2813 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2814 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2815 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2816
2817 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2818 defined and macros will be expanded.
2819 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2820 available to admin users.
2821
2822 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2823 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2824 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2825 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2826 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2827 of a file. For example:
2828 .code
2829 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2830 .endd
2831 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2832 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2833 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2834 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2835 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2836 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2837 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2838 &%-be%&).
2839
2840 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2841 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2842 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2843 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2844 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2845 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2846 system filters are recognized.
2847
2848 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2849 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2850 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2851 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2852 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2853 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2854 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2855 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2856 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2857 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2858 supplied.
2859
2860 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2861 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2862 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2863 .code
2864 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2865 .endd
2866 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2867 variables that are used by the user filter.
2868
2869 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2870 .code
2871 # Exim filter
2872 # Sieve filter
2873 .endd
2874 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2875 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2876 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2877 redirection lists.
2878
2879 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2880 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2881 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2882 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2883
2884 When testing a filter file,
2885 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2886 .cindex "envelope from"
2887 .cindex "envelope sender"
2888 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2889 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2890 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2891 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2892 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2893 options).
2894
2895 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2896 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2897 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2898 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2899 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2900 &$qualify_domain$&.
2901
2902 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2903 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2904 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2905 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2906 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2907 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2908 actually being delivered.
2909
2910 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2911 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2912 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2913 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2915 prefix.
2916
2917 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2918 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2919 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2920 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2921 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2922 suffix.
2923
2924 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2925 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2926 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2927 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2928 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2929 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2930 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2931 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2932 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2933 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2934 after a full stop. For example:
2935 .code
2936 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2937 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2938 .endd
2939 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2940 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2941 conversion to the canonical form is
2942 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2943
2944 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2945 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2946 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2947 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2948 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2949
2950 &*Warning 1*&:
2951 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2952 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2953 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2954 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2955 connection.
2956
2957 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2958 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2959 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2960
2961 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2962 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2963 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2964 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2965 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2966 session were authenticated.
2967
2968 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2969 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2970 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2971
2972 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2973 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2974 specialized SMTP test program such as
2975 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2976
2977 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2978 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2979 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2980 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2981 updating the callout cache database.
2982
2983 .vitem &%-bi%&
2984 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2985 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2986 .cindex "building alias file"
2987 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2988 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2989 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2990 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2991 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2992 recognized.
2993
2994 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2995 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2996 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2997 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2998 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2999 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3000 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
3001
3002 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3003 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3005 .cindex "querying exim information"
3006 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3007 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3008 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3009 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3010 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3011
3012 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3013 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3014 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3015 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3016 recognised DSCP names.
3017
3018 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3019 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3020 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3021 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3022 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3023 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3024 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3025 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3026 way to guarantee a correct response.
3027
3028 .vitem &%-bm%&
3029 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3030 .cindex "local message reception"
3031 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3032 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3033 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3034 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3035 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3036 if no other conflicting option is present.
3037
3038 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3039 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3040 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3041 suppressing this for special cases.
3042
3043 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3044 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3045
3046 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3047 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3048 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3049
3050 The format
3051 .cindex "message" "format"
3052 .cindex "format" "message"
3053 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3054 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3055 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3056 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3057 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3058 .code
3059 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3060 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3061 .endd
3062 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3063 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3064 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3065 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3066 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3067
3068 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3069 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3070 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3071 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3072 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3073
3074 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3075 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3076 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3077 .cindex "malware scan test"
3078 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3079 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3080 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3081 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3082 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3083 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3084 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3085
3086 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3087 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3088 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3089 This option requires admin privileges.
3090
3091 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3092 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3093 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3094
3095 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3096 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3097 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3098 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3099 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3100 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3101 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3102 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3103 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3104
3105 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3106 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3107 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3108 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3109 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3110
3111 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3112 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3113 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3114 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3115
3116
3117 .vitem &%-bP%&
3118 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3119 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3120 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3121 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3122 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3123 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3124 arguments, for example:
3125 .code
3126 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3127 .endd
3128 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3129 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3130 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3131 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3132 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3133 users, the output is as in this example:
3134 .code
3135 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3136 .endd
3137 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3138 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3139
3140 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3141 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3142 backward compatibility.)
3143 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3144 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3145
3146 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3147 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3148 name will not be output.
3149
3150 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3151 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3152 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3153 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3154 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3155 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3156 written directly into the spool directory.
3157
3158 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3159 .code
3160 exim -bP +local_domains
3161 .endd
3162 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3163 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3164
3165 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3166 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3167 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3168 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3169 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3170 that driver are output. For example:
3171 .code
3172 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3173 .endd
3174 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3175 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3176 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3177 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3178 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3179 &%authenticators%&.
3180
3181 .cindex "environment"
3182 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3183 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3184 variables.
3185
3186 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3187 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3188 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3189 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3190 The output format is one item per line.
3191 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3192 the exit status will be nonzero.
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bp%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3196 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3197 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3198 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3199 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3200 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3201 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3202 to allow any user to see the queue.
3203
3204 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3205 .code
3206 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3207 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3208 <other addresses>
3209 .endd
3210 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3211 .cindex "size" "of message"
3212 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3213 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3214 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3215 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3216 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3217 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3218 before the sender address.
3219
3220 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3221 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3222 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3223
3224 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3225 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3226 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3227 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3228 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3229 complete.
3230
3231
3232 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3233 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3234 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3235 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3236 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3237 of just &"D"&.
3238
3239
3240 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3241 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3242 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3243 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3244 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3245 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3246
3247
3248 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3249 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3250 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3251 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3252 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3253 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3254
3255 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3256 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3257 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3258
3259 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3260 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3261 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3262
3263
3264 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3265 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3266 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3267 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3268 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3269 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3270
3271
3272 .vitem &%-brt%&
3273 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3274 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3275 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3276 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3277 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3278 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3279 .code
3280 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3281 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3282 .endd
3283 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3284 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3285 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3286 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3287 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3288 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3289 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3290 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3291 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3292 .code
3293 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3294 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3295 .endd
3296
3297 .vitem &%-brw%&
3298 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3299 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3300 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3301 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3302 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3303 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3304 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3305 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3306
3307 .vitem &%-bS%&
3308 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3309 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3310 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3311 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3312 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3313 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3314 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3315 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3316 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3317 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3318
3319 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3320 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3321 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3322
3323 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3324 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3325 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3326 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3327
3328 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3329 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3330 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3331
3332 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3333 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3334 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3335 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3336 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3337
3338 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3339 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3340
3341 .vitem &%-bs%&
3342 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3343 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3344 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3345 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3346 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3347 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3348 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3349 messages to the MTA.
3350
3351 In
3352 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3353 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3354 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3355 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3356 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3357 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3358 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3359
3360 .cindex "inetd"
3361 The
3362 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3363 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3364 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3365 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3366 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3367 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3368 the listening daemon.
3369
3370 .vitem &%-bt%&
3371 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3372 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3373 .cindex "address" "testing"
3374 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3375 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3376 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3377 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3378 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3379
3380 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3381 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3382
3383 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3384 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3385 security issues.
3386
3387 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3388 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3389 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3390 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3391 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3392 program.
3393
3394 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3395 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3396 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3397 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3398
3399 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3400 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3401 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3402 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3403 always shown.
3404
3405 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3406 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3407 message,
3408 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3409 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3410 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3411 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3412 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3413 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3414 doing such tests.
3415
3416 .vitem &%-bV%&
3417 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3418 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3419 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3420 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3421 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3422 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3423 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3424
3425 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3426 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3427 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3428 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3429 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3430 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3431 dynamic testing facilities.
3432
3433 .vitem &%-bv%&
3434 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3435 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3436 .cindex "address" "verification"
3437 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3438 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3439 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3440 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3441 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3442 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3443
3444 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3445 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3446 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3447
3448 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3449 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3450
3451 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3452 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3453 security issues.
3454
3455 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3456 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3457 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3458 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3459 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3460
3461 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3462 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3463 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3464 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3465 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3466 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3467 to succeed.
3468
3469 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3470 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3471 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3472
3473 The
3474 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3475 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3476 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3477 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3478
3479 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3480 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3481 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3482 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3483
3484 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3485 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3486 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3487 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3488 might happen.
3489
3490 .vitem &%-bw%&
3491 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3492 .cindex "daemon"
3493 .cindex "inetd"
3494 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3495 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3496 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3497 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3498
3499 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3500 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3501 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3502 each port only when the first connection is received.
3503
3504 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3505 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3506
3507 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3508 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3509 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3510 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3511 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3512 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3513 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3514 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3515 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3516 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3517 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3518
3519 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3520 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3521 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3522 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3523 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3524 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3525 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3526 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3527 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3528
3529 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3530 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3531 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3532 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3533 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3534 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3535 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3536
3537 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3538 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3539 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3540 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3541 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3542 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3543 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3544
3545 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3546 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3547 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3548 configuration file.
3549
3550 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3551 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3552 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3553 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3554 specified by this option.
3555
3556
3557 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3558 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3559 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3560 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3561 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3562 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3563 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3564 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3565
3566 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3567 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3568 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3569 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3570 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3571 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3572 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3573
3574 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3575 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3576 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3577 synonymous:
3578 .code
3579 exim -DABC ...
3580 exim -DABC= ...
3581 .endd
3582 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3583 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3584 example:
3585 .code
3586 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3587 .endd
3588 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3589 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3590
3591
3592 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3593 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3594 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3595 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3596 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3597 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3598 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3599 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3600 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3601 return code.
3602
3603 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3604 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3605 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3606 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3607 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3608 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3609 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3610 are:
3611 .display
3612 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3613 &`auth `& authenticators
3614 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3615 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3616 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3617 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3618 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3619 &`filter `& filter handling
3620 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3621 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3622 &`ident `& ident lookup
3623 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3624 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3625 &`load `& system load checks
3626 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3627 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3628 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3629 &`memory `& memory handling
3630 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3631 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3632 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3633 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3634 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3635 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3636 &`retry `& retry handling
3637 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3638 &`route `& address routing
3639 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3640 &`tls `& TLS logic
3641 &`transport `& transports
3642 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3643 &`verify `& address verification logic
3644 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3645 .endd
3646 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3647 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3648 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3649 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3650 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3651 turn everything off.
3652
3653 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3654 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3655 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3656 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3657 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3658 rather than stderr.
3659
3660 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3661 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3662 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3663 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3664 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3665 run in parallel.
3666
3667 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3668 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3669 in processing.
3670
3671 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3672 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3673 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3674 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3675 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3676 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3677
3678 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3679 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3680
3681 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3682 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3683 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3684 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3685 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3686 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3687
3688 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3689 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3690 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3691 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3692 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3693
3694 .vitem &%-E%&
3695 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3696 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3697 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3698 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3699 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3700 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3701 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3702 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3703 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3704
3705 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3706 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3707 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3708 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3709 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3710 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3711
3712 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3713 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3714 .cindex "sender" "name"
3715 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3716 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3717 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3718 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3719 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3720 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3723 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3724 .cindex "sender" "address"
3725 .cindex "address" "sender"
3726 .cindex "trusted users"
3727 .cindex "envelope from"
3728 .cindex "envelope sender"
3729 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3730 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3731 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3732 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3733 users to use it.
3734
3735 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3736 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3737 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3738 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3739 domain.
3740
3741 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3742 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3743 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3744 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3745 examples of shell commands:
3746 .code
3747 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3748 exim -f "" user@domain
3749 .endd
3750 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3751 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3752 &%-bv%& options.
3753
3754 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3755 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3756 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3757 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3758
3759 White
3760 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3761 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3762 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3763 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3764 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3765 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3766
3767 .vitem &%-G%&
3768 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3769 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3770 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3771 .code
3772 control = suppress_local_fixups
3773 .endd
3774 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3775 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3776 in future.
3777
3778 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3779 this option.
3780
3781 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3782 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3783 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3784 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3785 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3786 headers.)
3787
3788 .vitem &%-i%&
3789 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3790 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3791 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3792 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3793 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3794 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3795 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3796
3797 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3798 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3799 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3800 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3801 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3802 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3803 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3804 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3805
3806 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3809 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3810 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3811 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3812 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3813 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3814 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3815 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3816 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3817
3818 Retry
3819 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3820 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3821 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3822 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3823 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3824 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3825
3826 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3827 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3828 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3829 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3830
3831 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3832 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3833 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3834 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3835 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3836 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3837 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3838 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3839 can be used only by an admin user.
3840
3841 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3842 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3843 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3844 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3845 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3846 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3847 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3849 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3850 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3851 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3852
3853 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3854 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3857 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3860 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3863 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3864
3865 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3866 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3867 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3868 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3869 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3870
3871 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3872 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3873 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3874 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3875 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3876
3877 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3878 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3879 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3880 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3881 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3882
3883 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3884 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3885 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3886 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3887 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3888 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3889 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3890 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3891
3892 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3893 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3894 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3895 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3896 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3897 connection.
3898
3899 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3900 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3901 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3902 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3903 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3904
3905 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3906 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3907 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3908 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3909 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3910 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3911
3912 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3914 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3915 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3916 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3917 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3918 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3919 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3920 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3921 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3922 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3923 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3924 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3925 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3926 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3927
3928 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3929 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3930 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3931 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3932 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3933 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3934 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3935 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3936 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3937 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3938
3939 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3940 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3941 .cindex "freezing messages"
3942 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3943 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3944 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3945 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3946 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3947 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3948 user.
3949
3950 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3952 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3953 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3954 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3955 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3956 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3957 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3958 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3959 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3960 user.
3961
3962 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3963 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3964 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3965 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3966 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3967 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3968 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969
3970 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3971 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3972 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3973 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3974 .cindex "removing recipients"
3975 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3976 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3977 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3978 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3979 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3980 can be used only by an admin user.
3981
3982 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3983 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3984 .cindex "removing messages"
3985 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3986 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3987 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3988 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3989 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3990 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3991 placed in the queue.
3992
3993 . .new
3994 . .vitem &%-MS%&
3995 . .oindex "&%-MS%&"
3996 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3997 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3998 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3999 . a bounce message.
4000 . .wen
4001
4002 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4003 .oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4004 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4005 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4006 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4007 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4008 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4009 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4010 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4011 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4012 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4013
4014 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4015 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4016 .cindex "thawing messages"
4017 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4018 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4019 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4020 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4021 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4022 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4023 by an admin user.
4024
4025 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4026 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4027 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4028 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4029 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4030 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4031
4032 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4033 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4034 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4035 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4036 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4037 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4038 only by an admin user.
4039
4040 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4041 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4042 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4043 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4044 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4045 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4046 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4050 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4051 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4052 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4053 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4054
4055 .vitem &%-m%&
4056 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4057 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4058 treats it that way too.
4059
4060 .vitem &%-N%&
4061 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4062 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4063 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4064 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4065 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4066 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4067 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4068 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4069 than &"=>"&.
4070
4071 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4072 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4073 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4074 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4075 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4076 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4077 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4078 for that message.
4079
4080 .vitem &%-n%&
4081 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4082 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4083 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4084 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4085 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4086
4087 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4088 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4089 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4090 Exim.
4091
4092 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4093 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4094 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4095 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4096 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4097 description above.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4100 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4102 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4103 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4104 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4105 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4106 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-odb%&
4109 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4110 .cindex "background delivery"
4111 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4112 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4113 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4114 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4115 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4116 processes to finish.
4117
4118 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4119 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4120 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4121 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4122
4123 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4124 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4125 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4126 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4127
4128 .vitem &%-odf%&
4129 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4130 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4131 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4132 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4133 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4134 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4135 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4136
4137 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4138 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4139 during deliveries.
4140
4141 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4142 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4143
4144 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4145 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4146 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4147 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4148
4149
4150 .vitem &%-odi%&
4151 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4152 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4153 Sendmail.
4154
4155 .vitem &%-odq%&
4156 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4157 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4158 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4159 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4160 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4161 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4162 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4163 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4164 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4165 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4166 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4167 forces queueing.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4170 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4171 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4172 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4173 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4174 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4175 configuration file is in effect.
4176
4177 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4178 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4179 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4180 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4181 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4182 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4183 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4184 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4185 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4186 &%-qq%& option.
4187
4188 .vitem &%-oee%&
4189 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4190 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4191 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4192 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4193 message.
4194
4195 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4196 Provided
4197 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4198 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4199 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4200 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4201
4202 .vitem &%-oem%&
4203 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4204 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4205 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4206 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4207 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4208 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4209
4210 .vitem &%-oep%&
4211 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4212 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4213 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4214 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4215 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4216 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4217
4218 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4219 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4220 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4221 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4222 effect as &%-oep%&.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oew%&
4225 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4226 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4227 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4228 effect as &%-oem%&.
4229
4230 .vitem &%-oi%&
4231 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4232 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4233 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4234 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4235 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4236 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4237 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4238
4239 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4240 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4241 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4242
4243 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4244 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4245 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4246 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4247 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4248 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4249 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4250 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4251
4252 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4253 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4254 .code
4255 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4256 .endd
4257 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4258 followed by a colon and the port number:
4259 .code
4260 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4261 .endd
4262 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4263 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4264 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4265 whichever one is last.
4266
4267 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4268 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4269 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4270 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4271 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4272 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4273 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4274 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4278 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4279 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4280 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4281 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4282 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4283 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4284
4285 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4286 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4287 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4288 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4289 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4290 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4291 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4292 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4293 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4294 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4295
4296 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4297 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4298 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4299 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4300 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4301 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4302 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4303
4304 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4305 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4306 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4307 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4308 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4309 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4310 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4311 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4312 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4313
4314 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4315 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4316 is sending the bounce.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4320 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4321 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4322 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4323 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4324 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4325 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4326 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4327 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4328 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4329 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4330
4331 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4332 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4333 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4334 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4335 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4336 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4337 uses the name it is given.
4338
4339 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4340 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4341 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4342 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4343 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4344 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4345 used, when there is no default.
4346
4347 .vitem &%-om%&
4348 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4349 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4350 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4351 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4352 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4353
4354 .vitem &%-oo%&
4355 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4356 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4357 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4358 whatever that means.
4359
4360 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4361 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4362 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4363 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4364 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4365 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4366 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4367 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4368 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4369
4370 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4371 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4372 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4373 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4374 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4375 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4376 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4377
4378 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4379 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4380 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4381 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4382 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4383 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4384 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4385 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4386
4387 .vitem &%-ov%&
4388 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4389 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4390
4391 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4392 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4393 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4394 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4395 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4396 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4397 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4398 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4399 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4400 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-pd%&
4403 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4404 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4405 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4406 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4407 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4408 needed.
4409
4410 .vitem &%-ps%&
4411 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4412 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4413 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4414 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4415 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4416 started.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4419 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4420 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4421 .display
4422 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4423 .endd
4424 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4425 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4426 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4427 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4428 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4429 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4430
4431 .vitem &%-q%&
4432 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4433 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4434 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4435 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4436 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4437 and &%-S%& options).
4438
4439 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4440 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4441 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4442 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4443 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4444 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4445 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4446
4447 If
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4452 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4453 proceeding.
4454
4455 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4456 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4457 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4458 this to be repeated periodically.
4459
4460 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4461 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4462 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4463 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4464
4465 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4466 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4467 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4468
4469 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4470 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4471 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4472 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4473
4474 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4475 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4476 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4477 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4478 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4479 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4480 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4481 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4482 transports are run.
4483
4484 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4485 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4486 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4487 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4488 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4489 delivered down a single SMTP
4490 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4491 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4492 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4493 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4494 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4495 intermittently.
4496
4497 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4498 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4499 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4500 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4501 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4502 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4503 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4504
4505 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4506 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4507 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4508 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4509 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4510 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4511 their retry times are tried.
4512
4513 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4514 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4515 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4516 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4517 frozen or not.
4518
4519 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4520 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4521 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4522 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4523 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4524 for later delivery.
4525
4526 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4527 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4528 .cindex queue named
4529 .cindex "named queues"
4530 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4531 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4532 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4533 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4534 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4535 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4536
4537 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4538 will specify a queue to operate on.
4539 For example:
4540 .code
4541 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4542 mailq -qGquarantine
4543 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4544 .endd
4545
4546 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4547 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4548 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4549 starting message id. For example:
4550 .code
4551 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4552 .endd
4553 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4554 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4555 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4556 .code
4557 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4558 .endd
4559 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4560 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4561 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4562 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4563 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4564 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4565
4566 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4567 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4568 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4569 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4570 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4571 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4572 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4573 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4574 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4575 .code
4576 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4577 .endd
4578 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4579 process every 30 minutes.
4580
4581 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4582 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4583
4584 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4585 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4586 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4587 compatibility.
4588
4589 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4590 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4591 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4592
4593 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4594 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4595 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4596 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4597 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4598 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4599 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4600 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4601 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4602
4603 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4604 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4605 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4606 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4607 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4608 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4609
4610 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4611 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4612 .code
4613 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4614 .endd
4615 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4616 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4617 applied to each queue run.
4618
4619 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4620 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4621 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4622 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4623 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4624 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4625 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4626 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4627 address will be skipped.
4628
4629 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4630 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4631 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4632 &'ff'& is present.
4633
4634 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4635 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4636 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4637 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4638 an arbitrary command instead.
4639
4640 .vitem &%-r%&
4641 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4642 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4643
4644 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4645 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4646 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4647 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4648 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4649 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4650 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4651 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4652
4653 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4654 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4655 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4656 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4657 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4658
4659 .vitem &%-t%&
4660 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4661 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4662 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4663 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4664 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4665 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4666 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4667 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4668 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4669 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4670
4671 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4672 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4673 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4674 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4675 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4676 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4677 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4678 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4679 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4680 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4681 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4682
4683 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4684 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4685 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4686 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4687 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4688 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4689
4690 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4691 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4692 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4693 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4694 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4695 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4696 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4697 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4698 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4699
4700 .vitem &%-ti%&
4701 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4702 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4703 compatibility with Sendmail.
4704
4705 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4706 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4707 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4708 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4709 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4710 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4711 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4712 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4713
4714
4715 .vitem &%-U%&
4716 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4717 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4718 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4719 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4720 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4721 set. Exim ignores this option.
4722
4723 .vitem &%-v%&
4724 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4725 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4726 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4727 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4728 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4729 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4730 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4731 unconditional.
4732
4733 .vitem &%-x%&
4734 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4735 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4736 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4737 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4738 this option.
4739
4740 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4741 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4742 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4743 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4744
4745 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4746 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4747 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4748 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4749 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4750 under most shells.
4751 .endlist
4752
4753 .ecindex IIDclo1
4754 .ecindex IIDclo2
4755
4756
4757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4758 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4759 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4760 . creates a man page for the options.
4761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4762
4763 .literal xml
4764 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4765 .literal off
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4773
4774
4775 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4776 "The runtime configuration file"
4777
4778 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4779 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4780 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4781 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4782 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4783 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4784 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4785 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4786 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4787 control.
4788
4789 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4790 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4791 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4792 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4793 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4794 actually alter the string.
4795
4796 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4797 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4798 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4799 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4800 existing file in the list.
4801
4802 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4803 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4804 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4805 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4806 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4807 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4808 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4809 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4810 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4811 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4812 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4813
4814 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4815 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4816 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4817 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4818 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4819
4820 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4821 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4822 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4823 compromise the Exim user account.
4824
4825 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4826 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4827 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4828 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4829 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4830 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4831 configuration.
4832
4833
4834
4835 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4836 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4837 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4838 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4839 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4840 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4841 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4842 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4843 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4844 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4845 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4846
4847 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4848 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4849 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4850 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4851 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4852 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4853 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4854 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4855 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4856 &%-M%&).
4857
4858 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4859 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4860 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4861 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4862 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4863
4864 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4865 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4866 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4867 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4868 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4869 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4870
4871 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4872 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4873 necessarily be discarded.
4874 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4875 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4876 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4877 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4878 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4879 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4880
4881 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4882 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4883 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4884 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4885 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4886 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4887 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4888
4889 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4890 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4891 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4892
4893
4894
4895 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4896 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4897 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4898 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4899 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4900 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4901 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4902 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4903
4904 .ilist
4905 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4906 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4907 .next
4908 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4909 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4910 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4911 .next
4912 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4913 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4914 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4915 .next
4916 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4917 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4918 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4919 .next
4920 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4921 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4922 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4923 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4924 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4925 .next
4926 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4927 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4928 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4929 .next
4930 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4931 want to use this feature, you must set
4932 .code
4933 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4934 .endd
4935 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4936 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4937 .endlist
4938
4939 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4940 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4941 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4942 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4943
4944 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4945 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4946 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4947 and does not introduce a comment.
4948
4949 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4950 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4951 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4952 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4953 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4954
4955 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4956 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4957 change settings as required.
4958
4959 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4960 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4961 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4962 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4963 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4964 described.
4965
4966
4967
4968 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4969 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4970 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4971 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4972 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4973 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4974 using this syntax:
4975 .display
4976 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4977 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4978 .endd
4979 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4980 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4981 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4982 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4983 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4984 is required.
4985
4986 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4987 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4988 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4989 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4990
4991 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4992 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4993 for example:
4994 .code
4995 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4996 .include /some/file
4997 .endd
4998 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4999 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5000 inclusion appears.
5001
5002
5003
5004 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5005 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5006 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5007 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5008 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5009 definition, and must be of the form
5010 .display
5011 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5012 .endd
5013 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5014 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5015 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5016 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5017 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5018
5019 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5020 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5021 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5022
5023 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5024 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5025 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5026 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5027 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5028 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5029 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5030 define
5031 .display
5032 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5033 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5034 .endd
5035 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5036 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5037 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5038 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5039 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5040 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5041
5042
5043 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5044 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5045 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5046 &'='&. For example:
5047 .code
5048 MAC = initial value
5049 ...
5050 MAC == updated value
5051 .endd
5052 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5053 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5054 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5055 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5056 .code
5057 MAC = initial value
5058 ...
5059 MAC == MAC and something added
5060 .endd
5061 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5062 from a number of other files.
5063
5064 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5065 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5066 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5067 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5068 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5069 file to be ignored.
5070
5071
5072
5073 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5074 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5075 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5076 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5077 .code
5078 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5079 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5080 .endd
5081 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5082 .code
5083 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5084 .endd
5085 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5086 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5087 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5088
5089
5090 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5091 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5092 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5093 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5094 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5095 (see below).
5096
5097 The following classes of macros are defined:
5098 .display
5099 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5100 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5101 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5102 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5103 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5104 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5105 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5106 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5107 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5108 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5109 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5110 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5111 .endd
5112
5113 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5114
5115
5116 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5117 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5118 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5119 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5120 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5121 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5122 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5123
5124 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5125 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5126 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5127 line. Thus:
5128 .code
5129 .ifdef AAA
5130 message_size_limit = 50M
5131 .else
5132 message_size_limit = 100M
5133 .endif
5134 .endd
5135 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5136 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5137 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5138 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5139 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5140
5141 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5142 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5143 in this line"& will always be true.
5144
5145 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5146 to clarify complicated nestings.
5147
5148
5149
5150 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5151 .cindex "common option syntax"
5152 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5153 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5154 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5155 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5156 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5157 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5158 space) and then the value. For example:
5159 .code
5160 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5161 .endd
5162 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5163 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5164 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5165 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5166 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5167 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5168 word &"hide"&. For example:
5169 .code
5170 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5171 .endd
5172 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5173 .code
5174 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5175 .endd
5176 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5177 all instances of the same driver.
5178
5179 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5180 that are found in option settings.
5181
5182
5183 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5184 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5185 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5186 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5187 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5188 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5189 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5190 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5191 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5192 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5193 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5194 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5195 .code
5196 queue_only
5197 queue_only = true
5198 .endd
5199 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5200 .code
5201 no_queue_only
5202 queue_only = false
5203 .endd
5204 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5205
5206
5207
5208
5209 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5210 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5211 .cindex "format" "integer"
5212 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5213 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5214 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5215 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5216 hexadecimal number.
5217
5218 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5219 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5220 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5221 When the values
5222 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5223 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5224 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5225 used.
5226
5227
5228 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5229 .cindex "integer format"
5230 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5231 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5232 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5233 Such options are always output in octal.
5234
5235
5236 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5237 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5238 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5239 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5240 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5241
5242
5243
5244 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5245 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5246 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5247 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5248 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5249
5250 .table2 30pt
5251 .irow &%s%& seconds
5252 .irow &%m%& minutes
5253 .irow &%h%& hours
5254 .irow &%d%& days
5255 .irow &%w%& weeks
5256 .endtable
5257
5258 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5259 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5260 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5261
5262
5263
5264 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5265 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5266 .cindex "format" "string"
5267 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5268 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5269 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5270 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5271 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5272 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5273 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5274 therefore equivalent:
5275 .code
5276 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5277 trusted_users = uucp:\
5278 # This comment line is ignored
5279 mail
5280 .endd
5281 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5282 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5283 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5284 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5285 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5286
5287 .table2 100pt
5288 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5289 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5290 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5291 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5292 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5293 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5294 character"
5295 .endtable
5296
5297 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5298 character, that character replaces the pair.
5299
5300 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5301 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5302 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5303 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5304 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5305 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5306
5307
5308 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5309 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5310 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5311 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5312 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5313 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5314 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5315 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5316 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5317 within a quoted configuration string.
5318
5319
5320 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5321 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5322 .cindex "format" "user name"
5323 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5324 .cindex "format" "group name"
5325 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5326 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5327 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5328 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5329
5330
5331 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5332 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5333 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5334 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5335 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5336 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5337 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5338 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5339 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5340 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5341 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5342
5343 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5344 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5345 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5346 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5347 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5348 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5349 example, the list
5350 .code
5351 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5352 .endd
5353 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5354
5355 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5356 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5357 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5358 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5359
5360 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5361 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5362 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5363 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5364 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5365 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5366 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5367 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5368 .code
5369 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5370 .endd
5371 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5372 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5373 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5374
5375 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5376 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5377 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5378 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5379 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5380 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5381 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5382 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5383 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5384 .code
5385 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5386 .endd
5387 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5388 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5389 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5390 the value in quotes. For example:
5391 .code
5392 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5393 .endd
5394 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5395 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5396 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5397 enclosing an empty list item.
5398
5399
5400
5401 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5402 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5403 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5404 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5405 .code
5406 senders = user@domain :
5407 .endd
5408 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5409 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5410 items, the second of which is empty:
5411 .code
5412 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5413 .endd
5414 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5415 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5416 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5417 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5418 .code
5419 senders = :
5420 .endd
5421 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5422 is at the end of the list.
5423
5424
5425
5426
5427 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5428 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5429 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5430 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5431 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5432 a sequence of lines like this:
5433 .display
5434 <&'instance name'&>:
5435 <&'option'&>
5436 ...
5437 <&'option'&>
5438 .endd
5439 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5440 followed by three options settings:
5441 .code
5442 localuser:
5443 driver = accept
5444 check_local_user
5445 transport = local_delivery
5446 .endd
5447 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5448 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5449 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5450 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5451 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5452 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5453
5454 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5455 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5456
5457 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5458 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5459 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5460 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5461 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5462 server.
5463
5464 .cindex "generic options"
5465 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5466 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5467 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5468 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5469 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5470 .cindex "private options"
5471 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5472 they all have default values.
5473
5474 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5475 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5476 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5477
5478 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5479 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5480 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5481 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5482 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5483 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5484 configuration lines:
5485 .code
5486 remote_smtp:
5487 driver = smtp
5488 .endd
5489 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5490 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5491 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5492 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5493 thus:
5494 .code
5495 special_smtp:
5496 driver = smtp
5497 port = 1234
5498 command_timeout = 10s
5499 .endd
5500 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5501 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5502 lines.
5503
5504 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5505 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5506 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5507 option.
5508
5509
5510
5511
5512
5513
5514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5516
5517 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5518 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5519 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5520 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5521 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5522 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5523 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5524 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5525 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5526 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5527 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5528
5529
5530
5531 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5532 All macros should be defined before any options.
5533
5534 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5535 .code
5536 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5537 .endd
5538 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5539 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5540 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5541 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5542
5543 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5544 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5545 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5546
5547
5548 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5549 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5550 in the file, after the macros.
5551 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5552 .code
5553 # primary_hostname =
5554 .endd
5555 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5556 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5557 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5558 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5559
5560 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5561 .code
5562 domainlist local_domains = @
5563 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5564 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5565 .endd
5566 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5567 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5568 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5569 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5570
5571 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5572 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5573 on the local host.
5574
5575 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5576 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5577 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5578 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5579 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5580 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5581
5582 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5583 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5584 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5585 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5586 domain is permitted.
5587
5588 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5589 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5590 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5591 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5592 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5593 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5594
5595 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5596 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5597 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5598
5599 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5600 .code
5601 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5602 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5603 .endd
5604 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5605 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5606 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5607 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5608 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5609 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5610 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5611 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5612 contents of a message to be checked.
5613
5614 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5615 .code
5616 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5617 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5618 .endd
5619 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5620 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5621 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5622 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5623
5624 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5625 .code
5626 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5627 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5628 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5629 .endd
5630 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5631 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5632 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5633 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5634 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5635 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5636 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5637
5638 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5639 .code
5640 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5641 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5642 .endd
5643 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5644 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5645 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5646 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5647 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5648 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5649 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5650 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5651 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5652 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5653 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5654 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5655 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5656 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5657 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5658 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5659 consequences).
5660 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5661 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5662 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5663 which should be used in preference to 587.
5664 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5665 these ports.
5666 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5667
5668 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5669 .code
5670 # qualify_domain =
5671 # qualify_recipient =
5672 .endd
5673 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5674 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5675 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5676 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5677 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5678 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5679
5680 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5681 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5682 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5683 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5684 .code
5685 # allow_domain_literals
5686 .endd
5687 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5688 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5689 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5690 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5691 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5692 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5693
5694 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5695 .code
5696 never_users = root
5697 .endd
5698 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5699 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5700 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5701 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5702 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5703 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5704 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5705 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5706
5707 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5708 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5709 line,
5710 .code
5711 host_lookup = *
5712 .endd
5713 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5714 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5715 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5716 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5717 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5718 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5719 unreachable.
5720
5721 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5722 1413 (hence their names):
5723 .code
5724 rfc1413_hosts = *
5725 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5726 .endd
5727 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5728 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5729 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5730 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5731 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5732 information, you can change this.
5733
5734 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5735 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5736 .code
5737 prdr_enable = true
5738 .endd
5739
5740 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5741 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5742 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5743 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5744 .code
5745 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5746 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5747 .endd
5748 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5749 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5750
5751 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5752 over the default:
5753 .code
5754 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5755 +tls_certificate_verified
5756 .endd
5757
5758 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5759 .code
5760 # percent_hack_domains =
5761 .endd
5762 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5763 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5764 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5765
5766 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5767 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5768 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5769 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5770 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5771 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5772 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5773 always bounce messages.
5774 .code
5775 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5776 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5777 .endd
5778 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5779 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5780 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5781 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5782 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5783
5784 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5785 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5786 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5787 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5788 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5789 not often needed).
5790 .code
5791 # split_spool_directory = true
5792 .endd
5793
5794 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5795 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5796 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5797 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5798 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5799 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5800 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5801 .code
5802 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5803 .endd
5804
5805 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5806 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5807 that are not 8-bit clean.
5808 .code
5809 # accept_8bitmime = false
5810 .endd
5811
5812 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5813 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5814 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5815 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5816 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5817 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5818 .code
5819 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5820 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5821 .endd
5822
5823
5824 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5825 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5826 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5827 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5828 It starts with the line
5829 .code
5830 begin acl
5831 .endd
5832 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5833 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5834 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5835
5836 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5837 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5838 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5839 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5840 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5841 result of the ACL processing.
5842 .code
5843 acl_check_rcpt:
5844 .endd
5845 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5846 ACL, and names it.
5847 .code
5848 accept hosts = :
5849 .endd
5850 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5851 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5852 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5853 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5854 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5855 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5856
5857 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5858 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5859 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5860 manner.
5861 .code
5862 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5863 domains = +local_domains
5864 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5865
5866 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5867 domains = !+local_domains
5868 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5869 .endd
5870 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5871 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5872 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5873 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5874 in Internet mail addresses.
5875
5876 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5877 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5878 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5879 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5880 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5881 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5882 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5883 policy of being as safe as possible.
5884
5885 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5886 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5887 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5888 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5889 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5890 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5891
5892 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5893 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5894 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5895 have to modify this rule.
5896
5897 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5898 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5899 common convention of local parts constructed as
5900 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5901 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5902 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5903 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5904 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5905 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5906
5907 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5908 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5909 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5910 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5911 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5912 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5913 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5914 .code
5915 accept local_parts = postmaster
5916 domains = +local_domains
5917 .endd
5918 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5919 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5920 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5921 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5922 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5923
5924 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5925 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5926 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5927 .code
5928 require verify = sender
5929 .endd
5930 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5931 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5932 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5933 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5934 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5935 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5936 discusses the details of address verification.
5937 .code
5938 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5939 control = submission
5940 .endd
5941 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5942 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5943 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5944 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5945 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5946 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5947 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5948 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5949 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5950 .code
5951 accept authenticated = *
5952 control = submission
5953 .endd
5954 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5955 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5956 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5957 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5958 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5959 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5960 .code
5961 require message = relay not permitted
5962 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5963 .endd
5964 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5965 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5966 .code
5967 require verify = recipient
5968 .endd
5969 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5970 fails, the address is rejected.
5971 .code
5972 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5973 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5974 # $dnslist_text
5975 # dnslists = black.list.example
5976 #
5977 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5978 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5979 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5980 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5981 .endd
5982 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5983 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5984 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5985 line.
5986 .code
5987 # require verify = csa
5988 .endd
5989 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5990 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5991 records.
5992 .code
5993 accept
5994 .endd
5995 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5996 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5997 .code
5998 acl_check_data:
5999 .endd
6000 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6001 of this ACL are commented out:
6002 .code
6003 # deny malware = *
6004 # message = This message contains a virus \
6005 # ($malware_name).
6006 .endd
6007 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6008 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6009 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6010 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6011 .code
6012 # warn spam = nobody
6013 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6014 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6015 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6016 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6017 .endd
6018 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6019 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6020 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6021 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6022 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6023 whatever the spam score.
6024 .code
6025 accept
6026 .endd
6027 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6028
6029
6030 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6031 .cindex "default" "routers"
6032 .cindex "routers" "default"
6033 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6034 by the line
6035 .code
6036 begin routers
6037 .endd
6038 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6039 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6040 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6041 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6042 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6043 .code
6044 # domain_literal:
6045 # driver = ipliteral
6046 # domains = !+local_domains
6047 # transport = remote_smtp
6048 .endd
6049 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6050 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6051 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6052 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6053 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6054
6055 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6056 macro has been defined, per
6057 .code
6058 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6059 smarthost:
6060 #...
6061 .else
6062 dnslookup:
6063 #...
6064 .endif
6065 .endd
6066
6067 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6068 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6069 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6070 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6071
6072 .code
6073 smarthost:
6074 driver = manualroute
6075 domains = ! +local_domains
6076 transport = smarthost_smtp
6077 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6078 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6079 no_more
6080 .endd
6081 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6082 specified by the line
6083 .code
6084 domains = ! +local_domains
6085 .endd
6086 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6087 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6088 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6089 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6090 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6091 passed on to the following routers.
6092
6093 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6094 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6095 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6096 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6097
6098 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6099 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6100 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6101 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6102 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6103 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6104 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6105
6106 .code
6107 dnslookup:
6108 driver = dnslookup
6109 domains = ! +local_domains
6110 transport = remote_smtp
6111 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6112 .ifdef _HAVE_DNSSEC
6113 dnssec_request_domains = *
6114 .endif
6115 no_more
6116 .endd
6117 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6118
6119 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6120 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6121 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6122 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6123 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6124
6125 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6126 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6127 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6128 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6129 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6130 the address fails and is bounced.
6131
6132 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6133 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6134 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6135 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6136 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6137 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6138 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6139 out.
6140 .code
6141 system_aliases:
6142 driver = redirect
6143 allow_fail
6144 allow_defer
6145 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6146 # user = exim
6147 file_transport = address_file
6148 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6149 .endd
6150 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6151 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6152 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6153 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6154 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6155 the next router.
6156
6157 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6158 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6159 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6160 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6161 .code
6162 userforward:
6163 driver = redirect
6164 check_local_user
6165 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6166 # local_part_suffix_optional
6167 file = $home/.forward
6168 # allow_filter
6169 no_verify
6170 no_expn
6171 check_ancestor
6172 file_transport = address_file
6173 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6174 reply_transport = address_reply
6175 .endd
6176 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6177 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6178 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6179 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6180 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6181 namely:
6182 .code
6183 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6184 # local_part_suffix_optional
6185 .endd
6186 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6187 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6188 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6189 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6190 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6191 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6192 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6193
6194 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6195 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6196 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6197 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6198
6199 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6200 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6201 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6202 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6203 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6204 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6205 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6206
6207 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6208 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6209 There are two reasons for doing this:
6210
6211 .olist
6212 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6213 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6214 unnecessary work.
6215 .next
6216 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6217 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6218 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6219 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6220 this time.
6221 .endlist
6222
6223 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6224 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6225 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6226 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6227
6228 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6229 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6230 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6231 .code
6232 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6233 .endd
6234 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6235 transport.
6236 .code
6237 localuser:
6238 driver = accept
6239 check_local_user
6240 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6241 # local_part_suffix_optional
6242 transport = local_delivery
6243 .endd
6244 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6245 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6246 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6247 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6248 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6249
6250
6251 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6252 .cindex "default" "transports"
6253 .cindex "transports" "default"
6254 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6255 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6256 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6257 .code
6258 begin transports
6259 .endd
6260 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6261 .code
6262 remote_smtp:
6263 driver = smtp
6264 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6265 .ifdef _HAVE_DANE
6266 hosts_try_dane = *
6267 .endif
6268 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6269 hosts_try_prdr = *
6270 .endif
6271 .endd
6272 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6273 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6274 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6275 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6276 to use DANE for delivery;
6277 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6278
6279 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6280 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6281 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6282 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6283
6284 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6285 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6286 usual federated system.
6287
6288 .code
6289 smarthost_smtp:
6290 driver = smtp
6291 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6292 multi_domain
6293 #
6294 .ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6295 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6296 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6297 hosts_require_tls = *
6298 tls_verify_hosts = *
6299 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6300 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6301 # or not:
6302 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6303 #
6304 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6305 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6306 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6307 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6308 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6309 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6310 #
6311 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6312 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6313 .endif
6314 .ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6315 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6316 .endif
6317 .endif
6318 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6319 hosts_try_prdr = *
6320 .endif
6321 .endd
6322 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6323 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6324 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6325 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6326 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6327 then no other options are defined.
6328 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6329 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6330 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6331 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6332 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6333 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6334 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6335 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6336 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6337 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6338 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6339
6340 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6341
6342 All other options are defaulted.
6343 .code
6344 local_delivery:
6345 driver = appendfile
6346 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6347 delivery_date_add
6348 envelope_to_add
6349 return_path_add
6350 # group = mail
6351 # mode = 0660
6352 .endd
6353 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6354 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6355 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6356 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6357 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6358 show how this can be done.
6359
6360 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6361 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6362 similarly-named options above.
6363 .code
6364 address_pipe:
6365 driver = pipe
6366 return_output
6367 .endd
6368 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6369 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6370 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6371 be returned to the sender.
6372 .code
6373 address_file:
6374 driver = appendfile
6375 delivery_date_add
6376 envelope_to_add
6377 return_path_add
6378 .endd
6379 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6380 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6381 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6382 .code
6383 address_reply:
6384 driver = autoreply
6385 .endd
6386 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6387 filter files.
6388
6389
6390
6391 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6392 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6393 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6394 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6395 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6396 introduced by the line
6397 .code
6398 begin retry
6399 .endd
6400 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6401 errors:
6402 .code
6403 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6404 .endd
6405 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6406 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6407 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6408 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6409 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6410
6411 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6412 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6413 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6414
6415
6416 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6417 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6418 .code
6419 begin rewrite
6420 .endd
6421 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6422 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6423
6424
6425
6426 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6427 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6428 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6429 .code
6430 begin authenticators
6431 .endd
6432 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6433 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6434 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6435 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6436 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6437 to support most MUA software.
6438
6439 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6440 .code
6441 #PLAIN:
6442 # driver = plaintext
6443 # server_set_id = $auth2
6444 # server_prompts = :
6445 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6446 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6447 .endd
6448 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6449 .code
6450 #LOGIN:
6451 # driver = plaintext
6452 # server_set_id = $auth1
6453 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6454 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6455 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6456 .endd
6457
6458 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6459 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6460 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6461 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6462 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6463 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6464 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6465 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6466
6467 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6468 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6469 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6470 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6471
6472 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6473 usercode and password are in different positions.
6474 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6475
6476 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6477
6478
6479
6480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6482
6483 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6484
6485 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6486 .cindex "PCRE"
6487 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6488 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6489 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6490 regular expressions is discussed in
6491 online Perl manpages, in
6492 many Perl reference books, and also in
6493 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6494 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6495 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6496 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6497 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6498
6499 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6500 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6501 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6502 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6503 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6504 case-insensitive.
6505
6506 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6507 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6508 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6509 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6510 .code
6511 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6512 .endd
6513 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6514 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6515 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6516 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6517 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6518 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6519 matched.
6520
6521 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6522 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6523 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6524 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6525 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6526 match anywhere in the subject string.
6527
6528 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6529 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6530 .code
6531 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6532 .endd
6533 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6534 You need to use:
6535 .code
6536 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6537 .endd
6538 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6539 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6540
6541
6542
6543 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6545
6546 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6547 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6548 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6549 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6550 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6551 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6552
6553 .olist
6554 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6555 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6556 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6557 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6558 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6559 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6560 .next
6561 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6562 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6563 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6564 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6565 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6566 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6567 .endlist
6568
6569 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6570 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6571 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6572 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6573 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6574 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6575
6576 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6577 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6578 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6579 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6580 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6581 .code
6582 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6583 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6584 .endd
6585 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6586 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6587 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6588 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6589 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6590 .code
6591 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6592 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6593 .endd
6594 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6595 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6596
6597 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6598 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6599 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6600 .code
6601 domain1:
6602 domain2:
6603 .endd
6604 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6605 matches the list item.
6606
6607 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6608 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6609 .code
6610 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6611 .endd
6612 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6613 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6614 causes a second lookup to occur.
6615
6616 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6617 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6618 lookup is permitted.
6619
6620
6621 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6623 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6624 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6625
6626 .ilist
6627 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6628 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6629 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6630 .next
6631 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6632 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6633 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6634 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6635 .endlist
6636
6637 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6638 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6639 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6640 .code
6641 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6642 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6643 .endd
6644 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6645 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6646 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6647
6648
6649
6650
6651 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6652 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6653 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6654 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6655
6656 .ilist
6657 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6658 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6659 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6660 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6661 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6662 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6663 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6664 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6665 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6666 .display
6667 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6668 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6669 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6670 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6671 .endd
6672 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6673 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6674 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6675 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6676 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6677 .next
6678 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6679 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6680 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6681 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6682 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6683 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6684 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6685
6686 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6687 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6688 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6689 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6690 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6691 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6692 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6693 .next
6694 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6695 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6696 .cindex "sasldb2"
6697 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6698 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6699 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6700 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6701 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6702 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6703 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6704 .next
6705 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6706 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6707 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6708 .cindex "Courier"
6709 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6710 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6711 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6712 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6713 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6714 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6715 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6716 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6717 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6718 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6719 .next
6720 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6721 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6722 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6723 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6724 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6725 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6726 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6727 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6728 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6729 .next
6730 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6731 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6732 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6733 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6734 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6735 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6736 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6737 .code
6738 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6739 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6740 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6741 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6742 .endd
6743 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6744 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6745 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6746 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6747 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6748
6749 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6750 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6751 lookup types support only literal keys.
6752
6753 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6754 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6755 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6756
6757 .new
6758 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6759 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6760 notation before executing the lookup.)
6761 .wen
6762 .next
6763 .new
6764 .cindex lookup json
6765 .cindex json "lookup type"
6766 .cindex JSON expansions
6767 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6768 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6769 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6770 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6771 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6772 of the JSON structure.
6773 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6774 nunbered array element is selected.
6775 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6776 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6777 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6778 is returned.
6779 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6780 .wen
6781 .next
6782 .cindex "linear search"
6783 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6784 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6785 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6786 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6787 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6788 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6789 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6790 in the file is used.
6791
6792 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6793 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6794 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6795 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6796 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6797 colon, for example:
6798 .code
6799 baduser: :fail:
6800 .endd
6801 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6802 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6803 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6804 wildcarding of any kind.
6805
6806 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6807 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6808 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6809 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6810 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6811 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6812 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6813 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6814 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6815
6816 .next
6817 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6819 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6820 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6821 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6822 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6823 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6824 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6825
6826 .next
6827 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6828 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6829 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6831 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6832 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6833 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6834 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6835 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6836
6837 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6838 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6839 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6840 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6841
6842 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6843 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6844
6845 .olist
6846 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6847 .code
6848 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6849 *fish data for anythingfish
6850 .endd
6851 .next
6852 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6853 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6854 .code
6855 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6856 .endd
6857 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6858 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6859 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6860 .code
6861 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6862 .endd
6863 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6864 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6865 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6866 .code
6867 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6868 .endd
6869
6870 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6871 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6872 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6873 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6874 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6875
6876 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6877 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6878 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6879 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6880 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6881
6882 .next
6883 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6884 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6885 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6886 example:
6887 .code
6888 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6889 .endd
6890 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6891 .endlist olist
6892
6893 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6894 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6895 be followed by optional colons.
6896
6897 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6898 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6899 lookup types support only literal keys.
6900
6901 .next
6902 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6903 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6904 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6905 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6906 .endlist ilist
6907
6908
6909 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6910 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6911 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6912 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6913 many of them are given in later sections.
6914
6915 .ilist
6916 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6917 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6918 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6919 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6920 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6921 .next
6922 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6923 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6924 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6925 .next
6926 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6927 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6928 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6929 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6930 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6931 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6932 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6933 .next
6934 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6935 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6936 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6937 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6938 .next
6939 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6940 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6941 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6942 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6943 .next
6944 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6945 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6946 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6947 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6948 .next
6949 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6950 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6951 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6952 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6953 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6954 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6955 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6956 password value. For example:
6957 .code
6958 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6959 .endd
6960 .next
6961 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6962 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6963 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6964 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6965
6966 .next
6967 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6968 .cindex lookup Redis
6969 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6970 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6971
6972 .next
6973 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6974 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6975 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6976 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6977
6978 .next
6979 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6980 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6981 .next
6982 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6983 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6984 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6985 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6986 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6987 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6988 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6989 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6990 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6991 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6992 .code
6993 require condition = \
6994 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6995 .endd
6996 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6997 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6998 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6999 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7000 .endlist
7001
7002
7003
7004 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7005 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7006 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7007 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7008 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7009 options such as a list of local domains.
7010
7011 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7012 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7013 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7014 or may give up altogether.
7015
7016
7017
7018 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7019 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7020 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7021 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7022 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7023 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7024 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7025 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7026
7027 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7028 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7029 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7030
7031 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7032 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7033 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7034
7035 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7036 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7037 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7038 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7039 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7040 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7041 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7042 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7043 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7044 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7045 .code
7046 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7047 .endd
7048 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7049 looks up these keys, in this order:
7050 .code
7051 jane@eyre.example
7052 *@eyre.example
7053 *
7054 .endd
7055 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7056 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7057 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7058 Exim move on to try the next key.
7059
7060
7061
7062 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7063 .cindex "partial matching"
7064 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7065 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7066 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7067 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7068 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7069 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7070 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7071 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7072 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7073 a key in a DBM file is
7074 .code
7075 *.dates.fict.example
7076 .endd
7077 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7078 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7079 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7080 file.
7081
7082 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7083 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7084 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7085
7086 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7087 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7088 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7089 partial matching keys
7090 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7091 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7092 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7093
7094 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7095 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7096 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7097 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7098 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7099 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7100 remains.
7101
7102 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7103 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7104 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7105 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7106 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7107 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7108 .code
7109 2250.dates.fict.example
7110 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7111 *.dates.fict.example
7112 *.fict.example
7113 .endd
7114 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7115 finishes.
7116
7117 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7118 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7119 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7120 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7121 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7122 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7123 .code
7124 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7125 .endd
7126 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7127 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7128 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7129 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7130 .code
7131 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7132 .endd
7133 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7134 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7135
7136 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7137 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7138 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7139
7140 .ilist
7141 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7142 .next
7143 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7144 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7145 .next
7146 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7147 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7148 for &"*"& on its own.
7149 .next
7150 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7151 .endlist
7152
7153
7154 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7155 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7156 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7157 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7158 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7159 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7160 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7161
7162 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7163 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7164 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7165 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7166 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7167
7168
7169
7170
7171 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7172 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7173 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7174 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7175 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7176 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7177 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7178
7179 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7180 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7181 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7182 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7183 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7184 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7185
7186 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7187 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7188 complete.
7189
7190
7191
7192
7193 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7194 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7195 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7196 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7197 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7198 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7199 .code
7200 [name=$local_part]
7201 .endd
7202 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7203 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7204 .code
7205 [name="$local_part"]
7206 .endd
7207 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7208 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7209 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7210 of the following form is provided:
7211 .code
7212 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7213 .endd
7214 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7215 .code
7216 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7217 .endd
7218 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7219 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7220 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7221
7222
7223
7224
7225 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7226 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7227 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7228 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7229 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7230 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7231 an expansion string could contain:
7232 .code
7233 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7234 .endd
7235 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7236 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7237 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7238 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7239
7240 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7241 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7242 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7243
7244 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7245 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7246 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7247 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7248 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7249 .code
7250 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7251 .endd
7252 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7253 white space is ignored.
7254 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7255 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7256 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7257
7258 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7259 When the type is PTR,
7260 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7261 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7262 .code
7263 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7264 .endd
7265 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7266 altered and nothing is added.
7267
7268 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7269 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7270 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7271 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7272 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7273 The field separator can be modified as above.
7274
7275 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7276 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7277 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7278 unless a field separator is specified.
7279 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7280 For SPF records the
7281 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7282 .code
7283 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7284 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7285 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7286 .endd
7287 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7288 white space is ignored.
7289
7290 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7291 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7292 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7293 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7294 specified.
7295 .code
7296 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7297 .endd
7298
7299 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7300 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7301 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7302 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7303 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7304 each followed by a comma,
7305 that may appear before the record type.
7306
7307 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7308 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7309 a defer-option modifier.
7310 The possible keywords are
7311 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7312 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7313 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7314 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7315 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7316 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7317 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7318 .code
7319 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7320 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7321 .endd
7322 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7323 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7324
7325 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7326 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7327 The possible keywords are
7328 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7329 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7330 with the lookup.
7331 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7332 is not labelled as authenticated data
7333 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7334 The default is &"never"&.
7335
7336 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7337
7338 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7339 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7340 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7341 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7342 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7343 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7344
7345 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7346 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7347 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7348
7349 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7350 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7351 .cindex DNS TTL
7352 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7353 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7354 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7355
7356
7357 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7358 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7359 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7360 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7361 the pseudo-type MXH:
7362 .code
7363 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7364 .endd
7365 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7366 returned.
7367
7368 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7369 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7370 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7371 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7372 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7373 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7374 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7375 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7376 .code
7377 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7378 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7379 .endd
7380 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7381 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7382 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7383
7384 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7385 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7386 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7387 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7388 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7389 such a list.
7390
7391 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7392 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7393 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7394 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7395 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7396 result of a successful lookup such as:
7397 .code
7398 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7399 .endd
7400 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7401 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7402 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7403
7404 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7405 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7406 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7407 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7408 .code
7409 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7410 .endd
7411
7412
7413 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7414 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7415 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7416 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7417 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7418 .code
7419 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7420 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7421 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7422 .endd
7423 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7424 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7425 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7426 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7427
7428 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7429 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7430 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7431
7432
7433
7434
7435 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7436 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7437 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7438 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7439 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7440 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7441 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7442 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7443 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7444 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7445 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7446 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7447 .code
7448 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7449 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7450 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7451 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7452 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7453 .endd
7454 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7455 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7456
7457 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7458 the way they handle the results of a query:
7459
7460 .ilist
7461 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7462 gives an error.
7463 .next
7464 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7465 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7466 .next
7467 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7468 from all of them are returned.
7469 .endlist
7470
7471
7472 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7473 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7474 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7475 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7476
7477
7478 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7479 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7480 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7481 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7482 .code
7483 data = ${lookup ldap \
7484 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7485 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7486 .endd
7487 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7488 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7489 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7490 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7491
7492 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7493 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7494 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7495
7496 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7497 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7498 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7499 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7500 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7501 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7502 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7503 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7504 &_exim.conf_&.
7505
7506
7507 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7508 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7509 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7510 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7511 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7512 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7513
7514 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7515 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7516 the string:
7517 .code
7518 * => \2A
7519 ( => \28
7520 ) => \29
7521 \ => \5C
7522 .endd
7523 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7524 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7525 .code
7526 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7527 .endd
7528 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7529 .code
7530 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7531 .endd
7532 yields
7533 .code
7534 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7535 .endd
7536 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7537 .code
7538 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7539 .endd
7540 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7541 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7542 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7543 .code
7544 , + " \ < > ;
7545 .endd
7546 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7547 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7548 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7549 .code
7550 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7551 .endd
7552 yields
7553 .code
7554 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7555 .endd
7556 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7557 .code
7558 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7559 .endd
7560 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7561 authentication below.
7562
7563
7564 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7565 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7566 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7567 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7568 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7569 by starting it with
7570 .code
7571 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7572 .endd
7573 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7574 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7575 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7576 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7577 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7578 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7579 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7580 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7581 failures, and timeouts.
7582
7583 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7584 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7585 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7586 doubled. For example
7587 .code
7588 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7589 .endd
7590 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7591 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7592 the local host) is used.
7593
7594 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7595 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7596 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7597 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7598 not available.
7599
7600 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7601 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7602 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7603 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7604 .code
7605 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7606 .endd
7607 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7608 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7609 .code
7610 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7611 .endd
7612 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7613 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7614 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7615 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7616 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7617 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7618 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7619 backup host.
7620
7621 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7622 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7623 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7624
7625 .ilist
7626 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7627 interface.
7628 .next
7629 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7630 .endlist
7631
7632
7633 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7634 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7635
7636
7637
7638 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7639 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7640 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7641 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7642 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7643 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7644 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7645 them. The following names are recognized:
7646 .display
7647 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7648 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7649 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7650 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7651 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7652 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7653 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7654 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7655 .endd
7656 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7657 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7658 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7659 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7660
7661 .cindex LDAP timeout
7662 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7663 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7664 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7665 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7666 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7667 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7668 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7669 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7670 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7671 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7672
7673 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7674 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7675
7676 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7677 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7678 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7679 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7680 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7681 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7682 alternate list (colon-separated).
7683
7684 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7685 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7686 .code
7687 ${lookup ldap
7688 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7689 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7690 {$value}fail}
7691 .endd
7692 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7693 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7694 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7695 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7696
7697 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7698 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7699 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7700
7701 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7702 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7703 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7704 quoting has two advantages:
7705
7706 .ilist
7707 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7708 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7709 .next
7710 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7711 .endlist
7712
7713 For example, a setting such as
7714 .code
7715 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7716 .endd
7717 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7718
7719 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7720 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7721 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7722 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7723 .code
7724 PASS=${quote:$3}
7725 .endd
7726 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7727 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7728 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7729
7730
7731
7732 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7733 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7734 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7735 as a sequence of values, for example
7736 .code
7737 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7738 .endd
7739 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7740 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7741 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7742 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7743 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7744 directory.
7745
7746 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7747 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7748 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7749 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7750
7751 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7752 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7753 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7754 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7755 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7756 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7757 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7758 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7759 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7760
7761 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7762 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7763 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7764 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7765 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7766
7767 .code
7768 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7769 value1.1,value1,,2
7770
7771 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7772 value two
7773
7774 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7775 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7776
7777 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7778 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7779
7780 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7781 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7782 .endd
7783 You can
7784 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7785 results of LDAP lookups.
7786 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7787 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7788 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7789 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7790 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7791 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7792
7793
7794
7795
7796 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7797 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7798 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7799 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7800 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7801 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7802 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7803 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7804 .code
7805 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7806 .endd
7807 might return the string
7808 .code
7809 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7810 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7811 .endd
7812 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7813 .code
7814 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7815 .endd
7816 would just return
7817 .code
7818 Martin Guerre
7819 .endd
7820 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7821 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7822 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7823
7824
7825
7826 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7827 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7828 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7829 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7830 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7831 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7832 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7834 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7835 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7836 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7837 .cindex lookup Redis
7838 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7839 and SQLite
7840 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7841 might be
7842 .code
7843 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7844 {$value}fail}
7845 .endd
7846 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7847 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7848 .code
7849 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7850 {$value}}
7851 .endd
7852 might be
7853 .code
7854 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7855 .endd
7856 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7857 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7858 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7859 .code
7860 Mister X
7861 .endd
7862 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7863 with a newline between the data for each row.
7864
7865
7866 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7867 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7868 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7869 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7870 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7871 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7872 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7873 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7874 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7875 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7876 .cindex lookup Redis
7877 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7878 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7879 or &%redis_servers%&
7880 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7881 information.
7882 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7883 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7884 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7885 For all but Redis
7886 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7887 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7888 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7889 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7890 .code
7891 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7892 .endd
7893 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7894 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7895 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7896 .code
7897 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7898 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7899 .endd
7900 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7901 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7902 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7903 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7904 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7905 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7906
7907 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7908 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7909 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7910 information.
7911 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7912 host, database number, and password.
7913 .olist
7914 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7915 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7916 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7917 .next
7918 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7919 .next
7920 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7921 .endlist
7922
7923 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7924 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7925 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7926 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7927
7928 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7929 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7930
7931 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7932 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7933 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7934 done by starting the query with
7935 .display
7936 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7937 .endd
7938 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7939 .olist
7940 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7941 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7942 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7943 taken from there.
7944 .next
7945 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7946 .endlist
7947 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7948 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7949 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7950
7951 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7952 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7953 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7954 like this:
7955 .code
7956 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7957 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7958 master/db/name/pw
7959 .endd
7960 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7961 .code
7962 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7963 .endd
7964 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7965 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7966 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7967 .code
7968 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7969 .endd
7970
7971
7972 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7973 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7974 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7975 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7976 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7977 the default value is &"exim"&.
7978 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7979 .display
7980 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7981 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7982 .endd
7983 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7984 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7985
7986 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7987 the queries.
7988
7989 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7990 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7991
7992 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7993 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7994 is zero because no rows are affected.
7995
7996
7997 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7998 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7999 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8000 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8001 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8002 looks like this:
8003 .code
8004 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8005 .endd
8006 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8007 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8008 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8009
8010 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8011 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8012 affected.
8013
8014 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8015 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8016 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8017 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8018 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8019 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8020 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8021 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8022 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8023 .code
8024 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8025 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8026 .endd
8027 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8028 .code
8029 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8030 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8031 .endd
8032 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8033 quote, which it doubles.
8034
8035 .cindex timeout SQLite
8036 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8037 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8038 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8039 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8040 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8041 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8042 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8043 option.
8044
8045 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8046 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8047 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8048 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8049 Examples:
8050 .code
8051 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8052 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8053 .endd
8054
8055 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8056 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8057 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8058 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8059 servers.
8060
8061 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8062 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8063 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8064 reached.
8065
8066 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
8067 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
8068
8069
8070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8071 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8072
8073 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8074 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8075 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8076 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8077 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8078 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8079 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8080 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8081 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8082
8083 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8084 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8085 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8086 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8087
8088 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8089 support all the complexity available in
8090 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8091
8092
8093
8094 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8095 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8096 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8097
8098 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8099 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8100
8101 The result of
8102 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8103 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8104 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8105 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8106 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8107
8108
8109 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8110 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8111 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8112
8113 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8114 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8115 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8116 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8117 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8118 .code
8119 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8120 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8121 .endd
8122 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8123 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8124 senders based on the receiving domain.
8125
8126
8127
8128
8129 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8130 .cindex "list" "negation"
8131 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8132 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8133 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8134 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8135 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8136 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8137
8138 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8139 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8140 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8141 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8142 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8143 .code
8144 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8145 .endd
8146 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8147 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8148 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8149 .code
8150 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8151 .endd
8152 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8153 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8154 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8155
8156 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8157 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8158 item.
8159
8160
8161
8162 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8163 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8164 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8165 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8166 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8167 filenames are not allowed,
8168 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8169 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8170 lines:
8171
8172 .ilist
8173 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8174 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8175 .next
8176 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8177 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8178 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8179 .code
8180 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8181 .endd
8182 .endlist
8183
8184 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8185 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8186 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8187 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8188
8189 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8190 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8191 .code
8192 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8193 .endd
8194 and the file contains the lines
8195 .code
8196 !a.b.c
8197 *.b.c
8198 .endd
8199 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8200 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8201
8202
8203
8204 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8205 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8206 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8207 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8208 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8209 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8210 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8211 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8212
8213 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8214 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8215 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8216 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8217
8218
8219
8220
8221 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8222 .cindex "named lists"
8223 .cindex "list" "named"
8224 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8225 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8226 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8227 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8228 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8229 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8230 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8231 .code
8232 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8233 .endd
8234 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8235 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8236 configured with the line
8237 .code
8238 domains = +local_domains
8239 .endd
8240 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8241 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8242 .code
8243 dnslookup:
8244 driver = dnslookup
8245 domains = ! +local_domains
8246 transport = remote_smtp
8247 no_more
8248 .endd
8249 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8250 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8251 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8252 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8253 .code
8254 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8255 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8256 .endd
8257 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8258 .code
8259 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8260 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8261 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8262 .endd
8263 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8264 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8265 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8266 .code
8267 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8268 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8269 .endd
8270 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8271 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8272 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8273 .code
8274 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8275 .endd
8276 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8277 referenced lists if you can.
8278
8279 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8280 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8281 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8282 .code
8283 domains = +local_domains
8284 .endd
8285 on several of your routers
8286 or in several ACL statements,
8287 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8288 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8289 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8290 the same each time they are referenced.
8291
8292 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8293 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8294 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8295 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8296
8297
8298
8299 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8300 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8301 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8302 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8303 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8304 write
8305 .code
8306 ALIST = host1 : host2
8307 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8308 .endd
8309 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8310 .code
8311 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8312 .endd
8313 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8314 list, and write
8315 .code
8316 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8317 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8318 .endd
8319 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8320 .code
8321 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8322 .endd
8323
8324
8325 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8326 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8327 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8328 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8329 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8330 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8331 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8332 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8333 message. For example:
8334 .code
8335 domainlist special_domains = \
8336 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8337 .endd
8338 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8339 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8340 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8341 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8342 same list each time.
8343
8344 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8345 cache the result anyway. For example:
8346 .code
8347 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8348 .endd
8349 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8350 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8351
8352
8353
8354 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8355 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8356 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8357 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8358 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8359
8360 .ilist
8361 .cindex "primary host name"
8362 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8363 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8364 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8365 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8366 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8367 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8368 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8369 differ only in their names.
8370 .next
8371 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8372 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8373 .cindex "domain literal"
8374 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8375 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8376 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8377 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8378 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8379 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8380 .next
8381 .cindex "@mx_any"
8382 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8383 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8384 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8385 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8386 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8387 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8388 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8389 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8390 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8391 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8392 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8393
8394 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8395 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8396 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8397 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8398 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8399
8400 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8401 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8402 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8403 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8404 on a router). For example:
8405 .code
8406 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8407 .endd
8408 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8409 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8410
8411 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8412 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8413 contain negative items.
8414
8415 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8416 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8417 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8418 .code
8419 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8420 an.other.domain : ...
8421 .endd
8422 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8423 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8424 .code
8425 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8426 an.other.domain ? ...
8427 .endd
8428 .next
8429 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8430 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8431 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8432 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8433 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8434 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8435 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8436 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8437 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8438 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8439
8440 .next
8441 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8442 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8443 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8444 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8445 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8446 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8447 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8448 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8449 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8450
8451 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8452 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8453 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8454 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8455 expression by expansion, of course).
8456 .next
8457 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8458 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8459 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8460 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8461 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8462 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8463 .code
8464 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8465 .endd
8466 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8467 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8468 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8469 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8470 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8471 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8472 other statements in the same ACL.
8473
8474 .next
8475 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8476 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8477 .code
8478 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8479 .endd
8480 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8481 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8482
8483 .next
8484 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8485 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8486 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8487 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8488 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8489 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8490 expansion variable.
8491 .next
8492 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8493 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8494 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8495 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8496 .code
8497 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8498 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8499 .endd
8500 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8501 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8502 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8503 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8504 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8505 .next
8506 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8507 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8508 between the pattern and the domain.
8509 .endlist
8510
8511 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8512 .code
8513 domainlist funny_domains = \
8514 @ : \
8515 lib.unseen.edu : \
8516 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8517 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8518 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8519 nis;domains.byname : \
8520 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8521 .endd
8522 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8523 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8524 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8525 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8526 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8527 patterns earlier.
8528
8529
8530
8531 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8532 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8533 .cindex "list" "host list"
8534 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8535 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8536 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8537 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8538 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8539 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8540 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8541
8542
8543 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8544 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8545 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8546 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8547 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8548 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8549 not used.
8550
8551 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8552 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8553 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8554
8555
8556
8557 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8558 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8559 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8560 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8561 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8562 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8563 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8564 concerns.)
8565
8566 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8567 inspecting its IP address:
8568
8569 .ilist
8570 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8571 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8572 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8573 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8574 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8575 with the IP address of the subject host.
8576
8577 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8578 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8579 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8580 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8581 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8582
8583 .next
8584 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8585 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8586 domain name, as just described.
8587
8588 .next
8589 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8590 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8591 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8592 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8593 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8594 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8595 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8596 that can never match a client host.
8597
8598 .next
8599 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8600 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8601 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8602 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8603 .code
8604 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8605 accept hosts = @[]
8606 .endd
8607 .next
8608 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8609 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8610 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8611 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8612 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8613 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8614 significant end of the address.
8615
8616 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8617 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8618 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8619 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8620 .code
8621 192.168.23.236/31
8622 .endd
8623 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8624 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8625 matches.
8626
8627 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8628 .code
8629 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8630 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8631 .endd
8632 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8633 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8634 For example:
8635 .code
8636 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8637 .endd
8638 could make use of a file containing
8639 .code
8640 172.16.0.0/12
8641 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8642 .endd
8643 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8644 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8645 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8646 .code
8647 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8648 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8649 .endd
8650 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8651 list.
8652 .endlist
8653
8654
8655
8656 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8657 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8658 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8659 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8660 address, the pattern takes this form:
8661 .display
8662 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8663 .endd
8664 For example:
8665 .code
8666 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8667 .endd
8668 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8669 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8670 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8671 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8672 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8673 returned by the lookup is not used.
8674
8675 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8676 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8677 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8678 patterns of this form:
8679 .display
8680 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8681 .endd
8682 For example:
8683 .code
8684 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8685 .endd
8686 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8687 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8688 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8689 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8690 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8691
8692 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8693 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8694 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8695 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8696 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8697 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8698 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8699 converted using colons and not dots.
8700 .new
8701 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8702 addresses are always used.
8703 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8704 .wen
8705
8706 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8707 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8708 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8709 configurations.
8710
8711 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8712 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8713 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8714 case the IP address is used on its own.
8715
8716
8717
8718 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8719 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8720 .cindex "unknown host name"
8721 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8722 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8723 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8724 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8725 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8726 above.)
8727
8728 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8729 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8730 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8731 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8732 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8733 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8734 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8735
8736 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8737 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8738
8739 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8740 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8741 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8742 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8743 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8744 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8745 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8746 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8747 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8748
8749 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8750 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8751
8752 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8753 .cindex "alias for host"
8754 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8755 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8756
8757 .ilist
8758 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8759 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8760 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8761 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8762 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8763 expression.
8764 .next
8765 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8766 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8767 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8768 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8769 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8770 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8771 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8772 example,
8773 .code
8774 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8775 .endd
8776 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8777 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8778 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8779 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8780 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8781 .code
8782 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8783 .endd
8784 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8785 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8786 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8787 required.
8788 .endlist
8789
8790
8791
8792
8793 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8794 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8795 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8796 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8797 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8798 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8799
8800 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8801 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8802
8803 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8804 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8805 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8806 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8807 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8808 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8809 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8810 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8811 not recognized in an indirected file).
8812
8813 .ilist
8814 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8815 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8816 .code
8817 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8818 .endd
8819 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8820 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8821
8822 .next
8823 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8824 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8825 example:
8826 .code
8827 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8828 192.168.4.5
8829 .endd
8830 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8831 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8832 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8833 .endlist
8834
8835 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8836 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8837 list.
8838
8839 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8840 "SECTmixwilhos"
8841 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8842
8843 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8844 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8845 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8846
8847 .ilist
8848 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8849 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8850 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8851 .code
8852 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8853 .endd
8854 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8855 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8856 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8857 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8858 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8859 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8860 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8861
8862 .next
8863 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8864 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8865 .code
8866 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8867 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8868 .endd
8869 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8870 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8871 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8872 this section.
8873 .endlist
8874
8875
8876 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8877 "SECTtemdnserr"
8878 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8879 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8880 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8881 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8882 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8883 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8884 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8885 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8886 host lists such as whitelists.
8887
8888
8889
8890 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8891 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8892 .cindex "unknown host name"
8893 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8894 If a pattern is of the form
8895 .display
8896 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8897 .endd
8898 for example
8899 .code
8900 dbm;/host/accept/list
8901 .endd
8902 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8903 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8904 is not used.
8905
8906 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8907 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8908 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8909 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8910 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8911 lookup, both using the same file.
8912
8913
8914
8915 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8916 If a pattern is of the form
8917 .display
8918 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8919 .endd
8920 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8921 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8922 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8923 .code
8924 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8925 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8926 .endd
8927 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8928 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8929 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8930 operator.
8931
8932 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8933 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8934 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8935
8936 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8937 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8938 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8939 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8940 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8941 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8942
8943
8944
8945
8946
8947 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8948 .cindex "list" "address list"
8949 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8950 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8951 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8952 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8953 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8954 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8955 using this option setting:
8956 .code
8957 senders = :
8958 .endd
8959 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8960 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8961 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8962 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8963
8964 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8965 example:
8966 .code
8967 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8968 .endd
8969 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8970 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8971 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8972 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8973 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8974 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8975 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8976 .code
8977 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8978 *@+hostile_domains:\
8979 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8980 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8981 .endd
8982 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8983 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8984 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8985 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8986 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8987
8988 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8989 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8990 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8991 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8992 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8993 .code
8994 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8995 .endd
8996
8997 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8998 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8999 senders:
9000
9001 .ilist
9002 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9003 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9004 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9005 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9006 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9007 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9008 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9009 .code
9010 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9011 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9012 .endd
9013 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9014 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9015
9016 .next
9017 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9018 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9019 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9020 example:
9021 .code
9022 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9023 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9024 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9025 .endd
9026 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9027 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9028 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9029 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9030
9031 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9032 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9033 panic log.
9034 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9035 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9036 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9037 default. For example, with this lookup:
9038 .code
9039 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9040 .endd
9041 the file could contains lines like this:
9042 .code
9043 user1@domain1.example
9044 *@domain2.example
9045 .endd
9046 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9047 that are tried is:
9048 .code
9049 nimrod@jaeger.example
9050 *@jaeger.example
9051 *
9052 .endd
9053 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9054 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9055
9056 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9057 .code
9058 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9059 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9060 .endd
9061 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9062 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9063 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9064 .endlist
9065
9066
9067 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9068 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9069 always fails.
9070
9071
9072 .ilist
9073 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9074 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9075 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9076 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9077 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9078 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9079 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9080 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9081 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9082
9083 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9084 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9085 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9086 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9087 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9088 with
9089 .code
9090 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9091 .endd
9092 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9093 .code
9094 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9095 .endd
9096 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9097
9098 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9099 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9100 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9101 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9102 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9103 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9104 .code
9105 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9106 spammer3 : spammer4
9107 .endd
9108 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9109 doubling.
9110
9111 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9112 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9113 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9114 might have entries like
9115 .code
9116 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9117 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9118 *: ^\d{8}$
9119 .endd
9120 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9121 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9122 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9123 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9124
9125 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9126 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9127 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9128
9129 .next
9130 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9131 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9132 can only return a single list of local parts.
9133 .endlist
9134
9135 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9136 in these two examples:
9137 .code
9138 senders = +my_list
9139 senders = *@+my_list
9140 .endd
9141 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9142 example it is a named domain list.
9143
9144
9145
9146
9147 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9148 .cindex "case of local parts"
9149 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9150 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9151 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9152 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9153 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9154 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9155 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9156 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9157 default.
9158
9159 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9160 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9161 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9162 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9163 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9164 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9165 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9166 case-independent.
9167
9168 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9169 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9170 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9171 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9172 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9173 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9174 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9175 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9176
9177
9178
9179 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9180 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9181 .cindex "local part" "list"
9182 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9183 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9184 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9185 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9186 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9187 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9188 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9189 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9190
9191 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9192 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9193 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9194 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9195 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9196 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9197 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9198 types.
9199 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9200
9201
9202
9203
9204 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9206
9207 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9208 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9209 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9210 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9211
9212 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9213 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9214 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9215 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9216 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9217 escape character, as described in the following section.
9218
9219 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9220 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9221 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9222 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9223 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9224 reasons,
9225 .new
9226 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9227 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9228 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9229 is not permitted.
9230 .wen
9231
9232
9233
9234 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9235 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9236 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9237 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9238 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9239 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9240 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9241 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9242
9243 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9244 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9245 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9246 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9247 .code
9248 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9249 .endd
9250 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9251 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9252 string.
9253
9254
9255
9256 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9257 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9258 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9259 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9260 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9261 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9262 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9263 encoding.
9264
9265 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9266 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9267 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9268
9269
9270 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9271 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9272 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9273 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9274 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9275 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9276 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9277 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9278 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9279 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9280 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9281 and &%nhash%&.
9282
9283 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9284 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9285 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9286
9287 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9288 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9289 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9290 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9291 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9292 .code
9293 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9294 .endd
9295 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9296 Exim message identifier. For example:
9297 .code
9298 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9299 .endd
9300 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9301 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9302
9303
9304 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9305 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9306 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9307 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9308 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9309 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9310 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9311 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9312 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9313 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9314 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9315 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9316 being expanded.
9317
9318
9319
9320
9321 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9322 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9323 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9324 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9325 white space is significant.
9326
9327 .vlist
9328 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9329 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9330 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9331 .code
9332 $local_part
9333 ${domain}
9334 .endd
9335 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9336 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9337 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9338 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9339 given, the expansion fails.
9340
9341 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9342 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9343 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9344 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9345 .code
9346 ${lc:$local_part}
9347 .endd
9348 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9349 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9350 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9351 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9352 string easier to understand.
9353
9354 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9355 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9356 expansion item below.
9357
9358
9359 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9360 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9361 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9362 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9363 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9364 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9365 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9366 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9367 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9368 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9369 the result of the expansion.
9370 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9371 the expansion result is an empty string.
9372 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9373
9374
9375 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9376 .cindex authentication "results header"
9377 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9378 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9379 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9380 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9381 header line.
9382 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9383 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9384 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9385 .code
9386 none
9387 iprev
9388 auth
9389 spf
9390 dkim
9391 .endd
9392
9393 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9394 .code
9395 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9396 .endd
9397 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9398
9399
9400 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9401 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9402 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9403 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9404 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9405 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9406 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9407 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9408 .display
9409 &`version `&
9410 &`serial_number `&
9411 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9412 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9413 &`notbefore `& time
9414 &`notafter `& time
9415 &`sig_algorithm `&
9416 &`signature `&
9417 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9418 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9419 &`crl_uri `& list
9420 .endd
9421 If the field is found,
9422 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9423 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9424 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9425 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9426
9427 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9428 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9429 extracted is used.
9430
9431 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9432
9433 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9434 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9435 not quite
9436 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9437 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9438 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9439 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9440 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9441 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9442 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9443 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9444
9445 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9446 take an optional modifier of "int"
9447 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9448 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9449 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9450
9451 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9452 newline-separated by default,
9453 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9454 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9455 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9456
9457 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9458 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9459 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9460 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9461 if so the element tags are omitted.
9462
9463 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9464
9465 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9466 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9467 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9468 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9469 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9470 .code
9471 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9472 .endd
9473 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9474 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9475 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9476
9477 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9478 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9479 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9480 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9481 must have the following type:
9482 .code
9483 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9484 .endd
9485 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9486 function should return one of the following values:
9487
9488 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9489 into the expanded string that is being built.
9490
9491 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9492 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9493
9494 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9495 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9496
9497 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9498
9499 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9500 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9501 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9502
9503
9504 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9505 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9506 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9507 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9508 removed.
9509 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9510 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9511 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9512
9513 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9514 appear, for example:
9515 .code
9516 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9517 .endd
9518 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9519 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9520
9521 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9522 search failure.
9523 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9524 search success.
9525
9526 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9527 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9528
9529
9530 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9531 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9532 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9533 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9534 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9535 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9536 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9537 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9538 .display
9539 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9540 .endd
9541 .vindex "&$value$&"
9542 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9543 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9544 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9545 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9546 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9547 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9548 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9549 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9550 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9551
9552 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9553 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9554 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9555 yield &"2001"&:
9556 .code
9557 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9558 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9559 .endd
9560 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9561 appear, for example:
9562 .code
9563 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9564 .endd
9565 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9566 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9567
9568 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9569 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9570 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9571 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9572 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9573 .cindex JSON expansions
9574 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9575 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9576 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9577 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9578 .display
9579 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9580 .endd
9581 .vindex "&$value$&"
9582 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9583 the spaces are optional.
9584 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9585 For the &"json"& variant,
9586 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9587 trailing quotes.
9588 .new
9589 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9590 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9591 .wen
9592 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9593
9594 The results of matching are handled as above.
9595
9596
9597 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9598 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9599 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9600 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9601 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9602 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9603 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9604 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9605 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9606 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9607 <&'string3'&> as before.
9608
9609 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9610 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9611 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9612 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9613 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9614 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9615 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9616 provided. For example:
9617 .code
9618 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9619 .endd
9620 yields &"42"&, and
9621 .code
9622 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9623 .endd
9624 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9625 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9626
9627
9628 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9629 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9630 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9631 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9632 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9633 .cindex JSON expansions
9634 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9635 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9636
9637 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9638 there is no choice of field separator.
9639 For the &"json"& variant,
9640 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9641 trailing quotes.
9642 .new
9643 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9644 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9645 .wen
9646
9647
9648 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9649 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9650 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9651 .vindex "&$item$&"
9652 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9653 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9654 For each item
9655 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9656 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9657 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9658 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9659 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9660 .code
9661 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9662 .endd
9663 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9664 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9665
9666
9667 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9668 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9669 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9670 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9671 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9672 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9673
9674 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9675 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9676 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9677 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9678 .code
9679 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9680 .endd
9681 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9682 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9683 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9684 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9685 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9686 .code
9687 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9688 .endd
9689 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9690 letters appear. For example:
9691 .display
9692 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9693 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9694 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9695 .endd
9696
9697 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9698 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9699 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9700 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9701 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9702 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9703 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9704 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9705 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9706 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9707 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9708 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9709 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9710 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9711 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9712 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9713 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9714 .code
9715 $header_reply-to:
9716 .endd
9717 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9718 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9719 lines) may be present.
9720
9721 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9722 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9723
9724 .ilist
9725 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9726 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9727 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9728
9729 .next
9730 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9731 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9732 are multiple headers with a given name.
9733 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9734 list-processing facilities can be used.
9735 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9736 the content is &"raw"&.
9737
9738 .next
9739 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9740 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9741 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9742 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9743 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9744 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9745 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9746 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9747
9748 .next
9749 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9750 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9751 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9752 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9753 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9754 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9755 .endlist ilist
9756
9757 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9758 command of the following form:
9759 .code
9760 headers charset "UTF-8"
9761 .endd
9762 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9763 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9764 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9765 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9766 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9767 ISO-8859-1.
9768
9769 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9770 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9771 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9772 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9773
9774 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9775 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9776 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9777 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9778 router or transport are not accessible.
9779
9780 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9781 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9782 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9783 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9784 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9785 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9786 point they are added.
9787 When any of the above ACLs ar
9788 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9789
9790 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9791 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9792 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9793 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9794 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9795 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9796 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9797 header.)
9798
9799 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9800 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9801 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9802 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9803 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9804 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9805 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9806 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9807
9808
9809 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9810 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9811 .cindex &%hmac%&
9812 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9813 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9814 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9815 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9816 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9817 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9818 present. For example:
9819 .code
9820 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9821 .endd
9822 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9823 produces:
9824 .code
9825 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9826 .endd
9827 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9828 an Exim configuration:
9829 .code
9830 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9831 .endd
9832 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9833 .code
9834 headers_add = \
9835 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9836 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9837 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9838 .endd
9839 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9840 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9841 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9842 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9843 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9844 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9845
9846
9847 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9848 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9849 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9850 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9851 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9852 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9853 .code
9854 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9855 .endd
9856 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9857 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9858 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9859 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9860 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9861
9862 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9863 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9864 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9865 .code
9866 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9867 .endd
9868 you can use
9869 .code
9870 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9871 .endd
9872
9873
9874
9875 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9876 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9877 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9878 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9879 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9880 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9881
9882
9883
9884 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9885 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9886 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9887 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9888 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9889 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9890 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9891 some of the braces:
9892 .code
9893 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9894 .endd
9895 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9896 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9897 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9898 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9899
9900
9901 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9902 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9903 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9904 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9905 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9906 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9907 apart from an optional leading minus,
9908 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9909
9910 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9911 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9912
9913 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9914 If the number is negative, the fields are
9915 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9916 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9917 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9918
9919 If the modulus of the
9920 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9921 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9922
9923 For example:
9924 .code
9925 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9926 .endd
9927 yields &"42"&, and
9928 .code
9929 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9930 .endd
9931 yields &"result: 42"&.
9932
9933 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9934 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9935 extracted is used.
9936 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9937
9938
9939 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9940 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9941 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9942 described in the next item.
9943
9944 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9945 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9946 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9947 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9948 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9949 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9950 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9951 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9952 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9953
9954 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9955 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9956 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9957 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9958 out by the system administrator.
9959
9960 .vindex "&$value$&"
9961 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9962 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9963 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9964 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9965 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9966 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9967 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9968 original lookup fails.
9969
9970 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9971 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9972 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9973 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9974 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9975 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9976 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9977 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9978
9979 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9980 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9981 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9982 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9983
9984 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9985 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9986 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9987 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9988
9989 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9990 .code
9991 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9992 .endd
9993 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9994 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9995 .code
9996 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9997 {$value}fail}
9998 .endd
9999
10000
10001 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10002 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10003 .vindex "&$item$&"
10004 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10005 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10006 For each item
10007 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10008 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10009 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10010 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10011 .code
10012 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10013 .endd
10014 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10015 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
10016 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
10017
10018 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10019 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10020 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10021 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10022 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10023 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10024 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10025 .code
10026 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10027 .endd
10028 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10029 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10030 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10031 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10032 example,
10033 .code
10034 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10035 .endd
10036 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10037
10038
10039
10040 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10041 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10042 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10043 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10044 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10045 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10046 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10047 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10048
10049 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10050 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10051 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10052 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10053 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10054 not its contents.
10055
10056 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10057 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10058 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10059
10060 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10061 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10062
10063
10064 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10065 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10066 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10067 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10068 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10069 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10070 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10071 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10072
10073 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10074 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10075 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10076 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10077 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10078 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10079 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10080 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10081 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10082 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10083
10084 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10085 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10086 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10087 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10088
10089 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10090 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10091 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10092 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10093 is the expansion of the third argument.
10094
10095 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10096 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10097 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10098
10099 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10100 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10101 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10102 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10103 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10104 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10105 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10106 newlines are left in the string.
10107 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10108 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10109 the string expansion fails.
10110
10111 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10112 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10113
10114
10115
10116 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10117 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10118 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10119 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10120 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10121 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10122 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10123 examples:
10124 .code
10125 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10126 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10127 .endd
10128 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10129 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10130 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10131 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10132 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10133 example:
10134 .code
10135 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10136 .endd
10137 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10138 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10139 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10140 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10141 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10142 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10143 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10144 .code
10145 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10146 .endd
10147
10148 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10149 and must be present if the argument is given.
10150 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10151 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10152 The first defines whether (the default)
10153 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10154 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10155 .code
10156 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10157 .endd
10158 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10159 .code
10160 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10161 .endd
10162 The default is to not use TLS.
10163 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10164
10165 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10166 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10167 turns them into spaces:
10168 .code
10169 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10170 .endd
10171 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10172 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10173 addition, the following errors can occur:
10174
10175 .ilist
10176 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10177 .next
10178 Failure to connect the socket;
10179 .next
10180 Failure to write the request string;
10181 .next
10182 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10183 .endlist
10184
10185 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10186 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10187 errors occurs. For example:
10188 .code
10189 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10190 {socket failure}}
10191 .endd
10192 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10193 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10194 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10195 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10196 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10197
10198 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10199 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10200
10201
10202 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10203 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10204 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10205 .vindex "&$value$&"
10206 .vindex "&$item$&"
10207 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10208 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10209 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10210 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10211 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10212 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10213 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10214 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10215 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10216 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10217 .code
10218 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10219 .endd
10220 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10221 can be found:
10222 .code
10223 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10224 .endd
10225 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10226 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10227 expansion items.
10228
10229 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10230 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10231 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10232
10233 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10234 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10235 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10236 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10237 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10238 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10239 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10240 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10241 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10242
10243 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10244 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10245 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10246 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10247 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10248 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10249 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10250 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10251 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10252 character.
10253
10254 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10255 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10256 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10257 .vindex "&$value$&"
10258 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10259 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10260 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10261 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10262 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10263 &$value$&.
10264
10265 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10266 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10267 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10268 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10269
10270 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10271 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10272 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10273 troubleshoot:
10274 .code
10275 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10276 log_message = Output of id: $value
10277 .endd
10278 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10279 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10280 .code
10281 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10282 .endd
10283
10284 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10285 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10286 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10287 .code
10288 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10289 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10290 ...
10291 endif
10292 .endd
10293 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10294 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10295 commands.
10296
10297 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10298 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10299 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10300 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10301
10302 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10303 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10304
10305
10306 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10307 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10308 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10309 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10310 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10311 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10312 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10313 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10314 .code
10315 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10316 .endd
10317 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10318 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10319 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10320 .code
10321 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10322 .endd
10323 yields &"defabc"&, and
10324 .code
10325 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10326 .endd
10327 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10328 the regular expression from string expansion.
10329
10330 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10331 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10332
10333
10334 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10335 .cindex sorting "a list"
10336 .cindex list sorting
10337 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10338 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10339 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10340 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10341 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10342 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10343 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10344 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10345 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10346 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10347 to give values for comparison.
10348
10349 The item result is a sorted list,
10350 with the original list separator,
10351 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10352
10353 Examples:
10354 .code
10355 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10356 .endd
10357 sorts a list of numbers, and
10358 .code
10359 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10360 .endd
10361 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10362
10363
10364 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10365 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10366 .cindex "substring extraction"
10367 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10368 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10369 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10370 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10371 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10372 .code
10373 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10374 .endd
10375 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10376 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10377 omitted.
10378
10379 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10380 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10381 length required. For example
10382 .code
10383 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10384 .endd
10385 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10386 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10387 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10388 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10389
10390 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10391 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10392 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10393 .code
10394 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10395 .endd
10396 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10397 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10398 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10399 .code
10400 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10401 .endd
10402 yields an empty string, but
10403 .code
10404 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10405 .endd
10406 yields &"1"&.
10407
10408 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10409 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10410 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10411 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10412 .code
10413 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10414 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10415 .endd
10416 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10417
10418 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10419
10420
10421
10422 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10423 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10424 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10425 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10426 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10427 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10428 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10429 replacement list. For example
10430 .code
10431 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10432 .endd
10433 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10434 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10435 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10436 place.
10437
10438 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10439
10440 .endlist
10441
10442
10443
10444 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10445 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10446 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10447 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10448 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10449 following operations can be performed:
10450
10451 .vlist
10452 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10453 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10454 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10455 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10456 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10457 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10458
10459 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10460
10461
10462 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10463 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10464 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10465 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10466 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10467 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10468 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10469 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10470 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10471
10472 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10473 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10474 character. For example:
10475 .code
10476 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10477 .endd
10478 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10479 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10480 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10481 separator explicitly:
10482 .code
10483 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10484 .endd
10485
10486 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10487 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10488 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10489 processing lists.
10490
10491 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10492 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10493 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10494 email address separator. For the example header line:
10495 .code
10496 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10497 .endd
10498 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10499 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10500 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10501 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10502 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10503 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10504 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10505 .code
10506 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10507 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10508 user@example.com
10509 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10510 Last:user@example.com
10511 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10512 user@example.com
10513 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10514 フィリップ@example.jp
10515 .endd
10516
10517 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10518 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10519 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10520 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10521 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10522 Only lowercase letters are used.
10523
10524 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10526 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10527 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10528 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10529
10530 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10531 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10532 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10533 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10534 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10535 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10536 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10537 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10538 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10539
10540 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10542 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10543 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10544 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10545 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10546 string.
10547
10548 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10549 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10550 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10551 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10552 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10553 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10554
10555 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10556 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10557
10558
10559 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10560 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10561 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10562 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10563 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10564
10565
10566 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10567 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10568 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10569 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10570 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10571
10572
10573 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10575 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10576 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10577 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10578 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10579 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10580
10581 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10583 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10584 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10585 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10586 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10587
10588
10589 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10590 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10591 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10592 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10593 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10594 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10595 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10596 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10597 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10598 C programming language):
10599 .table2 70pt 300pt
10600 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10601 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10602 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10603 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10604 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10605 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10606 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10607 .endtable
10608 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10609 space is permitted before or after operators.
10610
10611 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10612 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10613 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10614 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10615 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10616
10617 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10618 or 1024*1024*1024,
10619 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10620 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10621
10622 .display
10623 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10624 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10625 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10626 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10627 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10628 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10629 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10630 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10631 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10632 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10633 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10634 .endd
10635
10636 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10637 .code
10638 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10639 condition = \
10640 ${if and { \
10641 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10642 { \
10643 < \
10644 {$recipients_count} \
10645 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10646 } \
10647 }{yes}{no}}
10648 .endd
10649 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10650 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10651
10652
10653 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10655 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10656 example,
10657 .code
10658 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10659 .endd
10660 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10661 and then re-expands what it has found.
10662
10663
10664 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10665 .cindex "Unicode"
10666 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10667 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10668 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10669 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10670 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10671 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10672 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10673 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10674 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10675
10676 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10677 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10678 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10679 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10680 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10681 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10682 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10683
10684
10685 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10686 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10687 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10688 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10689 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10690 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10691 .code
10692 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10693 .endd
10694 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10695 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10696
10697
10698
10699 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10701 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10702 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10703 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10704 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10705
10706
10707
10708 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10709 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10710 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10711 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10712 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10713 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10714 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10715
10716
10717 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10719 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10720 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10721 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10722 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10723 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10724
10725 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10726 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10727 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10728 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10729 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10730 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10731 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10732 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10733 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10734
10735
10736 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10738 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10739 .cindex "lower casing"
10740 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10741 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10742 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10743 .code
10744 ${lc:$local_part}
10745 .endd
10746 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10747
10748 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10749 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10750 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10751 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10752 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10753 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10754 .code
10755 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10756 .endd
10757 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10758 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10759 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10760 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10761
10762
10763 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10764 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10765 .cindex "list" "item count"
10766 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10767 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10768 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10769
10770
10771 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10772 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10773 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10774 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10775 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10776 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10777 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10778 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10779 matching list is returned.
10780
10781
10782 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10783 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10784 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10785 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10786 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10787 empty.
10788 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10789
10790
10791 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10792 .cindex "masked IP address"
10793 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10794 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10795 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10796 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10797 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10798 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10799 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10800 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10801 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10802 .code
10803 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10804 .endd
10805 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10806 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10807 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10808 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10809 .code
10810 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10811 .endd
10812 returns the string
10813 .code
10814 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10815 .endd
10816 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10817
10818
10819 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10820 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10821 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10822 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10823 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10824 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10825 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10826
10827 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10828 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10829
10830
10831 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10832 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10833 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10834 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10835 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10836 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10837 .code
10838 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10839 .endd
10840 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10841
10842
10843 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10844 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10845 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10846 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10847 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10848 is an empty string or
10849 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10850 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10851 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10852 respectively For example,
10853 .code
10854 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10855 .endd
10856 becomes
10857 .code
10858 "ab\"*\"cd"
10859 .endd
10860 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10861 variable or a message header.
10862
10863 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10864 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10865 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10866 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10867 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10868 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10869 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10870
10871 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10872 will likely use the quoting form.
10873 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10874
10875
10876 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10878 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10879 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10880 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10881 .code
10882 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10883 .endd
10884 returns
10885 .code
10886 two%20%5C2A%20two
10887 .endd
10888 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10889 yields an unchanged string.
10890
10891
10892 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10893 .cindex "random number"
10894 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10895 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10896 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10897 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10898 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10899 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10900 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10901 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10902 random().
10903
10904
10905 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10906 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10907 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10908 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10909 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10910 for DNS. For example,
10911 .code
10912 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10913 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10914 .endd
10915 returns
10916 .code
10917 4.2.0.192
10918 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10919 .endd
10920
10921
10922 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10923 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10924 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10925 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10926 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10927 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10928 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10929 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10930 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10931 characters
10932 .code
10933 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10934 .endd
10935 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10936 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10937 characters.
10938
10939
10940 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10941 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10942 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10943 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10944 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10945 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10946 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10947 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10948
10949 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10950 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10951 to use this operator as well.
10952
10953
10954
10955 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10956 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10957 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10958 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10959 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10960 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10961 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10962
10963
10964 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10965 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10966 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10967 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10968 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10969 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10970 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10971
10972 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10973 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10974
10975
10976 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10977 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10978 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10979 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10980 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10981 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10982 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10983 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10984 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10985 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10986 and returns
10987 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10988
10989 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10990 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10991
10992 .new
10993 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
10994 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
10995 Finally, if an underbar
10996 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
10997 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
10998 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
10999 .wen
11000
11001
11002 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11003 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11004 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11005 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11006 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11007 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11008 and returns
11009 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11010
11011 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11012 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11013 with 256 being the default.
11014
11015 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11016 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11017 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11018 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11019
11020
11021 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11022 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11023 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11024 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11025 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11026 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11027 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11028 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11029 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11030 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11031 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11032 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11033 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11034
11035 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11036 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11037 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11038
11039 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11040 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11041 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11042
11043
11044
11045 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11046 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11047 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11048 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11049 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11050 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11051 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11052
11053
11054 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11055 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11056 .cindex "substring extraction"
11057 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11058 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11059 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11060 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11061 .code
11062 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11063 .endd
11064 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11065 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11066 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11067
11068 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11069 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11070 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11071 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11072 seconds.
11073
11074 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11076 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11077 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11078 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11079 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11080 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11081
11082 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11084 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11085 .cindex "upper casing"
11086 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11087 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11088 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11089 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11090
11091 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11092 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11093 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11094 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11095 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11096 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11097 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11098 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11099 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11100 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11101 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11102 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11103 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11104 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11105 .code
11106 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11107 .endd
11108 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11109 literal question mark).
11110
11111 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11112 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11113 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11114 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11115 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11116 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11117 .cindex EAI
11118 .cindex internationalisation
11119 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11120 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11121 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11122 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11123 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11124 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11125 .endlist
11126
11127
11128
11129
11130
11131
11132 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11133 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11134 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11135 while expanding strings:
11136
11137 .vlist
11138 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11139 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11140 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11141 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11142 condition.
11143
11144 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11145 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11146 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11147 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11148 are:
11149 .display
11150 &`= `& equal
11151 &`== `& equal
11152 &`> `& greater
11153 &`>= `& greater or equal
11154 &`< `& less
11155 &`<= `& less or equal
11156 .endd
11157 For example:
11158 .code
11159 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11160 .endd
11161 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11162 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11163 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11164 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11165 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11166 zero.
11167
11168 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11169 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11170 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11171
11172
11173 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11174 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11175 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11176 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11177 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11178 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11179 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11180 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11181 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11182 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11183 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11184 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11185 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11186 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11187
11188 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11189 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11190 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11191 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11192 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11193 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11194 false if zero.
11195 An empty string is treated as false.
11196 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11197 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11198 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11199
11200 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11201 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11202 For example:
11203 .code
11204 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11205 .endd
11206
11207
11208 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11209 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11210 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11211 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11212 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11213 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11214 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11215 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11216
11217 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11218
11219 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11220 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11221 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11222 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11223 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11224 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11225 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11226 included in the binary.
11227
11228 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11229 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11230 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11231 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11232 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11233 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11234 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11235 string in LDAP form is:
11236 .code
11237 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11238 .endd
11239 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11240 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11241 .code
11242 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11243 .endd
11244 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11245 supported:
11246
11247 .ilist
11248 .cindex "MD5 hash"
11249 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11250 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11251 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11252 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11253 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11254 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11255 comparison fails.
11256
11257 .next
11258 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11259 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11260 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11261 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11262 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11263 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11264
11265 .next
11266 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11267 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11268 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11269 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11270 whatever its length.
11271
11272 .next
11273 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11274 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11275 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11276 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11277 .endlist
11278 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11279 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11280 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11281 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11282 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11283 support &[crypt16()]&.
11284
11285 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11286 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11287 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11288 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11289 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11290
11291 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11292 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11293 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11294
11295 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11296 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11297 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11298 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11299 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11300
11301 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11302 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11303 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11304 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11305 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11306 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11307 .code
11308 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11309 .endd
11310 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11311 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11312
11313 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11314 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11315 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11316 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11317 exists in the message. For example,
11318 .code
11319 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11320 .endd
11321 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11322 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11323
11324 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11325 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11326 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11327 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11328 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11329 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11330 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11331 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11332 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11333 case is defined per the system C locale.
11334
11335 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11336 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11337 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11338 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11339 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11340 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11341 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11342 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11343
11344 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11345 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11346 .cindex "first delivery"
11347 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11348 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11349 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11350 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11351
11352
11353 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11354 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11355 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11356 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11357 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11358 .vindex "&$item$&"
11359 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11360 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11361 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11362 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11363 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11364 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11365 .ilist
11366 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11367 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11368 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11369 .next
11370 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11371 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11372 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11373 .endlist
11374 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11375 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11376 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11377 list separator is changed to a comma:
11378 .code
11379 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11380 .endd
11381 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11382 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11383
11384 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11385
11386 .new
11387 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11388 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11389 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11390 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11391 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11392 .cindex JSON expansions
11393 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11394 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11395 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11396 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11397 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11398 be a JSON array.
11399 The array separator is not changeable.
11400 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11401 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11402 .wen
11403
11404
11405
11406 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11407 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11408 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11409 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11410 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11411 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11412 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11413 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11414 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11415 case-independent.
11416 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11417
11418 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11419 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11420 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11421 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11422 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11423 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11424 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11425 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11426 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11427 case-independent.
11428 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11429
11430 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11431 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11432 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11433 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11434 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11435 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11436 is true.
11437 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11438
11439 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11440 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11441 .code
11442 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11443 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11444 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11445 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11446 .endd
11447
11448 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11449 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11450 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11451 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11452 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11453 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11454 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11455 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11456 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11457 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11458 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11459
11460 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11461 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11462 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11463 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11464 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11465
11466 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11467 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11468 check.
11469 This is no longer the case.
11470
11471 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11472 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11473 .code
11474 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11475 .endd
11476 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11477
11478 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11479 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11480 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11481 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11482 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11483 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11484 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11485 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11486 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11487 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11488 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11489 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11490 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11491 this can be used.
11492
11493
11494 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11495 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11496 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11497 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11498 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11499 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11500 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11501 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11502 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11503 case-independent.
11504 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11505
11506 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11507 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11508 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11509 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11510 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11511 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11512 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11513 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11514 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11515 case-independent.
11516 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11517
11518
11519 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11520 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11521 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11522 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11523 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11524 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11525 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11526 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11527 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11528 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11529 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11530 For example,
11531 .code
11532 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11533 .endd
11534 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11535 backslashes is also required.
11536
11537 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11538 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11539 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11540 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11541 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11542 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11543 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11544 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11545
11546 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11547 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11548 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11549 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11550 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11551 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11552 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11553 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11554
11555 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11556 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11557 See &*match_local_part*&.
11558
11559 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11560 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11561 See &*match_local_part*&.
11562
11563 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11564 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11565 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11566 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11567 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11568 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11569 .code
11570 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11571 .endd
11572 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11573
11574 .ilist
11575 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11576 .next
11577 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11578 .next
11579 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11580 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11581 in a single test such as
11582 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11583 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11584 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11585 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11586 .code
11587 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11588 .endd
11589 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11590 .next
11591 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11592 .next
11593 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11594 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11595 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11596 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11597 masks. For example:
11598 .code
11599 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11600 .endd
11601 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11602 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11603 address mask, for example:
11604 .code
11605 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11606 .endd
11607 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11608 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11609 .code
11610 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11611 .endd
11612 .endlist ilist
11613
11614 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11615 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11616
11617 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11618
11619 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11620 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11621 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11622 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11623 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11624 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11625 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11626 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11627 example is:
11628 .code
11629 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11630 .endd
11631 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11632 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11633 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11634 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11635 .code
11636 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11637 .endd
11638 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11639 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11640 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11641 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11642 caselessly.
11643
11644 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11645 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11646
11647 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11648 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11649 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11650 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11651
11652 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11653 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11654 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11655 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11656 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11657 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11658 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11659 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11660 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11661 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11662 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11663 .code
11664 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11665 .endd
11666 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11667 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11668
11669 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11670 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11671 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11672 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11673 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11674 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11675 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11676
11677 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11678 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11679 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11680 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11681 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11682 .code
11683 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11684 .endd
11685 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11686 .code
11687 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11688 .endd
11689 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11690 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11691 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11692 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11693
11694
11695 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11696 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11697 .cindex "Cyrus"
11698 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11699 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11700 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11701 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11702 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11703 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11704
11705 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11706 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11707 building Exim. For example:
11708 .code
11709 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11710 .endd
11711 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11712 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11713 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11714 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11715
11716 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11717 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11718 configuration, you might have this:
11719 .code
11720 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11721 .endd
11722 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11723 .code
11724 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11725 .endd
11726 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11727 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11728 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11729 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11730 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11731 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11732
11733
11734 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11735 .cindex "Radius"
11736 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11737 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11738 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11739 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11740 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11741 support.
11742
11743 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11744 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11745 this library, you need to set
11746 .code
11747 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11748 .endd
11749 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11750 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11751 .code
11752 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11753 .endd
11754 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11755 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11756 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11757
11758 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11759 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11760 the authentication is successful. For example:
11761 .code
11762 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11763 .endd
11764
11765
11766 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11767 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11768 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11769 .cindex "Cyrus"
11770 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11771 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11772 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11773 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11774 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11775 by a process that is not running as root.
11776
11777 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11778 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11779 building Exim. For example:
11780 .code
11781 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11782 .endd
11783 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11784 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11785 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11786
11787 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11788 two are mandatory. For example:
11789 .code
11790 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11791 .endd
11792 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11793 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11794 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11795 .endlist vlist
11796
11797
11798
11799 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11800 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11801 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11802 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11803 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11804 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11805 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11806
11807
11808 .vlist
11809 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11810 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11811 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11812 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11813 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11814 For example,
11815 .code
11816 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11817 .endd
11818 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11819 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11820 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11821
11822 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11823 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11824 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11825 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11826 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11827 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11828 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11829 parsed but not evaluated.
11830 .endlist
11831 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11832
11833
11834
11835
11836 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11837 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11838 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11839 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11840 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11841
11842 .vlist
11843 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11844 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11845 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11846 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11847 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11848 In the expansion condition case
11849 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11850 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11851 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11852 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11853 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11854 matching condition.
11855
11856 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11857 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11858 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11859 any unused variables being made empty.
11860
11861 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11862 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11863 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11864 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11865 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11866 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11867 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11868 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11869 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11870 during subsequent delivery.
11871
11872 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11873 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11874 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11875 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11876 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11877 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11878 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11879 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11880 delivery.
11881
11882 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11883 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11884 this variable has the number of arguments.
11885
11886 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11887 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11888 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11889 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11890 be preserved by coding like this:
11891 .code
11892 warn !verify = sender
11893 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11894 .endd
11895 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11896 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11897 failure.
11898
11899 .vitem &$address_data$&
11900 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11901 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11902 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11903 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11904 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11905 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11906 user filter files.
11907
11908 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11909 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11910 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11911 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11912 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11913 from the child's routing.
11914
11915 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11916 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11917 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11918 address.
11919
11920 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11921 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11922 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11923
11924 .vitem &$address_file$&
11925 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11926 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11927 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11928 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11929 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11930 .code
11931 /home/r2d2/savemail
11932 .endd
11933 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11934 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11935 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11936 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11937 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11938 to the relevant file.
11939
11940 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11941 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11942 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11943 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11944
11945 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11946 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11947 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11948 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11949
11950 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11951 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11952 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11953 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11954 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11955 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11956 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11957 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11958 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11959
11960 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11961 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11962 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11963 command line option.
11964 This second case also sets up information used by the
11965 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11966
11967 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11968 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11969 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11970 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11971 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11972 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11973 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11974 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11975 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11976 the ACL's as well.
11977
11978
11979 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11980 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11981 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11982 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11983 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11984 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11985 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11986 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11987 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11988 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11989 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11990
11991 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11992 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11993 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11994 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11995 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11996
11997
11998 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11999 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12000 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12001 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12002 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12003 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12004 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12005 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12006 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12007 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12008 an undefined mechanism.
12009
12010 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12011 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12012 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12013 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12014 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12015 the ACL malware condition.
12016
12017 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12018 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12019 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12020 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12021 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12022 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12023
12024 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12025 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12026 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12027 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12028 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12029 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12030 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12031
12032 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12033 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12034 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12035 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12036 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12037
12038 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12039 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12040 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12041 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12042 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12043
12044 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12045 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12046 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12047 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12048 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12049 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12050 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12051
12052 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12053 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12054 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12055 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12056 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12057 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12058 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12059
12060 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12061 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12062 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12063 address that was connected to.
12064
12065 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12066 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12067 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12068 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12069 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12070
12071 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12072 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12073 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12074 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12075 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12076 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12077
12078 .vitem &$config_file$&
12079 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12080 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12081
12082 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12083 Results of DKIM verification.
12084 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12085
12086 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12087 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12088 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12089 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12090 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12091 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12092 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12093 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12094 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12095 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12096 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12097 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12098 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12099 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12100 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12101 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12102 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12103 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12104 &$dkim_key_length$&
12105 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12106 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12107
12108 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12109 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12110 When a message has been received this variable contains
12111 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12112 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12113
12114 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12115 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12116 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12117 &$dnslist_value$&
12118 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12119 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12120 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12121 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12122 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12123 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12124 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12125 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12126 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12127
12128 .vitem &$domain$&
12129 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12130 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12131 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12132 case for &$domain$&.
12133
12134 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12135 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12136 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12137 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12138
12139 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12140 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12141 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12142 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12143 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12144 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12145
12146 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12147 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12148 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12149
12150 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12151
12152 .ilist
12153 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12154 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12155 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12156 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12157 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12158 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12159 the &(smtp)& transport.
12160
12161 .next
12162 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12163 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12164 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12165 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12166
12167 .next
12168 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12169 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12170 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12171 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12172 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12173 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12174
12175 .next
12176 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12177 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12178 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12179 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12180 .endlist
12181
12182
12183 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12184 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12185 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12186 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12187 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12188 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12189 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12190 used.
12191
12192 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12193 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12194 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12195 to nothing.
12196
12197 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12198 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12199 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12200
12201 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12202 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12203 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12204
12205 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12206 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12207 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12208
12209 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12210 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12211 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12212 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12213 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12214 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12215 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12216
12217 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12218 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12219 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12220 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12221 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12222 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12223
12224 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12225 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12226 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12227 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12228 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12229
12230 .vitem &$home$&
12231 .vindex "&$home$&"
12232 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12233 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12234 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12235 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12236 by a setting on the transport itself.
12237
12238 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12239 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12240 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12241
12242 .vitem &$host$&
12243 .vindex "&$host$&"
12244 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12245 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12246 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12247 to local and remote transports.
12248
12249 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12250 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12251 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12252 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12253 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12254 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12255 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12256 is connected.
12257
12258 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12259 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12260 client is connected.
12261
12262
12263 .vitem &$host_address$&
12264 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12265 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12266 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12267 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12268
12269 .vitem &$host_data$&
12270 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12271 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12272 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12273 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12274 .code
12275 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12276 message = $host_data
12277 .endd
12278 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12279 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12280 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12281 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12282 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12283 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12284 variables is set to &"1"&.
12285
12286 .ilist
12287 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12288 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12289
12290 .next
12291 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12292 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12293 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12294 .endlist ilist
12295
12296 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12297 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12298 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12299 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12300 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12301 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12302 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12303 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12304 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12305 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12306
12307 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12308 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12309 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12310
12311
12312 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12313 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12314 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12315
12316 .vitem &$host_port$&
12317 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12318 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12319 for an outbound connection.
12320
12321 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12322 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12323 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12324 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12325 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12326 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12327
12328 .vitem &$inode$&
12329 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12330 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12331 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12332 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12333 a unique name for the file.
12334
12335 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12336 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12337 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12338
12339 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12340 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12341 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12342
12343 .vitem &$item$&
12344 .vindex "&$item$&"
12345 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12346 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12347 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12348 empty.
12349
12350 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12351 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12352 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12353 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12354 lookup.
12355
12356 .vitem &$load_average$&
12357 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12358 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12359 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12360 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12361
12362 .vitem &$local_part$&
12363 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12364 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12365 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12366 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12367 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12368
12369 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12370 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12371 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12372 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12373 once.
12374
12375 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12376 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12377 .cindex affix variables
12378 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12379 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12380 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12381 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12382
12383 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12384 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12385 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12386 &$address_pipe$&).
12387
12388 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12389 local part of the recipient address.
12390
12391 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12392 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12393 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12394
12395 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12396 the addresses
12397 .code
12398 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12399 abc\:xyz@test.example
12400 .endd
12401 the value of &$local_part$& is
12402 .code
12403 abc:xyz
12404 .endd
12405 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12406 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12407 have:
12408 .code
12409 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12410 .endd
12411 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12412 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12413 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12414
12415 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12416 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12417 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12418 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12419 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12420 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12421 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12422
12423 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12424 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12425 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12426 variable expands to nothing.
12427
12428 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12429 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12430 .cindex affix variables
12431 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12432 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12433 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12434
12435 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12436 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12437 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12438 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12439 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12440
12441 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12442 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12443 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12444 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12445
12446 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12447 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12448 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12449
12450 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12451 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12452 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12453 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12454 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12455 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12456 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12457 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12458
12459 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12460 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12461 This contains the expanded value of the
12462 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12463 been read.
12464
12465 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12466 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12467 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12468 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12469 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12470 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12471
12472 .vitem &$log_space$&
12473 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12474 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12475 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12476 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12477 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12478 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12479
12480
12481 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12482 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12483 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12484 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12485 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12486 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12487 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12488 and &"yes"& if it was.
12489 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12490 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12491 as authenticated data.
12492
12493 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12494 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12495 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12496 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12497 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12498 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12499 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12500 variable is empty.
12501
12502 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12503 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12504 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12505 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12506 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12507
12508 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12509 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12510 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12511 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12512 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12513 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12514 character(s).
12515 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12516
12517 .vitem &$message_age$&
12518 .cindex "message" "age of"
12519 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12520 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12521 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12522 delivery attempt.
12523
12524 .vitem &$message_body$&
12525 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12526 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12527 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12528 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12529 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12530 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12531 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12532 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12533 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12534
12535 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12536 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12537 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12538 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12539 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12540
12541 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12542 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12543 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12544 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12545 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12546 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12547 &$message_body$&.
12548
12549 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12550 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12551 .cindex "message body" "size"
12552 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12553 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12554 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12555 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12556 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12557
12558 If the spool file is wireformat
12559 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12560 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12561
12562 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12563 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12564 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12565 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12566 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12567 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12568 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12569 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12570
12571 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12572 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12573 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12574 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12575 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12576 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12577
12578 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12579 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12580 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12581 contents of header lines is done.
12582
12583 .vitem &$message_id$&
12584 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12585
12586 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12587 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12588 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12589 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12590 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12591 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12592 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12593 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12594 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12595 from the body is not counted.
12596
12597 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12598 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12599 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12600 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12601 header and the body).
12602
12603 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12604 .code
12605 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12606 condition = \
12607 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12608 .endd
12609 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12610 message has not yet been received.
12611
12612 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12613
12614 .vitem &$message_size$&
12615 .cindex "size" "of message"
12616 .cindex "message" "size"
12617 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12618 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12619 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12620 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12621 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12622 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12623 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12624 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12625 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12626
12627 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12628 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12629 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12630 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12631
12632 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12633 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12634 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12635 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12636
12637 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12638 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12639 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12640
12641 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12642 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12643 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12644 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12645 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12646 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12647 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12648 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12649 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12650 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12651
12652 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12653 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12654 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12655
12656 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12657 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12658 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12659 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12660 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12661 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12662 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12663 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12664 the original address.
12665
12666 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12667 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12668 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12669 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12670 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12671
12672 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12673 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12674 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12675
12676 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12677 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12678 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12679 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12680 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12681 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12682 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12683 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12684 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12685
12686 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12687 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12688 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12689 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12690 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12691 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12692 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12693 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12694 user.
12695
12696 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12697 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12698 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12699 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12700
12701 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12702 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12703 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12704 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12705
12706 .vitem &$pid$&
12707 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12708 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12709 This variable contains the current process id.
12710
12711 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12712 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12713 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12714 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12715 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12716 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12717 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12718 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12719 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12720 variable"& error if encountered.
12721
12722 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12723 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12724 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12725 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12726 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12727 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12728 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12729
12730
12731 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12732 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12733 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12734 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12735 &$proxy_session$&
12736 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12737 or SOCKS5 support.
12738 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12739
12740 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12741 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12742 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12743 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12744
12745 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12746 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12747 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12748 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12749
12750 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12751 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12752 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12753 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12754
12755 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12756 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12757 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12758 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12759
12760 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12761 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12762 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12763
12764 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12765 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12766 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12767 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12768
12769 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12770 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12771 .cindex "named queues"
12772 .cindex queues named
12773 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12774
12775 .new
12776 .vitem &$r_...$&
12777 .vindex &$r_...$&
12778 .cindex router variables
12779 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12780 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12781 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12782 and the eventual transport.
12783 .wen
12784
12785 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12786 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12787 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12788 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12789 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12790
12791 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12792 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12793 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12794 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12795 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12796 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12797
12798 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12799 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12800 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12801 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12802 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12803
12804 .vitem &$received_count$&
12805 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12806 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12807 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12808 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12809 delivering.
12810
12811 .vitem &$received_for$&
12812 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12813 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12814 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12815 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12816 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12817
12818 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12819 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12820 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12821 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12822 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12823 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12824 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12825 option.
12826
12827 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12828 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12829 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12830 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12831 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12832 time.
12833 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12834
12835 .vitem &$received_port$&
12836 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12837 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12838
12839 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12840 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12841 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12842 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12843 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12844 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12845 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12846 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12847 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12848
12849 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12850 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12851 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12852 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12853 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12854 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12855
12856 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12857 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12858 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12859
12860 .vitem &$received_time$&
12861 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12862 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12863 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12864
12865 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12866 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12867 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12868 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12869 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12870 .display
12871 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12872 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12873 .endd
12874 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12875 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12876 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12877 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12878
12879 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12880 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12881 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12882 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12883
12884 .ilist
12885 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12886 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12887
12888 .next
12889 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12890
12891 .next
12892 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12893 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12894 MAIL).
12895
12896 .next
12897 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12898 .next
12899
12900 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12901 .endlist
12902
12903 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12904 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12905
12906 .vitem &$recipients$&
12907 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12908 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12909 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12910 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12911 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12912 cases:
12913
12914 .olist
12915 In a system filter file.
12916 .next
12917 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12918 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12919 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12920 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12921 .next
12922 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12923 .endlist
12924
12925
12926 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12927 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12928 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12929 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12930 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12931 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12932
12933
12934 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12935 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12936 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12937 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12938
12939 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12940 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12941 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12942 these variables contain the
12943 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12944
12945
12946 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12947 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12948 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12949 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12950 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12951 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12952 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12953
12954 .vitem &$return_path$&
12955 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12956 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12957 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12958 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12959 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12960 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12961 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12962 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12963 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12964 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12965 envelope sender.
12966
12967 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12968 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12969 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12970
12971 .vitem &$router_name$&
12972 .cindex "router" "name"
12973 .cindex "name" "of router"
12974 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12975 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12976
12977 .vitem &$runrc$&
12978 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12979 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12980 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12981 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12982 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12983 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12984 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12985 another.
12986
12987 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12988 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12989 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12990 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12991 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12992 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12993 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12994 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12995
12996 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12997 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12998 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12999 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13000 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13001 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13002
13003 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13004 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13005 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13006 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13007 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13008 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13009 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13010 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13011
13012 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13013 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13014 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13015
13016 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13017 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13018 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13019
13020 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13021 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13022 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13023 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13024 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13025 this:
13026 .display
13027 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13028 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13029 .endd
13030 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13031 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13032 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13033 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13034
13035 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13036 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13037 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13038 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13039 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13040 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13041 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13042 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13043 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13044 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13045 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13046 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13047 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13048
13049 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13050 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13051 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13052 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13053 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13054
13055 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13056 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13057 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13058 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13059 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13060 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13061
13062 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13063 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13064 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13065 this variable contains that
13066 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13067
13068 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13069 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13070 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13071 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13072 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13073 &$authenticated_id$&.
13074
13075 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13076 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13077 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13078 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13079 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13080 resolver library states that both
13081 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13082 other times, this variable is false.
13083
13084 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13085 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13086 library, by setting:
13087 .code
13088 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13089 .endd
13090
13091 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13092 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13093
13094 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13095 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13096
13097 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13098 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13099 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13100 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13101
13102
13103 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13104 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13105 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13106 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13107 other means, this variable is empty.
13108
13109 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13110 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13111 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13112 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13113 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13114 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13115 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13116
13117 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13118 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13119 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13120 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13121
13122 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13123 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13124 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13125 is set to &"1"&.
13126
13127 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13128 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13129 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13130 following are true:
13131
13132 .ilist
13133 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13134 .next
13135 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13136 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13137 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13138 .next
13139 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13140 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13141 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13142 .next
13143 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13144 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13145 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13146 .next
13147 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13148 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13149 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13150 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13151 .code
13152 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13153 .endd
13154 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13155 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13156 .endlist
13157
13158
13159 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13160 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13161 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13162 number that was used on the remote host.
13163
13164 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13165 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13166 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13167 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13168 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13169 called Exim.
13170
13171 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13172 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13173 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13174 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13175
13176 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13177 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13178 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13179 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13180 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13181 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13182 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13183 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13184 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13185 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13186 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13187 the parentheses.
13188
13189 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13190 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13191 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13192 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13193 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13194
13195 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13196 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13197 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13198 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13199 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13200
13201 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13202 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13203 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13204 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13205 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13206 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13207 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13208
13209 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13210 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13211 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13212 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13213 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13214
13215 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13216 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13217 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13218 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13219 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13220 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13221
13222 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13223 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13224 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13225 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13226 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13227 .code
13228 MAIL FROM:<>
13229 MAIL FROM: <>
13230 .endd
13231 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13232 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13233 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13234 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13235
13236 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13237 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13238 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13239 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13240 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13241 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13242 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13243
13244 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13245 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13246 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13247 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13248 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13249 are remembered.
13250
13251 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13252 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13253 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13254 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13255 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13256 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13257 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13258 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13259 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13260 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13261 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13262
13263 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13264 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13265 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13266 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13267 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13268 message is junk mail.
13269
13270 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13271 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13272 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13273 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13274
13275 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13276 &$spf_received$& &&&
13277 &$spf_result$& &&&
13278 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13279 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13280 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13281 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13282
13283 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13284 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13285 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13286
13287 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13288 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13289 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13290 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13291 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13292 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13293
13294 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13295 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13296 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13297 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13298 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13299 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13300 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13301 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13302 .code
13303 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13304 .endd
13305 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13306
13307
13308 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13309 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13310 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13311 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13312 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13313 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13314
13315 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13316 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13317 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13318 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13319 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13320 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13321 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13322 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13323
13324 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13325 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13326 the outbound.
13327
13328 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13329 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13330 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13331 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13332 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13333 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13334
13335 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13336 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13337 .cindex certificate variables
13338 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13339 inbound connection when the message was received.
13340 It is only useful as the argument of a
13341 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13342 or a &%def%& condition.
13343
13344 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13345 when a list of more than one
13346 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13347
13348 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13349 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13350 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13351 inbound connection when the message was received.
13352 It is only useful as the argument of a
13353 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13354 or a &%def%& condition.
13355 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13356 which is not the leaf.
13357
13358 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13359 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13360 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13361 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13362 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13363 or a &%def%& condition.
13364
13365 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13366 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13367 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13368 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13369 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13370 or a &%def%& condition.
13371 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13372 which is not the leaf.
13373
13374 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13375 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13376 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13377 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13378
13379 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13380 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13381 the outbound.
13382
13383 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13384 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13385 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13386 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13387 and &"0"& otherwise.
13388
13389 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13390 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13391 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13392 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13393 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13394 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13395 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13396 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13397 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13398
13399 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13400 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13401 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13402
13403 .new
13404 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13405 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13406 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13407 .wen
13408
13409 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13410 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13411 This variable is
13412 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13413 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13414 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13415 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13416
13417 ,new
13418 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13419 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13420 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13421 .wen
13422
13423 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13424 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13425 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13426
13427 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13428 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13429 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13430 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13431 .code
13432 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13433 1 No response to request
13434 2 Response not verified
13435 3 Verification failed
13436 4 Verification succeeded
13437 .endd
13438
13439 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13440 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13441 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13442 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13443 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13444
13445 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13446 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13447 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13448 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13449 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13450 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13451 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13452 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13453 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13454 which is not the leaf.
13455
13456 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13457 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13458 the outbound.
13459
13460 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13461 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13462 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13463 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13464 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13465 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13466 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13467 which is not the leaf.
13468
13469 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13470 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13471 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13472 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13473 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13474 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13475 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13476 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13477 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13478 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13479 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13480
13481 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13482 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13483 the outbound.
13484
13485 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13486 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13487 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13488 During outbound
13489 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13490 the transport.
13491
13492 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13493 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13494 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13495
13496 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13497 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13498 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13499 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13500
13501 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13502 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13503 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13504
13505 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13506 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13507 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13508
13509 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13510 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13511 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13512 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13513 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13514 values for those that are behind (west).
13515
13516 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13517 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13518 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13519 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13520
13521 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13522 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13523 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13524 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13525 flag.
13526
13527 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13528 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13529 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13530 -0500.
13531
13532 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13533 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13534 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13535 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13536
13537 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13538 .cindex "transport" "name"
13539 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13540 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13541 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13542
13543 .vitem &$value$&
13544 .vindex "&$value$&"
13545 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13546 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13547 &*reduce*& expansion.
13548
13549 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13550 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13551 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13552 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13553 Otherwise, empty.
13554
13555 .vitem &$version_number$&
13556 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13557 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13558 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13559
13560 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13561 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13562 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13563 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13564
13565 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13566 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13567 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13568 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13569 .endlist
13570 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13571
13572
13573
13574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13576
13577 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13578 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13579 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13580 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13581 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13582 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13583 the line
13584 .code
13585 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13586 .endd
13587 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13588
13589
13590 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13591 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13592 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13593 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13594 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13595 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13596 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13597 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13598 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13599
13600 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13601 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13602 should usually be something like
13603 .code
13604 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13605 .endd
13606 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13607 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13608 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13609 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13610 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13611 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13612 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13613 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13614 two ways:
13615
13616 .ilist
13617 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13618 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13619 a startup when Exim is entered.
13620 .next
13621 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13622 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13623 .endlist
13624
13625 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13626 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13627
13628 .ilist
13629 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13630 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13631 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13632 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13633 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13634 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13635 defaults to false.
13636
13637
13638 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13639 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13640 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13641 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13642 forms:
13643 .code
13644 ${perl{foo}}
13645 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13646 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13647 .endd
13648 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13649 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13650 with an error message of the form
13651 .code
13652 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13653 .endd
13654 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13655 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13656 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13657 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13658 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13659 that was passed to &%die%&.
13660
13661
13662 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13663 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13664 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13665 the Perl code
13666 .code
13667 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13668 .endd
13669 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13670 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13671 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13672
13673 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13674 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13675 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13676 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13677
13678 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13679 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13680 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13681 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13682 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13683 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13684 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13685
13686
13687 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13688 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13689 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13690 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13691 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13692 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13693 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13694 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13695 avoided, but the output is lost.
13696
13697 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13698 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13699 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13700 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13701 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13702 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13703 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13704 .code
13705 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13706 .endd
13707 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13708 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13709 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13710 as the first subroutine argument.
13711 .ecindex IIDperl
13712
13713
13714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13716
13717 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13718 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13719 "Starting the daemon"
13720 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13721 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13722 .cindex "network interface"
13723 .cindex "interface" "network"
13724 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13725 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13726 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13727 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13728 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13729 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13730 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13731 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13732 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13733 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13734 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13735
13736 .olist
13737 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13738 and ports to listen on.
13739 .next
13740 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13741 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13742 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13743 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13744 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13745 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13746 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13747 as an error situation.
13748 .next
13749 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13750 for the outgoing connection.
13751 .endlist
13752
13753
13754 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13755 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13756 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13757 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13758 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13759
13760 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13761 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13762 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13763 chapter describes how they operate.
13764
13765 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13766 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13767
13768
13769
13770 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13771 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13772 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13773 following options:
13774
13775 .ilist
13776 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13777 or service names.
13778 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13779 .next
13780 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13781 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13782 .endlist
13783
13784 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13785 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13786 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13787 colons. For example:
13788 .code
13789 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13790 192.168.23.65 ; \
13791 ::1 ; \
13792 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13793 .endd
13794 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13795 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13796
13797 .olist
13798 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13799 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13800 .code
13801 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13802 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13803 .endd
13804 .next
13805 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13806 with a colon separator, for example:
13807 .code
13808 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13809 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13810 .endd
13811 .endlist
13812
13813 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13814 default setting contains just one port:
13815 .code
13816 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13817 .endd
13818 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13819 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13820 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13821 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13822 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13823
13824
13825
13826 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13827 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13828 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13829 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13830 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13831 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13832 .code
13833 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13834 .endd
13835 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13836 .code
13837 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13838 .endd
13839 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13840
13841
13842
13843 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13844 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13845 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13846 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13847 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13848 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13849 exim.
13850
13851 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13852 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13853 If there are any items that do not
13854 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13855 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13856 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13857 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13858 .code
13859 -oX 1225
13860 .endd
13861 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13862 whereas
13863 .code
13864 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13865 .endd
13866 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13867 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13868 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13869
13870
13871
13872 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13873 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13874 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13875 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13876 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13877 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13878 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13879 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13880 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13881 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13882 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13883 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13884 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13885 the 465 TCP ports.
13886
13887 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13888 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13889 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13890
13891 The common use of this option is expected to be
13892 .code
13893 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13894 .endd
13895 per RFC 8314.
13896 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13897 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13898
13899 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13900 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13901 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13902 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13903 connections via the daemon.)
13904
13905
13906
13907
13908 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13909 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13910 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13911 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13912 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13913 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13914 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13915 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13916 .code
13917 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13918 .endd
13919 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13920 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13921 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13922 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13923 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13924 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13925 .code
13926 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13927 .endd
13928 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13929 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13930 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13931 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13932 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13933
13934 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13935 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13936 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13937 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13938 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13939 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13940 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13941 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13942 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13943 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13944 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13945 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13946
13947 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13948 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13949 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13950 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13951 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13952
13953
13954
13955 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13956 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13957 .code
13958 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13959 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13960 .endd
13961 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13962 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13963 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13964 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13965
13966 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13967 .code
13968 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13969 .endd
13970 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13971 .code
13972 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13973 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13974 .endd
13975 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13976 IPv4 loopback address only:
13977 .code
13978 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13979 .endd
13980 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13981 .code
13982 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13983 .endd
13984 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13985
13986
13987
13988 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13989 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13990 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13991 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13992 treated as local.
13993
13994 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13995 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13996 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13997 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13998
13999 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14000 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14001 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14002 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14003 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14004 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14005 used for listening. Consider this example:
14006 .code
14007 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14008 192.168.53.235 ; \
14009 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14010
14011 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14012 .endd
14013 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14014 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14015 Exim is routing.
14016
14017 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14018 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14019 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14020 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14021 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14022 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14023 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14024 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14025
14026
14027
14028 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14029 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14030 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14031 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14032 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14033 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14034 details.
14035
14036
14037
14038
14039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14041
14042 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14043 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14044 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14045 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14046
14047 .ilist
14048 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14049 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14050 .next
14051 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14052 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14053 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14054 .next
14055 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14056 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14057 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14058 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14059 settings.
14060 .endlist
14061
14062 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14063 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14064 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14065 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14066 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14067 listed in more than one group.
14068
14069 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14070 .table2
14071 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14072 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14073 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14074 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14075 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14076 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14077 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14078 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14079 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14080 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14081 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14082 .endtable
14083
14084
14085 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14086 .table2
14087 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14088 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14089 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14090 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14091 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14092 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14093 .endtable
14094
14095
14096
14097 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14098 .table2
14099 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14100 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14101 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14102 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14103 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14104 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14105 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14106 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14107 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14108 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14109 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14110 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14111 .endtable
14112
14113
14114
14115 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14116 .table2
14117 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14118 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14119 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14120 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14121 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14122 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14123 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14124 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14125 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14126 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14127 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14128 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14129 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14130 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14131 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14132 .endtable
14133
14134
14135
14136 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14137 .table2
14138 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14139 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14140 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14141 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14142 .endtable
14143
14144
14145
14146 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14147 .table2
14148 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14149 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14150 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14151 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14152 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14153 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14154 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14155 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14156 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14157 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14158 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14159 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14160 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14161 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14162 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14163 .endtable
14164
14165
14166
14167 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14168 .table2
14169 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14170 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14171 .endtable
14172
14173
14174
14175 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14176 .table2
14177 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14178 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14179 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14180 .endtable
14181
14182
14183
14184 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14185 .table2
14186 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14187 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14188 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14189 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14190 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14191 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14192 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14193 .endtable
14194
14195
14196
14197 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14198 .table2
14199 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14200 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14201 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14202 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14203 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14204 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14205 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14206 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14207 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14208 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14209 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14210 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14211 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14212 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14213 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14214 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14215 connection"
14216 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14217 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14218 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14219 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14220 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14221 .endtable
14222
14223
14224
14225 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14226 .table2
14227 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14228 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14229 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14230 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14231 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14232 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14233 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14234 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14235 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14236 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14237 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14238 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14239 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14240 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14241 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14242 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14243 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14244 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14245 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14246 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14247 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14248 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14249 words""&"
14250 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14251 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14252 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14253 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14254 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14255 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14256 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14257 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14258 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14259 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14260 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14261 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14262 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14263 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14264 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14265 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14266 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14267 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14268 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14269 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14270 .endtable
14271
14272
14273
14274 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14275 .table2
14276 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14277 item"
14278 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14279 item"
14280 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14281 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14282 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14283 .endtable
14284
14285
14286
14287 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14288 .table2
14289 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14290 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14291 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14292 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14293 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14294 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14295 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14296 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14297 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14298 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14299 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14300 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14301 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14302 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14303 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14304 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14305 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14306 .endtable
14307
14308
14309
14310 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14311 .table2
14312 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14313 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14314 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14315 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14316 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14317 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14318 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14319 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14320 .endtable
14321
14322
14323
14324 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14325 .table2
14326 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14327 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14328 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14329 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14330 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14331 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14332 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14333 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14334 .endtable
14335
14336
14337
14338
14339 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14340 .table2
14341 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14342 .endtable
14343
14344
14345
14346
14347
14348 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14349 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14350
14351 .table2
14352 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14353 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14354 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14355 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14356 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14357 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14358 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14359 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14360 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14361 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14362 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14363 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14364 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14365 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14366 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14367 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14368 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14369 connection"
14370 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14371 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14372 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14373 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14374 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14375 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14376 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14377 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14378 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14379 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14380 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14381 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14382 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14383 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14384 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14385 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14386 .endtable
14387
14388
14389
14390 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14391 .table2
14392 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14393 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14394 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14395 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14396 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14397 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14398 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14399 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14400 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14401 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14402 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14403 .endtable
14404
14405
14406
14407 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14408 .table2
14409 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14410 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14411 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14412 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14413 words""&"
14414 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14415 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14416 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14417 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14418 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14419 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14420 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14421 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14422 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14423 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14424 .endtable
14425
14426
14427
14428 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14429 .table2
14430 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14431 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14432 directory"
14433 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14434 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14435 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14436 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14437 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14438 .endtable
14439
14440
14441
14442 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14443 .table2
14444 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14445 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14446 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14447 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14448 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14449 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14450 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14451 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14452 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14453 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14454 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14455 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14456 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14457 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14458 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14459 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14460 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14461 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14462 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14463 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14464 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14465 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14466 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14467 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14468 .endtable
14469
14470
14471
14472 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14473 .table2
14474 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14475 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14476 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14477 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14478 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14479 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14480 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14481 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14482 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14483 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14484 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14485 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14486 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14487 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14488 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14489 .endtable
14490
14491
14492
14493 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14494 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14495 &dagger;.
14496
14497 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14498 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14499 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14500 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14501 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14502 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14503 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14504 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14505 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14506
14507 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14508 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14509 It now defaults to true.
14510 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14511 .display
14512 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14513 .endd
14514
14515 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14516 .code
14517 log_selector = +8bitmime
14518 .endd
14519
14520 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14521 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14522 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14523 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14524 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14525 further details.
14526
14527 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14528 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14529 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14530 SMTP messages.
14531
14532 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14533 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14534 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14535 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14536 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14537
14538 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14539 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14540 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14541 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14542 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14543
14544 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14545 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14546 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14547 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14548
14549 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14550 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14551 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14552 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14553 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14554
14555 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14556 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14557 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14558 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14559 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14560 This option defines the ACL that,
14561 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14562 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14563 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14564 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14565
14566 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14567 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14568 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14569 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14570 of a received message.
14571 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14572
14573 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14574 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14575 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14576 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14577
14578 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14579 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14580 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14581 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14582
14583 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14584 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14585 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14586 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14587 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14588
14589
14590 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14591 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14592 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14593 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14594
14595 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14596 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14597 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14598 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14599 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14600
14601 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14602 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14603 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14604 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14605 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14606
14607 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14608 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14609 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14610 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14611 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14612
14613 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14614 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14615 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14616 further details.
14617
14618 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14619 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14620 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14621 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14622
14623 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14624 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14625 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14626 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14627
14628 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14629 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14630 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14631 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14632
14633 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14634 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14635 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14636 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14637
14638 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14639 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14640 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14641 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14642 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14643
14644 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14645 .cindex "admin user"
14646 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14647 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14648 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14649 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14650 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14651 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14652 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14653
14654 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14655 .cindex "domain literal"
14656 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14657 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14658 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14659 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14660
14661 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14662 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14663 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14664 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14665 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14666 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14667 the local host's IP addresses.
14668
14669
14670 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14671 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14672 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14673 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14674 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14675 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14676 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14677 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14678 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14679
14680 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14681 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14682 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14683 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14684 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14685 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14686 experiment if they wish.
14687
14688 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14689 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14690 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14691 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14692 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14693 suitable setting is:
14694 .code
14695 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14696 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14697 .endd
14698 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14699 .code
14700 dns_check_names_pattern =
14701 .endd
14702 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14703
14704
14705 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14706 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14707 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14708 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14709 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14710 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14711 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14712 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14713 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14714 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14715 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14716
14717 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14718 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14719 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14720 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14721 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14722 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14723
14724 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14725 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14726 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14727 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14728 .code
14729 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14730 .endd
14731 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14732 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14733 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14734 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14735
14736
14737 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14738 .cindex "thawing messages"
14739 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14740 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14741 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14742 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14743 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14744 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14745
14746 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14747 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14748 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14749
14750
14751 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14752 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14753 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14754 .code
14755 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14756 .endd
14757 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14758 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14759
14760
14761 .option bi_command main string unset
14762 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14763 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14764 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14765 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14766 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14767
14768
14769 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14770 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14771 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14772 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14773 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14774 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14775
14776
14777 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14778 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14779 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14780 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14781
14782 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14783 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14784 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14785 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14786 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14787 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14788 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14789 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14790 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14791 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14792
14793 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14794 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14795 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14796 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14797 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14798 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14799 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14800 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14801 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14802 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14803
14804 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14805 during reception of a message.
14806 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14807
14808 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14809
14810
14811 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14812 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14813 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14814 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14815
14816
14817 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14818 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14819 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14820 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14821 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14822 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14823 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14824 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14825 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14826
14827 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14828 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14829 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14830 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14831 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14832 messages.
14833
14834 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14835 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14836 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14837 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14838 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14839 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14840 connection. A typical setting might be:
14841 .code
14842 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14843 .endd
14844 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14845 .code
14846 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14847 .endd
14848 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14849 address.
14850
14851 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14852 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14853 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14854 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14855 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14856 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14857
14858
14859 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14860 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14861 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14862 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14863
14864
14865 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14866 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14867 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14868 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14869
14870
14871 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14872 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14873 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14874 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14875
14876
14877 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14878 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14879 callout verification. The default value is
14880 .code
14881 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14882 .endd
14883 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14884
14885
14886 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14887 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14888
14889
14890 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14891 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14892
14893 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14894 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14895 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14896 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14897 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14898 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14899 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14900 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14901 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14902 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14903
14904
14905 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14906 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14907
14908
14909 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14910 .cindex "checking disk space"
14911 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14912 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14913 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14914 message is accepted.
14915
14916 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14917 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14918 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14919 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14920 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14921 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14922 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14923 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14924
14925
14926 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14927 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14928 .code
14929 check_spool_space = 100M
14930 check_spool_inodes = 100
14931 .endd
14932 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14933 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14934 transit.
14935
14936 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14937 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14938 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14939
14940 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14941 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14942 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14943 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14944 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14945 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14946
14947 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14948 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14949 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14950
14951 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14952 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14953 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14954
14955 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14956 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14957 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14958 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14959
14960 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14961 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14962 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14963 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14964 these hosts.
14965 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14966
14967 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14968 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14969 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14970 administrative user.
14971 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14972
14973 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14974 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14975 .cindex memory debugging
14976 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14977 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14978 it should normally be left as default.
14979
14980 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14981 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14982 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14983 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14984 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14985 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14986
14987 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14988 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14989 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14990 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14991 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14992 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14993 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14994
14995 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14996 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14997
14998 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14999 .cindex "warning of delay"
15000 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15001 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15002 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15003 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15004 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15005 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15006 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15007 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15008 with
15009 .code
15010 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15011 .endd
15012 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15013 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15014 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15015 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15016 .code
15017 delay_warning = 6h
15018 .endd
15019 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15020 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15021 .code
15022 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15023 .endd
15024 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15025 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15026 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15027
15028 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15029 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15030 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15031 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15032 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15033 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15034 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15035 not sent. The default is:
15036 .code
15037 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15038 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15039 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15040 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15041 } {no}{yes}}
15042 .endd
15043 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15044 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15045 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15046 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15047
15048 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15049 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15050 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15051 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15052 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15053 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15054 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15055 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15056
15057 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15058 .cindex "load average"
15059 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15060 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15061 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15062 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15063 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15064
15065
15066 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15067 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15068 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15069 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15070 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15071 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15072 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15073 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15074
15075 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15076 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15077 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15078 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15079 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15080 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15081 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15082 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15083
15084 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15085 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15086 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15087 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15088
15089
15090 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15091 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15092 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15093 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15094 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15095 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15096 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15097
15098
15099 .new
15100 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512 : sha1"
15101 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15102 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15103 and an order of processing.
15104 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15105
15106 Note that the presence of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15107 Signatures using the rsa-sha1 are however (as of writing) still common.
15108 The default inclusion of sha1 may be dropped in a future release.
15109
15110 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15111 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15112 and an order of processing.
15113 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15114
15115 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15116 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15117 first success.
15118 .wen
15119
15120 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15121 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15122 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15123 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15124 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15125 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15126
15127
15128 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15129 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15130 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15131 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15132 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15133 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15134 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15135 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15136 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15137 by a setting such as this:
15138 .code
15139 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15140 .endd
15141 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15142 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15143 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15144 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15145 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15146 options are applied after this global option.
15147
15148 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15149 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15150 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15151 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15152 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15153 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15154 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15155 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15156 value of this option. The default pattern is
15157 .code
15158 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15159 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15160 .endd
15161 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15162 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15163 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15164 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15165 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15166 empty string.
15167
15168 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15169 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15170 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15171
15172 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15173 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15174 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15175 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15176
15177 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15178 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15179 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15180 not do it internally.
15181 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15182 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15183
15184 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15185 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15186 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15187
15188
15189 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15190 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15191 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15192 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15193 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15194 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15195
15196 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15197
15198
15199 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15200 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15201 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15202 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15203 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15204 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15205 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15206 domain matches this list.
15207
15208 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15209 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15210 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15211 .new
15212 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15213 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15214 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15215 .wen
15216
15217
15218 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15219 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15220 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15221 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15222 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15223 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15224 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15225 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15226 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15227 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15228 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15229 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15230 to set in them.
15231 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15232
15233
15234 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15235 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15236
15237
15238 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15239 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15240 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15241 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15242 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15243 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15244 match with this expanded domain list.
15245
15246 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15247 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15248 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15249 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15250 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15251 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15252
15253 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15254 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15255 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15256
15257 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15258 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15259 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15260 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15261 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15262
15263 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15264 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15265 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15266 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15267 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15268 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15269 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15270 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15271 on.
15272
15273 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15274
15275 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15276 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15277 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15278
15279
15280 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15281 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15282 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15283 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15284
15285 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15286 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15287 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15288 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15289 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15290 and accepted from, these hosts.
15291 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15292 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15293 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15294 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15295 are sent.
15296
15297 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15298 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15299 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15300 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15301 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15302 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15303 .code
15304 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15305 .endd
15306 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15307 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15308
15309 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15310 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15311 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15312 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15313 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15314 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15315 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15316 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15317 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15318
15319
15320 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15321 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15322 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15323 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15324 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15325 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15326 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15327 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15328 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15329
15330 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15331 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15332 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15333 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15334 are examined. For example:
15335 .code
15336 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15337 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15338 postmaster@mydomain.example
15339 .endd
15340 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15341 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15342 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15343 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15344 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15345 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15346 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15347
15348
15349 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15350 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15351 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15352 .display
15353 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15354 .endd
15355 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15356 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15357 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15358 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15359 overrides the default.
15360
15361 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15362 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15363 and warning messages. For example:
15364 .code
15365 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15366 .endd
15367 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15368 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15369 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15370 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15371 not used.
15372
15373
15374 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15375 .cindex events
15376 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15377 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15378
15379
15380 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15381 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15382 .cindex "Exim group"
15383 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15384 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15385 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15386 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15387 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15388 security issues.
15389
15390
15391 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15392 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15393 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15394 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15395 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15396 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15397 other place.
15398 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15399 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15400 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15401 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15402
15403
15404 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15405 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15406 .cindex "Exim user"
15407 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15408 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15409 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15410 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15411
15412 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15413 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15414 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15415 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15416
15417
15418 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15419 .cindex "Exim version"
15420 .cindex customizing "version number"
15421 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15422 This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15423 various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15424
15425
15426 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15427 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15428 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15429 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15430
15431
15432 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15433 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15434
15435 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15436 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15437 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15438 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15439 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15440 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15441 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15442 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15443 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15444 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15445 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15446 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15447 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15448 addresses.
15449
15450
15451 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15452 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15453 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15454 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15455 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15456 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15457 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15458 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15459 retries.
15460
15461 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15462 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15463 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15464 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15465
15466
15467
15468 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15469 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15470 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15471 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15472 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15473 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15474 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15475 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15476 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15477 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15478 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15479 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15480 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15481 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15482 logging that you require.
15483
15484
15485 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15486 .cindex "HP-UX"
15487 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15488 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15489 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15490 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15491 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15492 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15493 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15494 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15495
15496 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15497 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15498 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15499 user's name.
15500
15501 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15502 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15503 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15504 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15505 .code
15506 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15507 gecos_name = $1
15508 .endd
15509
15510 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15511 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15512
15513
15514 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15515 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15516 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15517 implementations of TLS.
15518
15519
15520 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15521 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15522 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15523
15524 See
15525 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15526 for documentation.
15527
15528
15529
15530 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15531 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15532 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15533 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15534 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15535 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15536
15537
15538
15539 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15540 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15541 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15542 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15543 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15544 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15545 sections are rejected.
15546
15547
15548 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15549 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15550 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15551 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15552 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15553 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15554 zero means &"no limit"&.
15555
15556
15557
15558
15559 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15560 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15561 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15562 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15563 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15564 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15565 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15566 if you want to do semantic checking.
15567 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15568 set.
15569
15570
15571 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15572 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15573 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15574 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15575 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15576 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15577 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15578 .code
15579 helo_allow_chars = _
15580 .endd
15581 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15582
15583
15584 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15585 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15586 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15587 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15588 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15589 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15590 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15591 do.
15592
15593
15594 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15595 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15596 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15597 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15598 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15599 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15600 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15601 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15602 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15603 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15604 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15605 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15606
15607 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15608 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15609 EHLO command either:
15610
15611 .ilist
15612 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15613 .next
15614 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15615 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15616 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15617 calling host address, or
15618 .next
15619 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15620 .endlist
15621
15622 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15623 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15624 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15625
15626 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15627 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15628 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15629
15630 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15631 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15632 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15633 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15634 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15635 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15636 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15637 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15638 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15639 error.
15640
15641 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15642 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15643 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15644 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15645 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15646 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15647 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15648 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15649 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15650
15651 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15652 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15653 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15654 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15655 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15656
15657 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15658 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15659 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15660 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15661
15662
15663 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15664 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15665 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15666 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15667 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15668 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15669 default configuration file contains
15670 .code
15671 host_lookup = *
15672 .endd
15673 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15674 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15675
15676 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15677 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15678 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15679
15680 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15681 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15682 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15683 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15684 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15685 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15686
15687
15688 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15689 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15690 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15691 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15692 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15693 if you want.
15694
15695 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15696 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15697 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15698 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15699
15700
15701
15702 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15703 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15704 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15705 as soon as the connection is made.
15706 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15707 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15708 connections immediately.
15709
15710 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15711 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15712 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15713 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15714 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15715
15716
15717 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15718 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15719 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15720 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15721 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15722 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15723 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15724 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15725 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15726 .code
15727 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15728 .endd
15729 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15730
15731
15732
15733 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15734 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15735 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15736 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15737
15738
15739 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15740 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15741 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15742 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15743 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15744 records
15745 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15746 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15747
15748 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15749 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15750 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15751 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15752 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15753 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15754 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15755
15756
15757 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15758 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15759 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15760 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15761 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15762
15763
15764
15765 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15766 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15767 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15768 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15769 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15770 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15771
15772 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15773 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15774 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15775 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15776 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15777 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15778 for frozen messages. For example,
15779 .code
15780 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15781 .endd
15782 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15783 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15784 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15785 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15786 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15787 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15788
15789
15790 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15791 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15792 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15793 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15794 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15795 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15796 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15797 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15798 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15799 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15800
15801
15802 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15803 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15804
15805 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15806 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15807 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15808 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15809 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15810 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15811 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15812 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15813 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15814
15815 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15816 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15817
15818 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15819 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15820 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15821 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15822
15823 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15824 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15825 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15826 anymore.
15827
15828 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15829 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15830 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15831 details.
15832
15833
15834 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15835 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15836 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15837 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15838 logged.
15839
15840
15841 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15842 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15843 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15844 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15845 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15846 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15847 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15848 and constrained to be a directory.
15849
15850
15851 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15852 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15853 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15854 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15855 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15856 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15857 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15858 and constrained to be a file.
15859
15860
15861 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15862 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15863 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15864 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15865 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15866 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15867
15868
15869 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15870 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15871 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15872 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15873 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15874 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15875 identity to be proven.
15876
15877
15878 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15879 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15880 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15881 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15882 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15883
15884
15885 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15886 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15887 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15888 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15889 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15890 with LDAP support.
15891
15892
15893 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15894 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15895 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15896 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15897 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15898 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15899 to hard/demand.
15900
15901
15902 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15903 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15904 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15905 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15906 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15907 of SSL-on-connect.
15908 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15909 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15910 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15911
15912
15913 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15914 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15915 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15916 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15917 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15918 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15919 has been built with LDAP support.
15920
15921
15922
15923 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15924 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15925 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15926 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15927 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15928 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15929 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15930
15931 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15932 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15933 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15934
15935 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15936 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15937 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15938 and the default qualify domain.
15939
15940 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15941 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15942 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15943 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15944
15945 .cindex "envelope from"
15946 .cindex "envelope sender"
15947 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15948 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15949 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15950
15951 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15952 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15953 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15954
15955
15956
15957
15958 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15959 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15960 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15961 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15962 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15963 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15964 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15965 example, if
15966 .code
15967 local_from_prefix = *-
15968 .endd
15969 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15970 .code
15971 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15972 .endd
15973 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15974 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15975 qualify domain.
15976
15977
15978 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15979 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15980
15981
15982 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15983 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15984 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15985 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15986 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15987 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15988 &%local_interfaces%& is
15989 .code
15990 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15991 .endd
15992 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15993 .code
15994 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15995 .endd
15996
15997 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15998 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15999 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16000 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16001 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16002 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16003 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16004 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16005
16006
16007
16008 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16009 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16010 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16011 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16012 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16013 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16014 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16015 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16016
16017
16018
16019
16020 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16021 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16022 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16023 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16024 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16025 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16026 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16027 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16028 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16029 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16030 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16031 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16032 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16033 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16034 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16035
16036
16037
16038 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16039 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16040 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16041 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16042 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16043 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16044 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16045 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16046 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16047 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16048 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16049 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16050 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16051 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16052 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16053
16054
16055 .option log_selector main string unset
16056 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16057 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16058 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16059 minus characters. For example:
16060 .code
16061 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16062 .endd
16063 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16064 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16065
16066
16067 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16068 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16069 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16070 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16071 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16072 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16073 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16074 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16075 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16076 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16077 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16078 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16079 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16080
16081
16082 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16083 .cindex "too many open files"
16084 .cindex "open files, too many"
16085 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16086 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16087 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16088 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16089 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16090 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16091 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16092 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16093 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16094 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16095 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16096 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16097
16098
16099 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16100 .cindex "length of login name"
16101 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16102 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16103 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16104 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16105 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16106 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16107
16108
16109 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16110 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16111 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16112 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16113 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16114 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16115 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16116 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16117
16118
16119 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16120 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16121 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16122 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16123 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16124 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16125 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16126
16127
16128 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16129 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16130 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16131 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16132 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16133 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16134 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16135 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16136 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16137 empty string, the option is ignored.
16138
16139
16140 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16141 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16142 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16143 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16144 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16145 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16146 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16147 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16148 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16149 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16150 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16151 colons will become hyphens.
16152
16153
16154 .option message_logs main boolean true
16155 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16156 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16157 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16158 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16159 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16160 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16161 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16162 which is not affected by this option.
16163
16164
16165 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16166 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16167 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16168 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16169 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16170 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16171 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16172 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16173 optionally followed by K or M.
16174
16175 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16176 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16177 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16178 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16179 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16180
16181 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16182 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16183 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16184 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16185 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16186 message that an individual transport can process.
16187
16188 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16189 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16190 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16191 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16192 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16193 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16194 some problems may result.
16195
16196 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16197 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16198 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16199
16200
16201 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16202 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16203 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16204 .code
16205 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16206 .endd
16207 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16208 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16209 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16210 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16211 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16212
16213
16214 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16215 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16216 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16217 contains a full description of this facility.
16218
16219
16220
16221 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16222 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16223 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16224 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16225 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16226
16227
16228 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16229 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16230 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16231 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16232 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16233 safety precaution.
16234
16235 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16236 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16237 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16238 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16239 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16240
16241 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16242 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16243 example is
16244 .code
16245 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16246 .endd
16247 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16248 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16249 transport driver.
16250
16251
16252 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16253 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16254 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16255 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16256 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16257
16258 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16259 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16260 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16261 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16262 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16263 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16264 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16265
16266 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16267 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16268 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16269 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16270 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16271
16272 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16273
16274 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16275 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16276 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16277 some now infamous attacks.
16278
16279 Examples:
16280 .code
16281 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16282 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16283 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16284
16285 # Disable older protocol versions:
16286 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16287 .endd
16288
16289 Possible options may include:
16290 .ilist
16291 &`all`&
16292 .next
16293 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16294 .next
16295 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16296 .next
16297 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16298 .next
16299 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
16300 .next
16301 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16302 .next
16303 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16304 .next
16305 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16306 .next
16307 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16308 .next
16309 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16310 .next
16311 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16312 .next
16313 &`no_compression`&
16314 .next
16315 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16316 .next
16317 &`no_sslv2`&
16318 .next
16319 &`no_sslv3`&
16320 .next
16321 &`no_ticket`&
16322 .next
16323 &`no_tlsv1`&
16324 .next
16325 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
16326 .next
16327 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
16328 .next
16329 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16330 .next
16331 &`single_dh_use`&
16332 .next
16333 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16334 .next
16335 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16336 .next
16337 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16338 .next
16339 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16340 .next
16341 &`tls_d5_bug`&
16342 .next
16343 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16344 .endlist
16345
16346 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16347 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16348 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16349 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16350 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16351 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16352
16353
16354 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16355 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16356 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16357 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16358 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16359
16360
16361 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16362 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16363 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16364 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16365 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16366 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16367 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16368 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16369 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16370 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16371 an ACL.
16372
16373 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16374 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16375 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16376 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16377 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16378 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16379 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16380
16381
16382 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16383 .cindex "Perl"
16384 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16385 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16386
16387
16388 .option perl_startup main string unset
16389 .cindex "Perl"
16390 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16391 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16392
16393 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16394 .cindex "Perl"
16395 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16396
16397
16398 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16399 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16400 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16401 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16402 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16403 PostgreSQL support.
16404
16405
16406 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16407 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16408 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16409 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16410 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16411 to the host name:
16412 .code
16413 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16414 .endd
16415 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16416 spool directory.
16417 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16418 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16419 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16420
16421
16422 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16423 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16424 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16425 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16426 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16427 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16428 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16429 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16430 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16431
16432 .new
16433 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16434 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16435 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16436 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16437 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16438 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16439 commands are acceptable.
16440 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16441
16442 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16443 .wen
16444
16445
16446 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16447 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16448 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16449 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16450 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16451 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16452 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16453 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16454
16455 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16456 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16457 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16458 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16459 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16460 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16461 volume of mail. Use with care!
16462
16463
16464 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16465 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16466 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16467 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16468 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16469 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16470 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16471 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16472 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16473 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16474
16475 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16476 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16477 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16478 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16479 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16480 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16481
16482
16483 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16484 .cindex "printing characters"
16485 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16486 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16487 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16488 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16489 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16490 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16491 characters.
16492
16493 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16494 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16495 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16496 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16497 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16498 standards.
16499
16500
16501 .option process_log_path main string unset
16502 .cindex "process log path"
16503 .cindex "log" "process log"
16504 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16505 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16506 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16507 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16508 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16509 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16510 different spool directories.
16511
16512
16513 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16514 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16515 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16516 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16517 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16518 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16519 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16520 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16521
16522
16523 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16524 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16525 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16526 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16527 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16528 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16529 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16530 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16531 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16532
16533 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16534 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16535 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16536 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16537 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16538 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16539 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16540
16541
16542 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16543 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16544 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16545
16546
16547
16548 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16549 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16550 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16551 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16552 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16553 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16554 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16555 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16556
16557
16558 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16559 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16560 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16561 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16562 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16563 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16564 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16565
16566
16567 .option queue_only main boolean false
16568 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16569 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16570 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16571 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16572 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16573 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16574
16575 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16576 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16577 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16578 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16579
16580
16581 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16582 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16583 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16584 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16585 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16586 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16587 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16588 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16589 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16590 .code
16591 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16592 .endd
16593 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16594 &_/some/file_& exists.
16595
16596
16597 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16598 .cindex "load average"
16599 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16600 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16601 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16602 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16603 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16604 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16605 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16606 false.
16607
16608 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16609 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16610 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16611 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16612
16613
16614 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16615 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16616 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16617 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16618 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16619 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16620 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16621 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16622 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16623 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16624 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16625 re-evaluated for each message.
16626
16627
16628 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16629 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16630 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16631 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16632 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16633 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16634
16635
16636 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16637 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16638 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16639 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16640 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16641 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16642 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16643 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16644 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16645 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16646 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16647 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16648 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16649
16650
16651
16652 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16653 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16654 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16655 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16656 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16657 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16658 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16659 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16660 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16661
16662 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16663 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16664 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16665 the daemon's command line.
16666
16667 .cindex queues named
16668 .cindex "named queues"
16669 To set limits for different named queues use
16670 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16671
16672 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16673 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16674 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16675 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16676 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16677 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16678 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16679 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16680 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16681 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16682 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16683 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16684 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16685 &%queue_domains%&.
16686
16687
16688 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16689 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16690 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16691 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16692 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16693 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16694 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16695
16696 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16697 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16698 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16699 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16700 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16701 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16702 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16703 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16704 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16705 header lines.
16706 .new
16707 The default setting is:
16708
16709 .code
16710 received_header_text = Received: \
16711 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16712 {${if def:sender_ident \
16713 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16714 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16715 by $primary_hostname \
16716 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16717 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16718 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16719 ${if def:sender_address \
16720 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16721 id $message_exim_id\
16722 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16723 .endd
16724 .wen
16725
16726 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16727 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16728 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16729 header lines such as the following:
16730 .code
16731 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16732 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16733 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16734 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16735 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16736 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16737 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16738 .endd
16739 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16740 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16741 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16742 message was accepted.
16743
16744
16745 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16746 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16747 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16748 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16749 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16750 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16751 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16752 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16753
16754
16755 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16756 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16757 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16758 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16759 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16760 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16761 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16762 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16763 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16764 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16765 option was not set.
16766
16767
16768 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16769 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16770 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16771 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16772 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16773 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16774 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16775 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16776 done.
16777
16778 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16779 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16780 RCPT commands in a single message.
16781
16782
16783 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16784 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16785 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16786 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16787 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16788 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16789 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16790
16791
16792 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16793 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16794 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16795 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16796 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16797 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16798 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16799 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16800 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16801 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16802 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16803 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16804 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16805 tagged with its process id.
16806
16807 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16808 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16809 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16810 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16811 is received.
16812
16813 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16814 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16815 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16816 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16817 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16818 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16819 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16820 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16821 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16822 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16823 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16824
16825 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16826 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16827 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16828 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16829
16830
16831 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16832 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16833 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16834 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16835 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16836 .code
16837 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16838 .endd
16839 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16840 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16841
16842
16843 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16844 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16845 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16846 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16847 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16848 past failures.
16849
16850
16851 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16852 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16853 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16854 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16855 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16856 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16857 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16858 the default value.
16859
16860
16861 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16862 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16863 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16864 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16865 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16866 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16867 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16868 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16869 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16870 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16871
16872
16873 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16874 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16875
16876
16877 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16878 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16879 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16880 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16881 an item in the list.
16882 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16883 for the system.
16884
16885 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16886 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16887 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16888 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16889 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16890
16891
16892 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16893 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16894 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16895 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16896 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16897 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16898 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16899 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16900 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16901 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16902
16903 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
16904 .cindex "environment"
16905 This option allows to add individual environment variables that the
16906 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16907 default list is empty.
16908
16909
16910 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16911 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16912 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16913 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16914 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16915 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16916 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16917
16918
16919
16920 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16921 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16922 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16923 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16924 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16925 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16926 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16927 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16928 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16929 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16930 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16931
16932
16933
16934 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16935 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16936 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16937 .cindex "inetd"
16938 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16939 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16940 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16941 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16942 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16943 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16944
16945 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16946 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16947 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16948 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16949
16950
16951 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16952 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16953 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16954 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16955 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16956 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16957 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16958 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16959
16960 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16961 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16962 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16963 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16964 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16965 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16966 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16967 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16968
16969
16970 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16971 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16972 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16973 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16974 live with.
16975
16976
16977 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16978 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16979 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16980 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16981 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16982 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16983 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16984 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16985 . the option name to split.
16986
16987 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16988 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16989 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16990 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16991 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16992 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16993 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16994 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16995 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16996 seen).
16997
16998
16999 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17000 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17001 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17002 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17003 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17004 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17005 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17006 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17007 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17008 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17009 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17010
17011 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17012 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17013 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17014 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17015 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17016 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17017
17018
17019
17020 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17021 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17022 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17023 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17024 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17025 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17026 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17027 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17028 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17029 to all messages received in the same connection.
17030
17031 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17032 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17033 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17034 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17035
17036
17037 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17038
17039 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17040 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17041 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17042 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17043 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17044 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17045 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17046 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17047 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17048 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17049 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17050 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17051 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17052
17053
17054 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17055 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17056 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17057 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17058 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17059 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17060 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17061 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17062 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17063 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17064 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17065 individual host.
17066
17067 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17068 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17069 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17070 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17071
17072
17073 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17074 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17075 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17076 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17077 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17078 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17079 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17080 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17081 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17082
17083 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17084 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17085 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17086 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17087
17088 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17089 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17090 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17091 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17092 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17093 For example:
17094 .code
17095 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17096 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17097 .endd
17098
17099 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17100 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17101 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17102 &%helo_data%& value.
17103
17104 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17105 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17106 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17107 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17108 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17109 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17110 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17111 .code
17112 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17113 $version_number $tod_full
17114 .endd
17115 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17116 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17117 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17118 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17119 multiline response).
17120
17121
17122 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17123 .cindex "checking disk space"
17124 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17125 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17126 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17127 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17128 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17129 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17130 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17131
17132
17133 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17134 .cindex "connection backlog"
17135 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17136 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17137 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17138 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17139 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17140 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17141 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17142 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17143 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17144 attacks by SYN flooding.
17145
17146
17147 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17148 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17149 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17150 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17151 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17152 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17153 fewer, but they still exist.
17154
17155 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17156 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17157 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17158 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17159 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17160 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17161 does detect many instances.
17162
17163 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17164 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17165 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17166 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17167
17168
17169
17170 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17171 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17172 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17173 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17174 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17175 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17176 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17177 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17178 example:
17179 .code
17180 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17181 $sender_host_address
17182 .endd
17183 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17184 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17185 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17186 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17187 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17188 the command.
17189
17190
17191 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17192 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17193 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17194 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17195 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17196
17197
17198 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17199 .cindex "load average"
17200 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17201 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17202 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17203 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17204 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17205 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17206
17207
17208
17209 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17210 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17211 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17212 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17213 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17214 .code
17215 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17216 .endd
17217 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17218 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17219 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17220 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17221 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17222
17223 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17224 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17225 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17226 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17227 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17228 not count towards the limit.
17229
17230
17231
17232 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17233 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17234 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17235 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17236 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17237 that subvert web
17238 clients
17239 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17240 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17241
17242
17243
17244 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17245 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17246 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17247 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17248 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17249 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17250 recipients.
17251
17252 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17253 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17254 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17255 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17256
17257 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17258 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17259 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17260 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17261 values:
17262
17263 .ilist
17264 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17265 .next
17266 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17267 fractional parts are allowed here.
17268 .next
17269 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17270 .next
17271 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17272 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17273 .endlist
17274
17275 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17276 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17277 .code
17278 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17279 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17280 .endd
17281 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17282 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17283 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17284 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17285
17286
17287 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17288 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17289
17290
17291 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17292 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17293
17294
17295 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17296 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17297 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17298 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17299 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17300 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17301 the message is abandoned.
17302 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17303 .code
17304 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17305 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17306 .endd
17307 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17308 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17309
17310 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17311 expanded before use and may depend on
17312 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17313
17314
17315 .oindex "&%-os%&"
17316 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17317 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17318 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17319 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17320 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17321
17322
17323 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17324 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17325 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17326
17327
17328 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17329 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17330 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17331 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17332 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17333 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17334 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17335 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17336 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17337 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17338 .code
17339 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17340 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17341 .endd
17342
17343
17344 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17345 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17346 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17347 the availability thereof is advertised in
17348 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17349 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17350
17351
17352 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17353 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17354 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17355 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17356
17357
17358
17359 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17360 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17361 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17362
17363
17364
17365 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17366 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17367 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17368 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17369 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17370 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17371 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17372 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17373 arrival of the message.
17374
17375 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17376 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17377 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17378 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17379 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17380
17381 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17382 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17383 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17384 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17385 automatically deleted.
17386
17387 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17388 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17389 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17390 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17391 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17392 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17393 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17394 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17395 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17396
17397
17398 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17399 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17400 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17401 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17402 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17403 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17404 &$primary_hostname$&.
17405
17406 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17407 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17408 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17409 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17410 as failures in the configuration file.
17411
17412 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17413 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17414
17415 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17416 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17417 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17418 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17419 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17420 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17421 option.
17422
17423 The following variables will not have useful values:
17424 .code
17425 $max_received_linelength
17426 $body_linecount
17427 $body_zerocount
17428 .endd
17429
17430 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17431 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17432 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17433 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17434
17435 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17436 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17437 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17438
17439 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17440 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17441 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17442 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17443
17444 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17445 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17446 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17447 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17448 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17449 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17450
17451 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17452 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17453 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17454 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17455 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17456 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17457 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17458
17459
17460 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17461 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17462 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17463 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17464 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17465 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17466 domain causes a syntax error.
17467 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17468 syntax checking.
17469
17470
17471 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17472 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17473 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17474 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17475 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17476 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17477 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17478 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17479 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17480 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17481 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17482 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17483
17484
17485 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17486 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17487 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17488 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17489 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17490 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17491 details of Exim's logging.
17492
17493
17494 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17495 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17496 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17497 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17498 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17499 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17500 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17501
17502
17503
17504 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17505 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17506 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17507 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17508 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17509
17510
17511
17512 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17513 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17514 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17515 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17516 details of Exim's logging.
17517
17518
17519 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17520 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17521 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17522 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17523 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17524 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17525 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17526 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17527 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17528 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17529 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17530 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17531
17532
17533 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17534 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17535 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17536 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17537 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17538 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17539
17540
17541 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17542 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17543 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17544 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17545 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17546
17547 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17548 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17549 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17550 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17551 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17552
17553 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17554 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17555 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17556 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17557 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17558 contains the pipe command.
17559
17560
17561 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17562 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17563 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17564 is used in a system filter.
17565
17566
17567 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17568 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17569 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17570 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17571 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17572 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17573 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17574 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17575 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17576 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17577
17578 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17579 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17580 transport option overrides.
17581
17582
17583 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17584 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17585 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17586 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17587 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17588 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17589 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17590 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17591 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17592 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17593 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17594 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17595 TCP_NODELAY.
17596
17597
17598 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17599 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17600 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17601 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17602 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17603 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17604 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17605 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17606 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17607 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17608
17609 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17610 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17611 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17612
17613
17614 .option timezone main string unset
17615 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17616 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17617 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17618 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17619 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17620 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17621 .code
17622 timezone = UTC
17623 .endd
17624 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17625 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17626 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17627 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17628 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17629 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17630
17631
17632 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17633 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17634 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17635 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17636 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17637 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17638 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17639 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17640 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17641 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17642 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17643
17644
17645 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17646 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17647 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17648 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17649 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17650 Commonly only one file is needed.
17651 The server's private key is also
17652 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17653 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17654
17655 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17656 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17657 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17658 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17659
17660 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17661 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17662
17663 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17664 when a list of more than one
17665 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17666
17667 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17668 when a list of more than one file is used.
17669
17670 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17671 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17672 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17673 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17674
17675 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17676 generated for every connection.
17677
17678 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17679 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17680 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17681 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17682 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17683
17684 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17685
17686 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17687 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17688 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17689
17690 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17691
17692
17693 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17694 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17695 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17696 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17697 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17698 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17699
17700 The value must be at least 1024.
17701
17702 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17703 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17704 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17705
17706 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17707 number.
17708
17709 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17710 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17711 larger prime than requested.
17712
17713
17714 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17715 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17716 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17717 to be used by Exim.
17718
17719 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17720 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17721 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17722 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17723
17724 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17725 then it names a file from which DH
17726 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17727 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17728 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17729 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17730 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17731 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17732
17733 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17734 loaded by Exim.
17735
17736 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17737 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17738 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17739 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17740
17741 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17742 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17743
17744 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17745 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17746 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17747
17748 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17749 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17750 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17751 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17752 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17753
17754 The available standard primes are:
17755 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17756 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17757 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17758 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17759
17760 The available additional primes are:
17761 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17762
17763 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17764 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17765 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17766 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17767 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17768
17769 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17770 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17771 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17772
17773 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17774 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17775 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17776 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17777 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17778 userbase.
17779
17780 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17781 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17782 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17783 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17784 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17785 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17786 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17787
17788
17789 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17790 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17791 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17792 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17793
17794 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17795 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17796 for valid selections.
17797
17798 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17799 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17800 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17801
17802 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17803
17804
17805 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17806 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17807 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17808 This option
17809 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17810 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17811 Certificate Authority.
17812
17813 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17814
17815 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17816 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17817 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17818
17819
17820 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17821 .cindex SSMTP
17822 .cindex SMTPS
17823 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17824 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17825 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17826 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17827
17828
17829
17830 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17831 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17832 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17833 files which contains the server's private keys.
17834 If this option is unset, or if
17835 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17836 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17837 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17838
17839 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17840
17841
17842 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17843 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17844 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17845 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17846 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17847 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17848 TLS session.
17849
17850
17851 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17852 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17853 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17854 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17855 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17856 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17857 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17858 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17859 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17860 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17861 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17862
17863
17864 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17865 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17866 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17867 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17868
17869
17870 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17871 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17872 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17873 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17874 word "system"
17875 or the absolute path to
17876 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17877 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17878
17879 The "system" value for the option will use a
17880 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17881 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17882 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17883 must be specified.
17884
17885 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17886 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17887
17888 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17889 explicitly
17890 either by file or directory
17891 are added to those given by the system default location.
17892
17893 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17894 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17895 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17896 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17897 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17898 use the explicit directory version.
17899
17900 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17901
17902 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17903 being unset.
17904
17905
17906 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17907 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17908 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17909 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17910 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17911 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17912 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17913 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17914
17915 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17916 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17917 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17918 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17919 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17920 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17921 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17922
17923 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17924 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17925 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17926 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17927 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17928 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17929 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17930 certificate"&.
17931
17932 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17933 certificates.
17934
17935
17936 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17937 .cindex "trusted groups"
17938 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17939 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17940 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17941 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17942 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17943 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17944 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17945 are trusted.
17946
17947 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17948 .cindex "trusted users"
17949 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17950 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17951 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17952 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17953 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17954 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17955 Exim user are trusted.
17956
17957 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17958 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17959 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17960 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17961 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17962 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17963 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17964 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17965 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17966 &%-F%& option.
17967
17968 .option unknown_username main string unset
17969 See &%unknown_login%&.
17970
17971 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17972 .cindex "trusted users"
17973 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17974 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17975 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17976 .cindex "envelope from"
17977 .cindex "envelope sender"
17978 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17979 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17980 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17981 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17982 is used) is ignored.
17983
17984 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17985 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17986 .code
17987 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17988 .endd
17989 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17990 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17991 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17992 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17993 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17994 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17995 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17996 followed by a hyphen
17997 by a setting like this:
17998 .code
17999 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18000 .endd
18001 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18002 restriction, you can use
18003 .code
18004 untrusted_set_sender = *
18005 .endd
18006 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18007 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18008 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18009 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18010 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18011 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18012 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18013 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18014
18015 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18016 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18017 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18018 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18019 sender address.
18020
18021
18022 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18023 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18024 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18025 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18026 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18027 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18028 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18029 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18030 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18031 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18032 .code
18033 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18034 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18035 .endd
18036 The pattern can be seen by running
18037 .code
18038 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18039 .endd
18040 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18041 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18042 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18043 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18044 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18045 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18046
18047
18048 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18049 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18050
18051
18052 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18053 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18054 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18055 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18056 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18057 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18058 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18059 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18060
18061
18062 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18063 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18064 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18065 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18066 .ecindex IIDconfima
18067 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18068
18069
18070
18071
18072 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18074
18075 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18076 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18077 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18078 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18079 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18080
18081 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18082 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18083 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18084 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18085 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18086
18087
18088
18089 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18090 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18091 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18092 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18093 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18094 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18095 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18096
18097 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18098 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18099 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18100 routers, and the eventual transport.
18101
18102 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18103 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18104 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18105 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18106 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18107
18108 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18109 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18110 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18111 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18112 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18113
18114 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18115 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18116 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18117 .code
18118 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18119 .endd
18120 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18121 .code
18122 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18123 .endd
18124 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18125 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18126
18127 .new
18128 See also the &%set%& option below.
18129 .wen
18130
18131 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18132 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18133 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18134 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18135 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18136 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18137 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18138
18139
18140
18141 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18142 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
18143 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18144 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18145 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18146 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18147 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18148 routing.
18149
18150
18151
18152 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18153 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18154 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18155 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18156 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18157 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18158 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18159 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18160 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18161 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18162 you could put:
18163 .code
18164 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18165 .endd
18166 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18167 and
18168 .code
18169 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18170 .endd
18171 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18172 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18173 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18174 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18175
18176
18177 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18178 .cindex "case of local parts"
18179 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18180 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18181 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18182 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18183 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18184 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18185 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18186 more details.
18187
18188 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18189 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18190 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18191 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18192 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18193 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18194 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18195 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18196 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18197
18198 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18199 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18200 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18201 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18202
18203
18204
18205 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18206 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18207 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18208 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18209 .vindex "&$home$&"
18210 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18211 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18212 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18213 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18214 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18215 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18216 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18217 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18218 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18219 the router is skipped.
18220
18221 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18222 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18223 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18224 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18225 setting to achieve this. For example:
18226 .code
18227 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18228 .endd
18229 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18230 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18231 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18232
18233
18234
18235 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18236 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18237 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18238 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18239 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18240 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18241 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18242 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18243
18244 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18245 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18246
18247 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18248 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18249
18250 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18251 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18252 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18253 .code
18254 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18255 .endd
18256 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18257 .code
18258 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18259 .endd
18260
18261 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18262 .code
18263 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18264 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18265 condition = foobar
18266 .endd
18267
18268 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18269 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18270 be specified using &%condition%&.
18271
18272 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18273 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18274 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18275 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18276 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18277 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18278 Router rules processing behavior.
18279
18280 This is best illustrated in an example:
18281 .code
18282 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18283 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18284
18285 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18286 true {yes} {no}}
18287
18288 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18289 {yes} {no}}
18290 .endd
18291 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18292 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18293 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18294 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18295 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18296 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18297 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18298 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18299
18300 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18301 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18302 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18303 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18304 string characters.
18305
18306 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18307 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18308 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18309 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18310 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18311
18312
18313 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18314 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18315 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18316 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18317 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18318 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18319 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18320 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18321 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18322 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18323 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18324 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18325 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18326 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18327
18328
18329
18330 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18331 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18332 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18333 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18334 transport option of the same name.
18335
18336 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18337 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18338 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18339 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18340 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18341 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18342 the dnssec request bit set.
18343 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18344
18345 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18346 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18347 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18348 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18349 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18350 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18351 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18352 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18353 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18354
18355
18356 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18357 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18358 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18359 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18360 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18361 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18362 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18363 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18364
18365
18366
18367 .option driver routers string unset
18368 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18369 to be used.
18370
18371
18372 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18373 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18374 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18375 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18376 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18377 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18378 Not effective on redirect routers.
18379
18380
18381
18382 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18383 .cindex "envelope from"
18384 .cindex "envelope sender"
18385 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18386 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18387 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18388 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18389 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18390 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18391 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18392
18393 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18394 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18395 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18396 setting.
18397
18398 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18399 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18400 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18401 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18402
18403 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18404 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18405 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18406 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18407 settings:
18408 .code
18409 errors_to =
18410 errors_to = ""
18411 .endd
18412 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18413 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18414 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18415 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18416 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18417
18418 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18419 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18420 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18421 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18422 setting &%return_path%&.
18423
18424 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18425 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18426 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18427
18428
18429
18430 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18431 .cindex "address" "testing"
18432 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18433 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18434 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18435 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18436 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18437 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18438 on for the system alias file.
18439 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18440 are evaluated.
18441
18442 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18443 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18444 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18445
18446
18447
18448 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18449 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18450 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18451 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18452
18453
18454
18455 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18456 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18457 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18458
18459
18460
18461 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18462 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18463 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18464
18465
18466
18467 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18468 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18469 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18470 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18471 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18472 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18473 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18474 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18475 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18476
18477 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18478 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18479 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18480 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18481 transport for further details.
18482
18483
18484 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18485 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18486 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18487 .cindex "transport" "local"
18488 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18489 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18490 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18491 process.
18492 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18493 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18494 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18495 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18496 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18497
18498
18499
18500 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18501 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18502 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18503 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18504 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18505 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18506 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18507 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18508 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18509 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18510 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18511 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18512 &"see"& the added header lines.
18513
18514 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18515 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18516 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18517 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18518
18519 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18520 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18521
18522 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18523 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18524
18525 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18526 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18527 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18528 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18529 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18530 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18531 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18532 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18533 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18534 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18535
18536
18537
18538 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18539 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18540 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18541 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18542 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18543 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18544 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18545 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18546 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18547 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18548 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18549 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18550 &"see"& the original header lines.
18551
18552 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18553 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18554 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18555 errors.
18556
18557 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18558 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18559
18560 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18561 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18562
18563 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18564 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18565 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18566 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18567
18568 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18569 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18570 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18571
18572
18573
18574 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18575 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18576 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18577 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18578 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18579 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18580 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18581 like
18582 .code
18583 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18584 .endd
18585 by setting
18586 .code
18587 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18588 .endd
18589 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18590 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18591 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18592 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18593 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18594 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18595
18596 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18597 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18598 .code
18599 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18600 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18601 .endd
18602 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18603 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18604
18605 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18606 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18607 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18608 domain that is being routed.
18609
18610 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18611 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18612 checked.
18613
18614 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18615 .cindex "additional groups"
18616 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18617 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18618 .cindex "transport" "local"
18619 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18620 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18621 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18622 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18623 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18624
18625
18626
18627 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18628 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18629 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18630 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18631 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18632 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18633 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18634 evaluated.
18635
18636 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18637 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18638 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18639 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18640 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18641 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18642 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18643 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18644 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18645
18646 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18647 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18648 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18649 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18650 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18651 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18652 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18653 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18654 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18655 the relevant transport.
18656
18657 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18658 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18659 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18660 callout.
18661
18662 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18663 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18664 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18665 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18666 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18667 .code
18668 real_localuser:
18669 driver = accept
18670 local_part_prefix = real-
18671 check_local_user
18672 transport = local_delivery
18673 .endd
18674 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18675 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18676 .code
18677 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18678 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18679 .endd
18680
18681 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18682 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18683 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18684 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18685
18686
18687 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18688 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18689
18690
18691
18692 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18693 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18694 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18695 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18696 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18697 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18698 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18699 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18700 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18701 &%username-foo%&.
18702
18703
18704 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18705 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18706
18707
18708
18709 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18710 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18711 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18712 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18713 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18714 are evaluated, and
18715 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18716 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18717 example:
18718 .code
18719 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18720 .endd
18721 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18722 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18723 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18724 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18725 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18726 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18727 each virtual domain:
18728 .code
18729 postmaster:
18730 driver = redirect
18731 local_parts = postmaster
18732 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18733 .endd
18734
18735
18736 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18737 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18738 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18739 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18740 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18741 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18742 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18743 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18744 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18745 redirect addresses.
18746
18747
18748
18749 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18750 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18751 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18752 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18753 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18754 delivery to be deferred.
18755
18756 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18757 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18758 .oindex "&%self%&"
18759 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18760 means of the setting
18761 .code
18762 self = pass
18763 .endd
18764 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18765 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18766 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18767
18768 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18769 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18770 controls what happens next.
18771
18772
18773 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18774 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18775 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18776 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18777 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18778 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18779 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18780 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18781
18782 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18783 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18784 applies to all of them.
18785
18786
18787
18788 .option pass_router routers string unset
18789 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18790 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18791 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18792 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18793 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18794 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18795 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18796 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18797 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18798 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18799
18800
18801
18802 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18803 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18804 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18805 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18806 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18807 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18808
18809 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18810 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18811 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18812 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18813
18814
18815
18816 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18817 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18818 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18819 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18820 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18821 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18822 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18823
18824 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18825 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18826 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18827 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18828 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18829
18830 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18831 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18832 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18833 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18834 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18835
18836 .cindex "NFS"
18837 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18838 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18839 unavailable.
18840
18841 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18842 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18843 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18844 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18845 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18846 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18847 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18848 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18849
18850 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18851 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18852 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18853 operates as follows:
18854
18855 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18856 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18857 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18858 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18859 used. For example:
18860 .code
18861 require_files = mail:/some/file
18862 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18863 .endd
18864 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18865 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18866
18867 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18868 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18869 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18870 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18871
18872 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18873 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18874 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18875 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18876 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18877
18878 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18879 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18880 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18881 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18882 check again in that process.
18883
18884 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18885 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18886 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18887 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18888 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18889 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18890 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18891 .code
18892 require_files = +/some/file
18893 .endd
18894 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18895 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18896 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18897
18898
18899
18900 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18901 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18902 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18903 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18904 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18905 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18906 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18907 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18908 latter kind.
18909
18910 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18911 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18912 .new
18913 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18914 &%check_local_user%&,
18915 &%local_parts%&,
18916 &%condition%&,
18917 &%local_part_prefix%&,
18918 &%local_part_suffix%&,
18919 &%senders%& or
18920 &%require_files%&
18921 .wen
18922 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18923 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18924 same name.
18925
18926 Failing to set this option when it is needed
18927 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18928 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18929
18930 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18931 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18932 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18933
18934
18935
18936 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18937 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18938 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18939 .vindex "&$home$&"
18940 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18941 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18942 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18943 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18944 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18945 cause the router to defer.
18946
18947 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18948 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18949 place.
18950 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18951 are evaluated.)
18952 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18953 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18954
18955 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18956 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18957 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18958 of these values that is set:
18959
18960 .ilist
18961 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18962 .next
18963 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18964 .next
18965 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18966 .next
18967 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18968 .endlist
18969
18970 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18971 router, but not for the transport.
18972
18973
18974
18975 .option self routers string freeze
18976 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18977 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18978 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18979 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18980 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18981 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18982 of remote hosts.
18983 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18984 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18985 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18986 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18987 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18988
18989 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18990 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18991 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18992 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18993 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18994 cases:
18995
18996 .vlist
18997 .vitem &%defer%&
18998 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18999
19000 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19001 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19002 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19003 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19004
19005 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19006 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19007 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19008 rewritten.
19009
19010 .vitem &%pass%&
19011 .oindex "&%more%&"
19012 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19013 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19014 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19015 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19016 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19017 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19018 combination
19019 .code
19020 self = pass
19021 no_more
19022 .endd
19023 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19024 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19025 be passed to the next router.
19026
19027 .vitem &%fail%&
19028 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19029
19030 .vitem &%send%&
19031 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19032 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19033 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19034 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19035 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19036 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19037 .endlist
19038
19039
19040
19041 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19042 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19043 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19044 address matches something on the list.
19045 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19046 are evaluated.
19047
19048 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19049 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19050 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19051 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19052 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19053 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19054 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19055 matters.
19056
19057
19058 .new
19059 .option set routers "string list" unset
19060 .cindex router variables
19061 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19062 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19063 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19064 usual way.
19065
19066 Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19067 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19068 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19069 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19070 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19071 the address.
19072 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19073 The variables can be used by the router options
19074 (not including any preconditions)
19075 and by the transport.
19076 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19077 Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19078
19079 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19080 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19081 .wen
19082
19083
19084 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19085 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19086 .cindex "packet radio"
19087 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19088 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19089 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19090 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19091 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19092 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19093 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19094 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19095
19096 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19097 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19098 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19099 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19100 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19101 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19102 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19103 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19104 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19105 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19106 .code
19107 translate_ip_address = \
19108 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19109 {$value}fail}}
19110 .endd
19111 The file would contain lines like
19112 .code
19113 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19114 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19115 .endd
19116 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19117 are doing.
19118
19119
19120
19121 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19122 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19123 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19124 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19125 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19126 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19127 delivery is deferred.
19128
19129 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19130 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19131 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19132
19133
19134
19135 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19136 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19137 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19138 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19139 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19140 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19141 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19142 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19143 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19144 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19145 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19146 environment.
19147
19148
19149
19150
19151 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19152 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19153 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19154 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19155 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19156 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19157 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19158 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19159 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19160 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19161
19162 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19163 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19164 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19165 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19166 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19167
19168 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19169 environment.
19170
19171
19172
19173
19174 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19175 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19176 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19177 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19178 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19179 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19180 delivery to be deferred.
19181
19182 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19183 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19184 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19185 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19186 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19187 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19188
19189 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19190 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19191 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19192 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19193 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19194 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19195 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19196 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19197
19198 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19199 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19200 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19201 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19202 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19203 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19204 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19205 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19206 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19207 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19208
19209 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19210 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19211 subsequent routers.
19212
19213
19214 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19215 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19216 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19217 .cindex "transport" "local"
19218 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19219 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19220 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19221 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19222 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19223 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19224 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19225 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19226 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19227 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19228 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19229 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19230
19231
19232
19233 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19234 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19235 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19236
19237
19238 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19239 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19240 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
19241 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19242 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19243 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19244 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19245 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19246 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19247 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19248
19249 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19250 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19251 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19252 user or group.
19253
19254
19255 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19256 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19257 addresses,
19258 delivering in cutthrough mode
19259 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19260 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19261 are evaluated.
19262 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19263
19264
19265 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19266 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19267 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19268 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19269 are evaluated.
19270 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19271 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19272 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19273
19274
19275
19276
19277
19278
19279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19280 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19281
19282 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19283 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19284 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19285 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19286 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19287 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19288 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19289 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19290 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19291 .code
19292 localusers:
19293 driver = accept
19294 domains = mydomain.example
19295 check_local_user
19296 transport = local_delivery
19297 .endd
19298 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19299 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19300 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19301 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19302
19303
19304
19305
19306
19307
19308 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19309 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19310
19311 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19312 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19313 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19314 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19315 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19316 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19317
19318 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19319 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19320 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19321 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19322 records.
19323
19324 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19325 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19326 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19327 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19328 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19329 generic option, the router declines.
19330
19331 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19332 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19333 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19334
19335 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19336 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19337 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19338 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19339 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19340 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19341
19342
19343 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19344 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19345 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19346 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19347 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19348 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19349
19350 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19351 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19352 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19353 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19354 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19355 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19356 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19357 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19358 case routing fails.
19359
19360
19361 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19362 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19363 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19364 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19365 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19366
19367 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19368 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19369
19370 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19371 .ilist
19372 The domain does not exist in DNS
19373 .next
19374 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19375 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19376 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19377 .next
19378 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19379 .next
19380 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19381 .next
19382 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19383 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19384 .next
19385 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19386 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19387 .next
19388 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19389 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19390 .next
19391 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19392 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19393 .endlist
19394
19395
19396
19397
19398 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19399 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19400 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19401
19402 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19403 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19404 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19405 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19406 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19407 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19408 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19409
19410
19411 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19412 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19413 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19414 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19415 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19416 required. For example,
19417 .code
19418 check_srv = smtp
19419 .endd
19420 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19421 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19422 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19423 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19424 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19425 normal way.
19426
19427 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19428 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19429 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19430 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19431 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19432 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19433
19434 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19435 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19436 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19437 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19438 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19439 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19440 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19441 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19442
19443 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19444 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19445
19446
19447
19448
19449 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19450 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19451 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19452 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19453 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19454 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19455 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19456 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19457 also being queued.
19458
19459
19460 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19461 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19462 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19463 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19464 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19465 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19466 only A records are used.
19467
19468 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19469 .cindex IPv4 preference
19470 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19471 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19472 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19473 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19474 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19475
19476 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19477 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19478 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19479 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19480 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19481 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19482 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19483 setting:
19484 .code
19485 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19486 .endd
19487 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19488 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19489 the address record.
19490
19491
19492 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19493 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19494 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19495 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19496
19497
19498
19499
19500 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19501 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19502 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19503 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19504 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19505 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19506 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19507 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19508 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19509 &'resolv.conf'&.
19510
19511
19512
19513 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19514 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19515 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19516 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19517 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19518 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19519 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19520 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19521 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19522 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19523 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19524
19525 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19526 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19527 sense.
19528
19529 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19530 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19531 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19532 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19533 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19534 header rewriting.
19535
19536
19537 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19538 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19539 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19540 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19541 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19542 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19543 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19544 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19545
19546 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19547 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19548 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19549 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19550 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19551 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19552 without processing them independently,
19553 provided the following conditions are met:
19554
19555 .ilist
19556 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19557 &%headers_remove%&.
19558 .next
19559 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19560 the domain.
19561 .endlist
19562
19563
19564
19565
19566 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19567 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19568 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19569 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19570 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19571 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19572 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19573 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19574 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19575 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19576
19577 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19578 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19579 local wildcard.
19580
19581
19582
19583 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19584 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19585 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19586 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19587
19588
19589
19590
19591 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19592 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19593 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19594 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19595 if
19596 .code
19597 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19598 .endd
19599 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19600 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19601 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19602 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19603 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19604 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19605
19606
19607 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19608 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19609 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19610 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19611 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19612
19613 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19614 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19615 such as that implied by
19616 .code
19617 domains = @mx_any
19618 .endd
19619 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19620 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19621 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19622 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19623
19624
19625
19626
19627
19628
19629
19630
19631
19632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19633 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19634
19635 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19636 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19637 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19638 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19639 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19640 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19641 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19642 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19643 router handles the address
19644 .code
19645 root@[192.168.1.1]
19646 .endd
19647 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19648 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19649 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19650 .code
19651 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19652 .endd
19653 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19654 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19655
19656 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19657 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19658 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19659 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19660
19661 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19662 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19663 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19664 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19665
19666
19667
19668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19670
19671 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19672 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19673 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19674 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19675 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19676 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19677 must set
19678 .code
19679 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19680 .endd
19681 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19682
19683 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19684 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19685 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19686 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19687 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19688 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19689 must not be specified for it.
19690
19691 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19692 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19693 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19694 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19695 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19696 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19697 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19698
19699
19700 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19701 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19702 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19703 delivery to the address is deferred.
19704
19705
19706 .option port iplookup integer 0
19707 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19708 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19709 call.
19710
19711
19712 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19713 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19714 protocols is to be used.
19715
19716
19717 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19718 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19719 default value is:
19720 .code
19721 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19722 .endd
19723 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19724 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19725
19726
19727 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19728 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19729 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19730 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19731 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19732 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19733 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19734 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19735
19736
19737 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19738 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19739 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19740 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19741 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19742 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19743 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19744 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19745 following could be used:
19746 .code
19747 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19748 reroute = $local_part@$1
19749 .endd
19750
19751 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19752 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19753 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19754 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19755
19756
19757
19758
19759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19761
19762 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19763 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19764 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19765 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19766 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19767 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19768 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19769 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19770 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19771 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19772
19773 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19774 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19775 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19776 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19777 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19778 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19779 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19780
19781 .vindex "&$host$&"
19782 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19783 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19784 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19785 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19786 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19787 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19788 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19789 text string.
19790
19791 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19792 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19793 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19794 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19795 below, following the list of private options.
19796
19797
19798 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19799
19800 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19801 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19802
19803 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19804 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19805
19806 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19807 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19808 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19809 of the following values:
19810 .code
19811 decline
19812 defer
19813 fail
19814 freeze
19815 ignore
19816 pass
19817 .endd
19818 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19819 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19820 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19821 &%pass_router%&),
19822 .oindex "&%more%&"
19823 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19824 router only if &%more%& is true.
19825
19826 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19827 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19828 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19829 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19830
19831 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19832 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19833 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19834
19835
19836 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19837 .cindex "randomized host list"
19838 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19839 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19840 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19841 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19842 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19843 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19844 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19845 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19846
19847 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19848 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19849 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19850 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19851 .code
19852 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19853 .endd
19854 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19855 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19856 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19857 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19858 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19859
19860
19861 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19862 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19863 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19864 example:
19865 .code
19866 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19867 .endd
19868 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19869 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19870 deferred.
19871
19872
19873 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19874 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19875 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19876 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19877
19878
19879 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19880 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19881 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19882 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19883 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19884 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19885 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19886 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19887
19888 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19889 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19890 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19891 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19892 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19893 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19894 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19895 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19896
19897
19898
19899
19900 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19901 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19902 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19903 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19904 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19905 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19906 .display
19907 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19908 .endd
19909 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19910 no options:
19911 .code
19912 route_list = \
19913 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19914 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19915 .endd
19916 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19917 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19918 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19919 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19920 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19921 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19922 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19923 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19924 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19925 in a &%route_list%&).
19926
19927 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19928 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19929 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19930 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19931
19932
19933
19934 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19935 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19936 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19937 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19938 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19939 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19940 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19941 like this:
19942 .code
19943 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19944 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19945 .endd
19946 This data can be accessed by setting
19947 .code
19948 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19949 .endd
19950 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19951 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19952 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19953 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19954 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19955
19956
19957
19958
19959 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19960 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19961 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19962 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19963 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19964 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19965 The format of each item
19966 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19967 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19968
19969 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19970 variables are set during its expansion:
19971
19972 .ilist
19973 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19974 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19975 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19976 .code
19977 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19978 .endd
19979 .next
19980 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19981 .next
19982 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19983
19984 .next
19985 .vindex "&$value$&"
19986 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19987 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19988 .code
19989 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19990 .endd
19991 .endlist
19992
19993 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19994 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19995
19996
19997
19998 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19999 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20000 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20001 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20002 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20003 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20004
20005 .ilist
20006 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20007 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20008 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20009 .code
20010 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20011 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20012 .endd
20013 .next
20014 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20015 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20016 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20017 number follows. For example:
20018 .code
20019 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20020 .endd
20021 .endlist
20022
20023 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20024 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20025 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20026 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20027 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20028 transport.
20029
20030 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20031 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20032 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20033 records in the DNS. For example:
20034 .code
20035 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20036 .endd
20037 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20038 example:
20039 .code
20040 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20041 .endd
20042 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20043 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20044 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20045 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20046 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20047 happens is controlled by the
20048 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20049 &%self%& option of the router.
20050
20051 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20052 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20053 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20054 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20055 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20056 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20057 defined by MX preferences.
20058
20059 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20060 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20061 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20062
20063 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20064 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20065 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20066 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20067
20068 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20069 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20070 router.
20071
20072 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20073 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20074 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20075
20076 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20077 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20078
20079
20080
20081 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20082 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20083 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20084 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20085 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20086 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20087 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20088
20089 .ilist
20090 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20091 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20092 .next
20093 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20094 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20095 .next
20096 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20097 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20098 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20099 .next
20100 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20101 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20102 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20103 .next
20104 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20105 .next
20106 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20107 .endlist
20108
20109 For example:
20110 .code
20111 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20112 domain2 host4:host5
20113 .endd
20114 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20115 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20116 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20117 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20118 call.
20119
20120 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20121 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20122 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20123 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20124 function called.
20125
20126 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20127 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20128 option specified.
20129
20130
20131
20132 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20133 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20134
20135 .vindex "&$host$&"
20136 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20137 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20138
20139
20140
20141 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20142 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20143 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20144
20145 .ilist
20146 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20147 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20148 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20149 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20150 .code
20151 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20152 .endd
20153 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20154 your first router something like this:
20155 .code
20156 smart_route:
20157 driver = manualroute
20158 domains = !+local_domains
20159 transport = remote_smtp
20160 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20161 .endd
20162 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20163 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20164 they are tried in order
20165 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20166 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20167 .code
20168 smart_route:
20169 driver = manualroute
20170 transport = remote_smtp
20171 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20172 .endd
20173 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20174 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20175 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20176 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20177 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20178 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20179 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20180 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20181
20182 .next
20183 .cindex "mail hub example"
20184 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20185 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20186 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20187 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20188 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20189 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20190 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20191 lookup is easier to manage.
20192
20193 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20194 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20195 example:
20196 .code
20197 hub_route:
20198 driver = manualroute
20199 transport = remote_smtp
20200 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20201 .endd
20202 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20203 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20204 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20205 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20206 domain can be used to find the host:
20207 .code
20208 through_firewall:
20209 driver = manualroute
20210 transport = remote_smtp
20211 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20212 .endd
20213 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20214 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20215 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20216 next router.
20217
20218 .next
20219 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20220 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20221 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20222 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20223 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20224 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20225 .code
20226 save_in_file:
20227 driver = manualroute
20228 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20229 route_list = saved.domain.example
20230 .endd
20231 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20232 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20233 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20234 .code
20235 save_in_file:
20236 driver = manualroute
20237 route_list = \
20238 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20239 *.saved.domain2.example \
20240 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20241 batch_pipe
20242 .endd
20243 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20244 .vindex "&$host$&"
20245 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20246 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20247 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20248 the address if the lookup fails.
20249
20250 .next
20251 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20252 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20253 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20254 one way it can be done:
20255 .code
20256 # Transport
20257 uucp:
20258 driver = pipe
20259 user = nobody
20260 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20261 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20262 return_fail_output = true
20263
20264 # Router
20265 uucphost:
20266 transport = uucp
20267 driver = manualroute
20268 route_data = \
20269 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20270 .endd
20271 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20272 .code
20273 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20274 .endd
20275 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20276 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20277 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20278 .endlist
20279 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20280 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20281
20282
20283
20284
20285
20286
20287
20288
20289 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20290 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20291
20292 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20293 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20294 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20295 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20296 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20297 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20298 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20299 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20300 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20301 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20302 options:
20303 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20304
20305 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20306 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20307 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20308 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20309 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20310
20311
20312 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20313 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20314 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20315 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20316 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20317 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20318
20319
20320 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20321 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20322 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20323 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20324 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20325 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20326 not set, a value for the gid also.
20327
20328 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20329 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20330 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20331 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20332 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20333 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20334 gid.
20335
20336
20337 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20338 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20339 before running the command.
20340
20341
20342 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20343 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20344 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20345 timeout.
20346
20347
20348 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20349 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20350 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20351 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20352 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20353
20354 .ilist
20355 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20356 below).
20357 .next
20358 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20359 &%no_more%& is set.
20360 .next
20361 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20362 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20363 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20364 included in the SMTP response.
20365 .next
20366 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20367 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20368 included in any SMTP response.
20369 .next
20370 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20371 .next
20372 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20373 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20374 .next
20375 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20376 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20377 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20378 .endlist
20379
20380 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20381 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20382 the page):
20383 .code
20384 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20385 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20386 .endd
20387 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20388 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20389 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20390 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20391
20392 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20393 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20394 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20395 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20396 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20397
20398 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20399 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20400 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20401 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20402 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20403
20404 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20405 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20406 variable. For example, this return line
20407 .code
20408 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20409 .endd
20410 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20411 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20412 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20413 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20414
20415
20416
20417
20418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20420
20421 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20422 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20423 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20424 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20425 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20426 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20427 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20428 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20429 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20430 redirected in several different ways:
20431
20432 .ilist
20433 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20434 independently.
20435 .next
20436 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20437 .next
20438 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20439 .next
20440 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20441 .next
20442 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20443 .next
20444 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20445 .next
20446 It can be discarded.
20447 .endlist
20448
20449 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20450 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20451 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20452 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20453
20454 If success DSNs have been requested
20455 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20456 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20457 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20458
20459
20460
20461 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20462 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20463 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20464 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20465 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20466 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20467 .code
20468 system_aliases:
20469 driver = redirect
20470 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20471 .endd
20472 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20473 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20474 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20475 cause delivery to be deferred.
20476
20477 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20478 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20479 .code
20480 userforward:
20481 driver = redirect
20482 check_local_user
20483 file = $home/.forward
20484 no_verify
20485 .endd
20486 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20487 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20488 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20489 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20490 comments.
20491
20492
20493
20494 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20495 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20496 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20497 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20498
20499 .ilist
20500 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20501 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20502 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20503 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20504 .next
20505 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20506 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20507 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20508 saves some resources.
20509 .endlist
20510
20511
20512
20513
20514
20515
20516 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20517 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20518 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20519 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20520 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20521
20522 .ilist
20523 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20524 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20525 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20526 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20527 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20528 document is intended for use by end users.
20529 .next
20530 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20531 described in the next section.
20532 .endlist
20533
20534 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20535 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20536 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20537 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20538 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20539
20540
20541
20542 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20543 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20544 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20545 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20546 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20547 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20548 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20549 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20550 commas or newlines.
20551 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20552 quotes.
20553
20554 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20555 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20556 next newline character is ignored.
20557
20558 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20559 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20560 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20561 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20562 removed.
20563
20564 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20565 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20566 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20567 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20568 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20569 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20570 setting:
20571 .code
20572 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20573 .endd
20574
20575
20576 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20577 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20578 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20579 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20580 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20581 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20582 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20583 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20584 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20585 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20586 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20587
20588 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20589 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20590 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20591 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20592 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20593 .code
20594 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20595 .endd
20596 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20597 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20598 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20599 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20600 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20601 synonymously.
20602
20603 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20604 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20605 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20606 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20607 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20608
20609 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20610 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20611 contains:
20612 .code
20613 Sam.Reman: spqr
20614 .endd
20615 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20616 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20617 this forward file:
20618 .code
20619 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20620 .endd
20621 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20622 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20623 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20624 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20625 should really contain
20626 .code
20627 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20628 .endd
20629 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20630 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20631 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20632
20633
20634
20635 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20636 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20637 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20638
20639 .ilist
20640 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20641 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20642 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20643 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20644 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20645 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20646 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20647
20648 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20649 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20650 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20651 in double quotes, for example:
20652 .code
20653 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20654 .endd
20655 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20656 quote just the command. An item such as
20657 .code
20658 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20659 .endd
20660 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20661
20662 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20663 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20664 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20665 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20666 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20667 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20668 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20669 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20670 an &%accept%& router.
20671
20672 .next
20673 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20674 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20675 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20676 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20677 .code
20678 /home/world/minbari
20679 .endd
20680 is treated as a filename, but
20681 .code
20682 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20683 .endd
20684 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20685 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20686 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20687 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20688
20689 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20690 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20691
20692 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20693 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20694 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20695 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20696
20697 .next
20698 .cindex "included address list"
20699 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20700 If an item is of the form
20701 .code
20702 :include:<path name>
20703 .endd
20704 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20705 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20706 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20707 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20708 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20709 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20710 .code
20711 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20712 .endd
20713 It must be given as
20714 .code
20715 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20716 .endd
20717 .next
20718 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20719 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20720 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20721 .cindex "black hole"
20722 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20723 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20724 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20725 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20726 .code
20727 :blackhole:
20728 .endd
20729 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20730 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20731 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20732
20733 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20734 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20735 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20736 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20737 &_/dev/null_&.
20738
20739 .next
20740 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20741 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20742 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20743 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20744 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20745 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20746 redirection items of the form
20747 .code
20748 :defer:
20749 :fail:
20750 .endd
20751 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20752 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20753 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20754 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20755 .code
20756 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20757 .endd
20758 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20759 of a
20760 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20761 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20762 default.
20763 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20764 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20765 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20766
20767 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20768 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20769 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20770 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20771 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20772 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20773 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20774 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20775 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20776 ignored.
20777
20778 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20779 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20780 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20781 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20782
20783 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20784 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20785 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20786 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20787 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20788
20789 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20790 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20791 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20792 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20793 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20794 rules still apply.
20795
20796 .next
20797 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20798 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20799 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20800 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20801 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20802 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20803 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20804 .endlist
20805
20806
20807 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20808 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20809 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20810 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20811 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20812 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20813 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20814 aliasing scheme of the type
20815 .code
20816 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20817 localpart1: pipe
20818 localpart2: pipe
20819 .endd
20820 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20821 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20822 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20823 such as
20824 .code
20825 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20826 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20827 .endd
20828 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20829 the pipes are distinct.
20830
20831
20832
20833 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20834 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20835 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20836 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20837 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20838 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20839 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20840 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20841 can be used to avoid this.
20842
20843
20844 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20845 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20846 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20847 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20848 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20849 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20850 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20851
20852
20853
20854 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20855
20856 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20857 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20858
20859
20860 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20861 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20862 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20863
20864
20865 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20866 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20867 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20868 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20869
20870
20871 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20872 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20873 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20874 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20875 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20876 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20877 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20878
20879 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20880 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20881
20882
20883 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20884 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20885 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20886 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20887 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20888
20889
20890
20891 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20892 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20893 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20894 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20895 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20896 let ordinary users do.
20897
20898
20899
20900 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20901 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20902 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20903 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20904 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20905 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20906
20907 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20908 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20909 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20910 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20911 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20912 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20913 .code
20914 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20915 .endd
20916 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20917 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20918 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20919 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20920 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20921 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20922 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20923 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20924
20925
20926 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20927 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20928 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20929 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20930 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20931 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20932 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20933 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20934
20935
20936
20937 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20938 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20939 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20940 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20941 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20942 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20943
20944
20945 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20946 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20947 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20948 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20949 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20950 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20951
20952 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20953 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20954 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20955 .code
20956 data = #Exim filter\n\
20957 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20958 .endd
20959 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20960 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20961 choice into a newline.
20962
20963
20964 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20965 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20966 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20967 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20968 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20969
20970
20971 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20972 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20973 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20974 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20975 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20976 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20977 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20978 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20979
20980 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20981 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20982 runs a check on the containing directory,
20983 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20984 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20985 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20986 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20987 not, the router declines.
20988
20989
20990 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20991 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20992 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20993 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20994 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20995 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20996 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20997
20998
20999 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21000 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21001 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21002 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21003 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21004
21005
21006 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21007 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21008 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21009 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21010 redirection list.
21011
21012
21013 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21014 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21015 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21016 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21017 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21018
21019
21020
21021
21022 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21023 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21024 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21025 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21026 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21027 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21028 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21029 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21030 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21031 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21032 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21033
21034
21035 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21036 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21037 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21038 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21039 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21040 functions.
21041
21042 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21043 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21044 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21045 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21046 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21047 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21048
21049 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21050 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21051 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21052 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21053 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21054 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21055 &_.forward_& files).
21056
21057
21058 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21059 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21060 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21061 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21062 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21063
21064
21065 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21066 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21067 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21068 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21069 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21070 of the embedded Perl support.
21071
21072
21073 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21074 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21075 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21076 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21077 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21078
21079
21080 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21081 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21082 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21083 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21084 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21085
21086
21087 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21088 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21089 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21090 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21091 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21092 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21093 &%one_time%& is set.
21094
21095
21096 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21097 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21098 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21099 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21100 to make use of &%run%& items.
21101
21102
21103 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21104 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21105 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21106 If this option is true, items of the form
21107 .code
21108 :include:<path name>
21109 .endd
21110 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21111
21112
21113 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21114 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21115 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21116 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21117 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21118 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21119 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21120
21121
21122 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21123 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21124 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21125 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21126 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21127
21128
21129 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21130 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21131 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21132 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21133 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21134
21135
21136
21137
21138 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21139 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21140 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21141 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21142 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21143 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21144 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21145
21146
21147 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21148 .cindex "EACCES"
21149 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21150 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21151 file did not exist.
21152
21153
21154 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21155 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
21156 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21157 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21158 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21159
21160 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21161 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21162 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21163 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21164 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21165 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21166 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21167 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21168
21169
21170
21171 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21172 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21173 redirection list must start with this directory.
21174
21175
21176 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21177 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21178 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21179
21180
21181 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21182 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21183 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21184 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21185 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21186 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21187 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21188 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21189 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21190 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21191 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21192 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21193 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21194 before they subscribed.
21195
21196 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21197 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21198 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21199 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21200 attempt.
21201
21202 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21203 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21204 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21205 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21206
21207 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21208 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21209 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21210
21211 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21212 &%one_time%&.
21213
21214 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21215 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21216 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21217 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21218 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21219 expansion.
21220
21221
21222 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21223 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21224 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21225 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21226 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21227 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21228 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21229 See &%check_owner%& above.
21230
21231
21232 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21233 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21234 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21235 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21236
21237
21238 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21239 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21240 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21241 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21242 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21243 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21244 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21245
21246
21247 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21248 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21249 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21250 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21251 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21252 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21253 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21254 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21255
21256 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21257 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21258 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21259 addresses.
21260
21261 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21262 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21263 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21264 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21265 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21266 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21267 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21268 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21269 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21270 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21271
21272
21273 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21274 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21275 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21276 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21277 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21278 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21279
21280
21281 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21282 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21283 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21284 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21285 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21286 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21287
21288
21289 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21290 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21291 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21292 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21293 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21294
21295
21296 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21297 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21298 :subaddress part of an address.
21299
21300 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21301 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21302 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21303 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21304
21305
21306 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21307 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21308 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21309 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21310 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21311 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21312 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21313
21314
21315
21316 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21317 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21318 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21319 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21320 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21321 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21322 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21323 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21324 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21325 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21326 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21327 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21328 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21329 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21330 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21331 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21332
21333 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21334 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21335 the following routers.
21336
21337 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21338 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21339 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21340 so it is passed to the following routers.
21341
21342 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21343 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21344 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21345 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21346
21347 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21348 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21349 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21350 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21351 .code
21352 userforward:
21353 driver = redirect
21354 allow_filter
21355 check_local_user
21356 file = $home/.forward
21357 file_transport = address_file
21358 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21359 reply_transport = address_reply
21360 no_verify
21361 skip_syntax_errors
21362 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21363 syntax_errors_text = \
21364 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21365 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21366 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21367 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21368 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21369 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21370 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21371 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21372 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21373 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21374 .endd
21375 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21376 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21377 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21378 .code
21379 real_localuser:
21380 driver = accept
21381 check_local_user
21382 local_part_prefix = real-
21383 transport = local_delivery
21384 .endd
21385 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21386 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21387 .code
21388 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21389 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21390 .endd
21391
21392
21393 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21394 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21395
21396
21397 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21398 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21399 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21400 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21401
21402
21403
21404
21405
21406
21407 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21409
21410 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21411 "Environment for local transports"
21412 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21413 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21414 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21415 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21416 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21417 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21418 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21419
21420 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21421 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21422 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21423 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21424
21425 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21426 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21427 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21428 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21429 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21430
21431
21432
21433 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21434 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21435 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21436 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21437 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21438 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21439 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21440 time.
21441
21442 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21443 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21444 .code
21445 my_transport:
21446 driver = pipe
21447 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21448 .endd
21449 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21450 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21451 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21452 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21453
21454
21455
21456
21457 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21458 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21459 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21460 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21461 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21462 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21463 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21464 group (set by the transport). For example:
21465 .code
21466 # Routers ...
21467 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21468 local_users:
21469 driver = accept
21470 check_local_user
21471 transport = group_delivery
21472
21473 # Transports ...
21474 # This transport overrides the group
21475 group_delivery:
21476 driver = appendfile
21477 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21478 group = mail
21479 .endd
21480 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21481 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21482 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21483 set.
21484
21485 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21486 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21487 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21488 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21489 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21490 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21491
21492 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21493 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21494 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21495 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21496 original gid is also used.
21497
21498 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21499 following that is set is used:
21500
21501 .ilist
21502 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21503 .next
21504 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21505 .next
21506 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21507 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21508 .next
21509 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21510 .next
21511 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21512 the uid is the creator's uid;
21513 .next
21514 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21515 .endlist
21516
21517 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21518 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21519 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21520 The first of the following that is set is used:
21521
21522 .ilist
21523 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21524 .next
21525 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21526 .next
21527 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21528 .next
21529 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21530 .next
21531 The Exim uid.
21532 .endlist
21533
21534 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21535 &%never_users%& list.
21536
21537
21538
21539
21540
21541 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21542 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21543 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21544 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21545 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21546 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21547 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21548 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21549 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21550 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21551
21552 .ilist
21553 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21554 .next
21555 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21556 .next
21557 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21558 .next
21559 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21560 .endlist
21561
21562 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21563
21564 .ilist
21565 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21566 .next
21567 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21568 .endlist
21569
21570
21571 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21572 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21573 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21574
21575
21576
21577 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21578 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21579 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21580 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21581 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21582 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21583 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21584 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21585 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21586 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21587 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21588 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21589 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21590 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21591
21592
21593
21594
21595
21596
21597
21598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21600
21601 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21602 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21603 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21604 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21605 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21606
21607
21608 .option body_only transports boolean false
21609 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21610 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21611 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21612 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21613 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21614 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21615 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21616 automatically suppress them.
21617
21618
21619 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21620 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21621 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21622 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21623 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21624 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21625
21626
21627 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21628 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21629 deliveries by the transport or for any
21630 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21631 what you are doing.
21632
21633
21634 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21635 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21636 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21637 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21638 transport is run.
21639 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21640 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21641 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21642 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21643 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21644 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21645 one.
21646 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21647 transport and the router that called it.
21648
21649 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21650 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21651 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21652 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21653 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21654 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21655 safely be resent to other recipients.
21656
21657
21658 .option driver transports string unset
21659 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21660 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21661
21662
21663 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21664 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21665 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21666 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21667 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21668 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21669 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21670 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21671 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21672 resent to other recipients.
21673
21674
21675 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21676 .cindex events
21677 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21678 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21679
21680
21681 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21682 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21683 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21684 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21685 &%user%& (see below).
21686
21687
21688 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21689 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21690 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21691 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21692 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21693 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21694 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21695 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21696 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21697 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21698 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21699
21700 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21701 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21702
21703
21704 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21705 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21706 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21707 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21708 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21709 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21710 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21711 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21712
21713
21714 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21715 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21716 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21717 This option specifies a list of header names,
21718 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21719 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21720 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21721 routers.
21722 Each list item is separately expanded.
21723 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21724 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21725 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21726
21727 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21728 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21729
21730 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21731 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21732 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21733
21734
21735
21736 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21737 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21738 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21739 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21740 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21741 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21742 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21743 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21744 example,
21745 .code
21746 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21747 x@y w@z
21748 .endd
21749 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21750 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21751 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21752 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21753 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21754 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21755 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21756 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21757 change envelope recipients at this time.
21758
21759
21760 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21761 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21762 .vindex "&$home$&"
21763 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21764 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21765 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21766 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21767 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21768 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21769 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21770 deferred.
21771
21772
21773 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21774 .cindex "additional groups"
21775 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21776 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21777 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21778 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21779 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21780
21781
21782 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21783 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21784 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21785 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21786 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21787 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21788 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21789 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21790
21791 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21792 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21793 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21794 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21795 Obviously there is scope for
21796 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21797 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21798
21799 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21800 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21801 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21802 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21803 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21804
21805
21806 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21807 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21808 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21809 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21810 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21811 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21812 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21813 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21814 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21815 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21816 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21817 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21818 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21819 delivered.
21820
21821
21822
21823 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21824 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21825 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21826 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21827 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21828 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21829 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21830 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21831 that contains
21832 .code
21833 local_part_prefix = *-
21834 .endd
21835 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21836 is delivered with
21837 .code
21838 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21839 .endd
21840 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21841 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21842 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21843 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21844 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21845
21846
21847 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21848 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21849 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21850 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21851 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21852 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21853 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21854 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21855 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21856
21857 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21858 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21859 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21860 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21861
21862 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21863 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21864 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21865
21866
21867 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21868 .cindex "envelope sender"
21869 .cindex "envelope from"
21870 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21871 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21872 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21873 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21874 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21875 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21876 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21877 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21878 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21879
21880 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21881 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21882
21883 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21884 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21885 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21886 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21887 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21888 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21889 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21890
21891 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21892 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21893 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21894 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21895 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21896
21897
21898
21899 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21900 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21901 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21902 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21903 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21904 have easy access to it.
21905
21906 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21907 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21908 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21909 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21910 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21911 recipients.
21912
21913
21914 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21915 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21916
21917
21918 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21919 .cindex "shadow transport"
21920 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21921 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21922 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21923
21924 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21925 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21926 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21927 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21928 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21929 cause a log line to be written.
21930
21931 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21932 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21933 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21934 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21935 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21936 of the form
21937 .code
21938 ST=<shadow transport name>
21939 .endd
21940 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21941 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21942 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21943 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21944 headers that some sites insist on.
21945
21946
21947 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21948 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21949 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21950 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21951 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21952 individual users or via a system filter.
21953 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21954
21955 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21956 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21957 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21958 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21959 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21960
21961 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21962 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21963 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21964 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21965 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21966 &(pipe)& transports.
21967
21968 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21969 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21970 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21971 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21972 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21973
21974 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21975 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21976 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21977 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21978
21979 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21980 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21981 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21982 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21983 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21984 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21985
21986 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21987 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21988 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21989 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21990 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21991 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21992 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21993 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21994
21995 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21996 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21997 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21998 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21999 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22000 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22001 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22002 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22003 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22004 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22005
22006 .vindex "&$host$&"
22007 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22008 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22009 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22010 which the message is being sent. For example:
22011 .code
22012 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22013 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22014 .endd
22015
22016 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22017 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22018 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22019 .ilist
22020 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22021 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22022 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22023 example:
22024 .code
22025 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22026 .endd
22027 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22028 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22029 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22030 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22031 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22032 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22033 .next
22034 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22035 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22036 arguments. Consider this example:
22037 .code
22038 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22039 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22040 .endd
22041 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22042 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22043 .code
22044 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22045 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22046 .endd
22047 .endlist
22048
22049 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22050 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22051 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22052 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22053 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22054 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22055 bounced from a transport filter.
22056
22057 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22058 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22059 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22060
22061
22062 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22063 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22064 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22065 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22066 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22067 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22068 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22069 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22070 becomes a temporary error.
22071
22072
22073 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22074 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22075 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22076 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22077 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22078 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22079 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22080 option is not set.
22081
22082 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22083 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22084 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22085
22086 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22087 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22088 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22089 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22090 retry data.
22091 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22092 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22093 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22094
22095
22096
22097
22098
22099
22100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22102
22103 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22104 "Address batching"
22105 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22106 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22107 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22108 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22109 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22110 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22111 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22112
22113 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22114 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22115 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22116 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22117 local transport, for example:
22118
22119 .ilist
22120 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22121 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22122 recipients saves space.
22123 .next
22124 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22125 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22126 .next
22127 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22128 to a scanner program or
22129 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22130 acceptable.
22131 .endlist
22132
22133 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22134 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22135 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22136
22137 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22138 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22139 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22140 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22141 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22142 to certain conditions:
22143
22144 .ilist
22145 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22146 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22147 batching is possible.
22148 .next
22149 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22150 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22151 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22152 .next
22153 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22154 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22155 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22156 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22157 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22158 from taking place.
22159 .next
22160 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22161 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22162 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22163 be the same.
22164 .endlist
22165
22166 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22167 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22168 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22169 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22170 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22171 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22172 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22173 .code
22174 check_string = "."
22175 escape_string = ".."
22176 .endd
22177 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22178 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22179 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22180
22181 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22182 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22183 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22184 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22185 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22186 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22187
22188 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22189 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22190 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22191 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22192 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22193 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22194 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22195 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22196 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22197
22198
22199
22200
22201 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22203
22204 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22205 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22206 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22207 .cindex "directory creation"
22208 .cindex "creating directories"
22209 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22210 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22211 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22212 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22213 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22214 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22215 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22216 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22217 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22218 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22219
22220 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22221 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22222 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22223 included.
22224
22225 .cindex "quota" "system"
22226 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22227 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22228 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22229
22230 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22231 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22232 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22233 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22234
22235 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22236 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22237 private options.
22238
22239 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22240 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22241 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22242 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22243 option).
22244
22245
22246
22247 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22248 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22249 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22250 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22251 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22252
22253 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22254 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22255 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22256 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22257 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22258 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22259 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22260 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22261 operation. There are two cases:
22262
22263 .ilist
22264 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22265 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22266 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22267 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22268 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22269 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22270 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22271 .next
22272 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22273 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22274 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22275 .endlist
22276
22277
22278 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22279 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22280 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22281 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22282 form:
22283 .code
22284 save folder23
22285 .endd
22286 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22287 .code
22288 require "fileinto";
22289 fileinto "folder23";
22290 .endd
22291 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22292 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22293 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22294 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22295 way of handling this requirement:
22296 .code
22297 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22298 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22299 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22300 {$address_file} \
22301 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22302 }} \
22303 }
22304 .endd
22305 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22306 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22307 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22308
22309 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22310 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22311 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22312 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22313 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22314 path to the transport.
22315
22316 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22317 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22318
22319
22320
22321
22322 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22323 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22324
22325
22326
22327 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22328 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22329 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22330 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22331 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22332 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22333 delivery is deferred.
22334
22335
22336 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22337 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22338 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22339 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22340 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22341 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22342 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22343 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22344
22345
22346 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22347 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22348 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22349 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22350 file.
22351
22352
22353 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22354 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22355
22356
22357 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22358 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22359 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22360 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22361 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22362
22363
22364 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22365 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22366 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22367 process is running.
22368
22369
22370 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22371 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22372 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22373 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22374 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22375 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22376 contains is significant.
22377
22378 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22379 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22380 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22381 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22382 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22383
22384 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22385 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22386 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22387 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22388 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22389 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22390 .code
22391 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22392 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22393 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22394 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22395 .endd
22396 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22397 .cindex "directory creation"
22398 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22399 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22400 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22401
22402 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22403 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22404 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22405 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22406 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22407
22408
22409
22410 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22411 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22412 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22413 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22414 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22415 beneath.
22416
22417 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22418 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22419 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22420 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22421 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22422 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22423 &%file_must_exist%&.
22424
22425
22426 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22427 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22428 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22429 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22430
22431 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22432 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22433 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22434 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22435 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22436
22437
22438 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22439 .cindex "base62"
22440 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22441 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22442 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22443 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22444 .code
22445 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22446 .endd
22447 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22448 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22449 option.
22450
22451
22452 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22453 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22454 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22455
22456
22457 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22458 See &%check_string%& above.
22459
22460
22461 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22462 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22463 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22464 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22465 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22466 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22467 &%file%&.
22468
22469 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22470 .cindex "locking files"
22471 .cindex "lock files"
22472 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22473 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22474
22475 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22476 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22477 examples:
22478 .code
22479 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22480 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22481 file = $home/inbox
22482 .endd
22483 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22484 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22485 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22486 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22487 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22488 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22489
22490
22491
22492 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22493 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22494 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22495 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22496 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22497 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22498 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22499 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22500 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22501 this added to it:
22502 .code
22503 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22504 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22505 .endd
22506 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22507 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22508 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22509 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22510 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22511 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22512 delivery is deferred.
22513
22514
22515 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22516 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22517 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22518 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22519
22520
22521 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22522 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22523 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22524 .cindex "locking files"
22525 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22526 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22527 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22528 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22529 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22530 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22531 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22532 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22533
22534 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22535 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22536 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22537 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22538
22539 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22540 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22541 retries is
22542 .code
22543 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22544 .endd
22545 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22546 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22547 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22548
22549 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22550 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22551 .code
22552 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22553 .endd
22554
22555 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22556 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22557 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22558 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22559
22560
22561 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22562 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22563 for details of locking.
22564
22565
22566 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22567 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22568 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22569
22570
22571 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22572 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22573 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22574
22575
22576 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22577 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22578 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22579 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22580 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22581
22582
22583 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22584 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22585 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22586 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22587 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22588 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22589 external source that maintains the data.
22590
22591
22592 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22593 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22594 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22595 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22596 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22597 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22598 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22599 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22600
22601
22602
22603 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22604 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22605 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22606 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22607 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22608 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22609 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22610 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22611 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22612 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22613
22614
22615 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22616 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22617 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22618 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22619 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22620 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22621 calculation. The default value is:
22622 .code
22623 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22624 .endd
22625 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22626 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22627 &_Trash_&
22628 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22629 .code
22630 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22631 .endd
22632 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22633 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22634 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22635 directly into that directory.
22636
22637
22638 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22639 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22640 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22641
22642
22643 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22644 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22645 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22646
22647
22648 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22649 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22650 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22651 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22652 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22653 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22654 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22655 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22656
22657 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22658 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22659 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22660 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22661 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22662 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22663 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22664 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22665 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22666 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22667
22668
22669 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22670 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22671 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22672 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22673 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22674 below for further details.
22675
22676
22677 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22678 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22679 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22680
22681
22682 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22683 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22684 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22685
22686
22687 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22688 .cindex "locking files"
22689 .cindex "file" "locking"
22690 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22691 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22692 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22693 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22694 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22695 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22696 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22697
22698 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22699 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22700 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22701 combination:
22702 .code
22703 mbx_format = true
22704 message_prefix =
22705 message_suffix =
22706 .endd
22707 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22708 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22709 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22710 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22711 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22712 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22713 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22714 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22715
22716 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22717 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22718 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22719 append messages to it.
22720
22721
22722 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22723 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22724 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22725 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22726 in which case it is:
22727 .code
22728 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22729 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22730 .endd
22731 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22732 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22733
22734 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22735 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22736 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22737 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22738 setting
22739 .code
22740 message_suffix =
22741 .endd
22742 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22743 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22744
22745 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22746 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22747 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22748 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22749 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22750 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22751 value, and this option is ignored.
22752
22753
22754 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22755 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22756 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22757 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22758 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22759
22760
22761 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22762 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22763 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22764 on users about incoming mail.
22765
22766
22767 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22768 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22769 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22770 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22771 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22772 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22773 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22774 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22775 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22776
22777 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22778 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22779 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22780
22781 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22782 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22783 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22784 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22785 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22786 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22787
22788 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22789 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22790 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22791 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22792 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22793 be handled.
22794
22795 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22796 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22797
22798 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22799
22800 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22801 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22802 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22803 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22804 system quota failures.
22805
22806 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22807 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22808 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22809 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22810 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22811 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22812 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22813 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22814 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22815 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22816
22817
22818 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22819 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22820 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22821 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22822 delivery directory.
22823
22824
22825 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22826 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22827 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22828 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22829 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22830 &"no quota"&.
22831
22832 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22833 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22834
22835 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22836 See &%quota%& above.
22837
22838
22839 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22840 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22841 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22842 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22843 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22844 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22845 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22846
22847 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22848 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22849 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22850 the file length to the filename. For example:
22851 .code
22852 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22853 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22854 .endd
22855 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22856 number of lines in the message.
22857
22858 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22859 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22860 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22861
22862 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22863
22864 .new
22865 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22866 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22867 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22868 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22869 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22870 as is used to adjust the effective size.
22871 .wen
22872
22873
22874 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22875 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22876 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22877 .code
22878 quota_warn_message = "\
22879 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22880 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22881 This message is automatically created \
22882 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22883 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22884 a warning threshold that is\n\
22885 set by the system administrator.\n"
22886 .endd
22887
22888
22889 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22890 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22891 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22892 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22893 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22894 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22895 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22896 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22897 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22898 sign. For example:
22899 .code
22900 quota = 10M
22901 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22902 .endd
22903 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22904 percent sign is ignored.
22905
22906 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22907 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22908 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22909 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22910 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22911 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22912 .code
22913 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22914 .endd
22915 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22916 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22917 option.
22918
22919 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22920 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22921 percentage.
22922
22923
22924 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22925 .cindex "envelope from"
22926 .cindex "envelope sender"
22927 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22928 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22929 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22930 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22931 for details of batch SMTP.
22932
22933
22934 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22935 .cindex "carriage return"
22936 .cindex "linefeed"
22937 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22938 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22939 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22940 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22941
22942 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22943 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22944 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22945 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22946 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22947 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22948
22949
22950 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22951 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22952 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22953 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22954 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22955 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22956
22957
22958 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22959 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22960 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22961 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22962 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22963
22964 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22965 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22966 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22967 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22968
22969 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22970 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22971 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22972 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22973 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22974 error.
22975
22976 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22977 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22978
22979
22980 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22981 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22982 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22983 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22984 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22985 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22986 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22987
22988 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22989 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22990 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22991 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22992 file corruption.
22993
22994 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22995 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22996 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22997
22998
22999 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23000 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23001 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23002 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23003 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23004 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23005 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23006 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23007 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23008
23009 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23010 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23011 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23012 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23013
23014
23015
23016
23017 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23018 .cindex "appending to a file"
23019 .cindex "file" "appending"
23020 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23021
23022 .ilist
23023 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23024 return is given.
23025
23026 .next
23027 .cindex "directory creation"
23028 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23029 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23030 &%directory_mode%& option.
23031
23032 .next
23033 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23034 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23035 transport.
23036
23037 .next
23038 .cindex "file" "locking"
23039 .cindex "locking files"
23040 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23041 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23042 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23043
23044 .olist
23045 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23046 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23047 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23048 .next
23049 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23050 .next
23051 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23052 Unlink the hitching post name.
23053 .next
23054 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23055 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23056 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23057 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23058 .next
23059 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23060 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23061 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23062 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23063 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23064 it before trying again.
23065 .endlist olist
23066
23067 .next
23068 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23069 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23070 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23071
23072 .next
23073 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23074 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23075 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23076 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23077 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23078 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23079 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23080 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23081 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23082 checked.
23083
23084 .next
23085 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23086 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23087 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23088 delivery is deferred.
23089
23090 .next
23091 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23092 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23093 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23094 permissions.
23095
23096 .next
23097 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23098 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23099 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23100
23101 .next
23102 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23103 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23104 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23105
23106 .next
23107 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23108 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23109 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23110 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23111 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23112 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23113 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23114 that prevents link following.
23115
23116 .next
23117 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23118 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23119 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23120 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23121 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23122
23123 .next
23124 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23125
23126 .next
23127 .cindex "file" "locking"
23128 .cindex "locking files"
23129 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23130 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23131 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23132 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23133 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23134 .code
23135 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23136 .endd
23137 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23138 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23139 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23140
23141 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23142 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23143 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23144
23145 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23146 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23147 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23148 delivery is deferred.
23149
23150 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23151 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23152 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23153 immediately. It retries up to
23154 .code
23155 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23156 .endd
23157 times (rounded up).
23158 .endlist
23159
23160 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23161 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23162
23163
23164 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23165 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23166 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23167 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23168 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23169 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23170 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23171 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23172 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23173 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23174
23175 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23176 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23177 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23178 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23179 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23180 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23181 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23182
23183 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23184 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23185 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23186 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23187
23188
23189 .cindex "maildir format"
23190 .cindex "mailstore format"
23191 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23192 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23193 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23194 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23195 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23196
23197 .cindex "directory creation"
23198 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23199 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23200 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23201 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23202 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23203 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23204 deferred.
23205
23206
23207
23208 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23209 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23210 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23211 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23212 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23213 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23214 &_new_& subdirectory.
23215
23216 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23217 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23218 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23219 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23220 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23221 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23222 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23223
23224 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23225 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23226 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23227 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23228 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23229 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23230 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23231 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23232
23233 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23234 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23235 folders. Consider this example:
23236 .code
23237 maildir_format = true
23238 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23239 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23240 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23241 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23242 .endd
23243 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23244 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23245 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23246 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23247 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23248 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23249
23250 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23251 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23252 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23253 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23254 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23255
23256 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23257 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23258 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23259
23260 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23261 .cindex "maildir++"
23262 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23263 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23264 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23265 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23266 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23267 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23268 amount of space used.
23269
23270 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23271 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23272 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23273 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23274 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23275 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23276
23277
23278
23279
23280 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23281 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23282 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23283 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23284 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23285 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23286
23287
23288 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23289 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23290 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23291 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23292 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23293 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23294 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23295 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23296 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23297 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23298 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23299 backwards compatibility).
23300
23301 For one common implementation, you might set:
23302 .code
23303 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23304 .endd
23305 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23306
23307 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23308 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23309 &[stat()]& each message file.
23310
23311
23312 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23313 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23314 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23315 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23316 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23317 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23318 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23319 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23320 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23321
23322 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23323 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23324 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23325 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23326 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23327 need to know the quota.
23328
23329 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23330 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23331
23332 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23333 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23334 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23335 details.
23336
23337
23338 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23339 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23340 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23341 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23342 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23343 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23344 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23345 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23346
23347 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23348 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23349 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23350 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23351 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23352 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23353
23354 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23355 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23356 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23357 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23358 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23359 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23360
23361 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23362 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23363 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23364 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23365
23366
23367 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23368 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23369 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23370 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23371 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23372 .code
23373 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23374 .endd
23375 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23376 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23377 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23378 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23379 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23380
23381
23382
23383
23384
23385
23386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23388
23389 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23390 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23391 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23392 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23393 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23394 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23395 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23396 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23397
23398 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23399 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23400 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23401 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23402 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23403
23404
23405 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23406 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23407 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23408 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23409 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23410
23411 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23412 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23413 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23414 transport is run as a consequence of a
23415 &%mail%&
23416 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23417 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23418 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23419 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23420 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23421 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23422
23423 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23424 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23425 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23426 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23427
23428 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23429 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23430 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23431 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23432 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23433 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23434 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23435
23436 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23437 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23438 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23439 the transport defers.
23440 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23441 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23442
23443 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23444 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23445 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23446 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23447
23448 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23449 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23450 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23451 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23452 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23453 problems. They are just discarded.
23454
23455
23456
23457 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23458 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23459
23460 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23461 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23462 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23463
23464
23465 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23466 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23467 when the message is specified by the transport.
23468
23469
23470 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23471 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23472 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23473 string comes first.
23474
23475
23476 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23477 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23478 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23479
23480
23481 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23482 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23483 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23484
23485
23486 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23487 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23488 specified by the transport.
23489
23490
23491 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23492 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23493 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23494 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23495
23496
23497 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23498 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23499 the message is specified by the transport.
23500
23501
23502 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23503 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23504 used.
23505
23506
23507 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23508 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23509 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23510 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23511 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23512
23513
23514
23515 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23516 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23517 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23518 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23519
23520 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23521 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23522 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23523 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23524 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23525 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23526 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23527 infinity.
23528
23529 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23530 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23531 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23532 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23533 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23534
23535 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23536 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23537 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23538 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23539 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23540 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23541
23542
23543 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23544 See &%once%& above.
23545
23546
23547 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23548 See &%once%& above.
23549 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23550
23551
23552 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23553 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23554 specified by the transport.
23555
23556
23557 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23558 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23559 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23560 configuration option.
23561
23562
23563 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23564 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23565 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23566 automatic responses. For example:
23567 .code
23568 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23569 .endd
23570 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23571 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23572 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23573 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23574 small.
23575
23576
23577
23578 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23579 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23580 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23581 the text comes first.
23582
23583
23584 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23585 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23586 when the message is specified by the transport.
23587 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23588 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23589
23590
23591
23592
23593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23595
23596 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23597 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23598 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23599 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23600 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23601 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23602 specified command
23603 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23604 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23605 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23606 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23607 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23608 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23609 .code
23610 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23611 .endd
23612 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23613 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23614 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23615 as follows:
23616
23617 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23618 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23619
23620
23621 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23622 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23623 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23624 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23625 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23626
23627
23628 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23629 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23630 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23631 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23632 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23633 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23634 LMTP protocol.
23635
23636 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23637 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23638 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23639 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23640 in its response to the LHLO command.
23641
23642 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23643 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23644 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23645 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23646
23647
23648 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23649 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23650 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23651 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23652 LMTP transport:
23653 .code
23654 lmtp:
23655 driver = lmtp
23656 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23657 batch_max = 20
23658 user = exim
23659 .endd
23660 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23661 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23662
23663
23664
23665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23667
23668 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23669 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23670 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23671 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23672 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23673 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23674 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23675 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23676 following ways:
23677
23678 .ilist
23679 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23680 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23681 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23682 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23683 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23684 .next
23685 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23686 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23687 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23688 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23689 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23690 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23691 that are routed to the transport.
23692 .next
23693 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23694 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23695 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23696 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23697 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23698 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23699 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23700 .endlist
23701
23702
23703 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23704 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23705 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23706
23707 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23708 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23709 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23710 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23711 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23712 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23713 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23714
23715
23716 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23717 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23718 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23719 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23720 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23721 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23722 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23723
23724
23725
23726
23727 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23728 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23729 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23730 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23731 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23732 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23733 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23734 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23735 &"local delivery failed"&.
23736
23737 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23738 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23739 will be sent as normal.
23740
23741 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23742 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23743 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23744 apply in this case.
23745
23746 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23747 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23748 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23749 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23750
23751 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23752 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23753 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23754 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23755 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23756 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23757 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23758 &%temp_errors%&.
23759
23760
23761
23762 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23763 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23764 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23765 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23766 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23767 run.
23768
23769 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23770 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23771 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23772 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23773
23774 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23775 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23776 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23777 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23778 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23779 .code
23780 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23781 .endd
23782 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23783 arguments. You have to write
23784 .code
23785 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23786 .endd
23787 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23788 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23789 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23790 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23791 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23792 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23793 example:
23794 .code
23795 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23796 .endd
23797
23798 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23799 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23800 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23801 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23802 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23803 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23804 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23805 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23806 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23807 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23808 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23809
23810 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23811 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23812 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23813 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23814 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23815 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23816 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23817 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23818
23819 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23820 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23821 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23822 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23823 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23824 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23825 control what is done with it.
23826
23827 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23828 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23829 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23830 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23831 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23832 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23833 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23834 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23835 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23836 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23837 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23838
23839
23840
23841 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23842 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23843 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23844 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23845 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23846 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23847 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23848 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23849 .display
23850 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23851 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23852 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23853 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23854 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23855 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23856 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23857 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23858 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23859 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23860 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23861 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23862 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23863 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23864 &`USER `& see below
23865 .endd
23866 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23867 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23868 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23869 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23870 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23871 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23872 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23873
23874 .cindex "HOST"
23875 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23876 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23877 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23878 the router.
23879
23880 .cindex "HOME"
23881 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23882 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23883 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23884 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23885
23886
23887 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23888 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23889
23890
23891
23892 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23893 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23894 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23895 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23896 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23897 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23898 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23899 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23900 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23901 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23902 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23903 example, if
23904 .code
23905 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23906 .endd
23907 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23908 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23909 &%use_shell%& is set.
23910
23911
23912 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23913 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23914
23915
23916 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23917 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23918 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23919
23920
23921 .option check_string pipe string unset
23922 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23923 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23924 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23925 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23926 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23927 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23928 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23929 ignored.
23930
23931
23932 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23933 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23934 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23935 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23936 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23937 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23938 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23939
23940
23941 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23942 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23943 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23944 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23945 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23946 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23947 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23948
23949
23950 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23951 See &%check_string%& above.
23952
23953
23954 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23955 .cindex "exec failure"
23956 .cindex "failure of exec"
23957 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23958 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23959 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23960 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23961 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23962
23963
23964 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23965 .cindex "signal exit"
23966 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23967 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23968 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23969 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23970
23971
23972 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23973 .cindex "force command"
23974 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23975 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23976 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23977 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23978 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23979 command. For example:
23980 .code
23981 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23982 force_command
23983 .endd
23984
23985 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23986 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23987 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23988
23989
23990 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23991 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23992 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23993 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23994 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23995 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23996
23997 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23998 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23999
24000
24001 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24002 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24003 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24004 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24005 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24006 written to the main log.
24007
24008
24009 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24010 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24011 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24012 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24013 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24014 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24015 be set.
24016
24017
24018 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24019 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24020 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24021 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24022 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24023
24024
24025 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24026 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24027 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24028 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24029 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24030 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24031 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24032 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24033
24034
24035 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24036 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24037 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24038 .code
24039 message_prefix = \
24040 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24041 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24042 .endd
24043 .cindex "Cyrus"
24044 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24045 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24046 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24047 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24048 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24049 setting
24050 .code
24051 message_prefix =
24052 .endd
24053 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24054 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24055
24056
24057 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24058 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24059 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24060 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24061 .code
24062 message_suffix =
24063 .endd
24064 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24065 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24066
24067
24068 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24069 This option is expanded and
24070 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24071 variable of the subprocess.
24072 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24073 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24074 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24075
24076
24077 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24078 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24079 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24080 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24081 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24082 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24083 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24084 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24085 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24086
24087
24088 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24089 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24090 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24091 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24092 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24093 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24094 accept the message is used.
24095
24096
24097 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24098 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24099 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24100 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24101 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24102 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24103
24104
24105 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24106 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24107 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24108 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24109 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24110 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24111 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24112
24113
24114
24115 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24116 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24117 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24118 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24119 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24120 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24121 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24122 of them may be set.
24123
24124
24125
24126 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24127 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24128 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24129 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24130 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24131 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24132 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24133 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24134 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24135 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24136 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24137 and 73, respectively.
24138
24139
24140 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24141 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24142 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24143 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24144 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24145 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24146 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24147
24148 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24149 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24150 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24151 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24152 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24153 delivery to be deferred.
24154
24155 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24156 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24157
24158
24159 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24160 .cindex "envelope sender"
24161 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24162 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24163 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24164 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24165 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24166
24167 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24168 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24169 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24170 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24171 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24172 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24173 class database.
24174
24175
24176 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24177 .cindex "carriage return"
24178 .cindex "linefeed"
24179 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24180 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24181 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24182 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24183
24184 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24185 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24186 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24187 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24188 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24189
24190
24191 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24192 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24193 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24194 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24195 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24196 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24197 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24198 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24199 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24200 its &%-c%& option.
24201
24202
24203
24204 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24205 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24206 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24207 .cindex "external local delivery"
24208 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24209 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24210 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24211 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24212 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24213 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24214 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24215 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24216 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24217 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24218 .code
24219 # transport
24220 procmail_pipe:
24221 driver = pipe
24222 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24223 return_path_add
24224 delivery_date_add
24225 envelope_to_add
24226 check_string = "From "
24227 escape_string = ">From "
24228 umask = 077
24229 user = $local_part
24230 group = mail
24231
24232 # router
24233 procmail:
24234 driver = accept
24235 check_local_user
24236 transport = procmail_pipe
24237 .endd
24238 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24239 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24240 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24241 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24242 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24243 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24244
24245 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24246 .code
24247 IFS=" "
24248 .endd
24249 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24250 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24251
24252 .cindex "Cyrus"
24253 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24254 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24255 .code
24256 # transport
24257 local_delivery_cyrus:
24258 driver = pipe
24259 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24260 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24261 user = cyrus
24262 group = mail
24263 return_output
24264 log_output
24265 message_prefix =
24266 message_suffix =
24267
24268 # router
24269 local_user_cyrus:
24270 driver = accept
24271 check_local_user
24272 local_part_suffix = .*
24273 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24274 .endd
24275 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24276 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24277 sender.
24278 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24279 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24280
24281
24282 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24283 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24284
24285 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24286 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24287 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24288 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24289 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24290 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24291 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24292 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24293
24294
24295 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24296 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24297 two ways:
24298
24299 .ilist
24300 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24301 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24302 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24303 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24304 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24305 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24306 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24307 .next
24308 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24309 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24310 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24311 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24312 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24313 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24314 process.
24315 .endlist
24316
24317
24318 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24319 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24320 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24321
24322
24323
24324 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24325 .vindex "&$host$&"
24326 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24327 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24328 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24329 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24330 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24331 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24332 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24333 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24334
24335
24336 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24337 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24338 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24339 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24340 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24341 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24342 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24343 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24344 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24345 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24346 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24347 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24348 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24349 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24350
24351 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24352 and will be removed in a future release.
24353
24354
24355 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24356 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24357 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24358
24359
24360 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24361 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24362 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24363 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24364 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24365 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24366 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24367 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24368
24369 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24370 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24371 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24372 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24373 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24374 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24375 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24376 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24377 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24378
24379
24380 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24381 .cindex "Cyrus"
24382 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24383 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24384 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24385 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24386 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24387 ignored.
24388
24389 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24390 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24391 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24392 particular connection.
24393
24394 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24395 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24396 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24397 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24398
24399 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24400 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24401 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24402 .code
24403 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24404 .endd
24405 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24406 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24407
24408 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24409 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24410 value.
24411
24412
24413 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24414 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24415 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24416 authenticated as a client.
24417
24418
24419 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24420 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24421 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24422 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24423
24424
24425 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24426 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24427 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24428 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24429 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24430 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24431 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24432
24433
24434 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24435 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24436 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24437 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24438 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24439 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24440 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24441 option.
24442
24443
24444 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24445 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24446 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24447 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24448 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24449 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24450 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24451 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24452 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24453 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24454 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24455 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24456 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24457 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24458
24459
24460 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24461 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24462 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24463 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24464
24465
24466 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24467 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24468 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24469 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24470 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24471 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24472 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24473 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24474 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24475 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24476 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24477 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24478 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24479 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24480 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24481 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24482 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24483 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24484
24485
24486 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24487 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24488 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24489 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24490 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24491 cutoff times.
24492
24493 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24494 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24495 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24496 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24497 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24498 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24499
24500 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24501 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24502 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24503 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24504 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24505 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24506 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24507 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24508 to them.
24509
24510
24511 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24512 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24513 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24514 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24515 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24516
24517
24518 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24519 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24520 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24521 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24522 details.
24523
24524
24525 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24526 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24527 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24528 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24529 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24530 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24531 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24532 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24533 router option.
24534
24535
24536
24537 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24538 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24539 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24540 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24541 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24542 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24543 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24544 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24545 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24546
24547
24548
24549 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24550 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24551 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24552 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24553 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24554 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24555 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24556
24557 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24558 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24559 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24560 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24561 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24562
24563
24564 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24565 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24566 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24567 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24568 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24569 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24570 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24571 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24572
24573 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24574 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24575 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24576 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24577 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24578 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24579
24580 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24581 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24582 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24583 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24584 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24585
24586 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24587 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24588 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24589 copy of the message is sent.
24590
24591 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24592 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24593 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24594 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24595 fails"& facility.
24596
24597
24598 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24599 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24600 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24601 zero.
24602
24603 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24604 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24605 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24606 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24607 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24608 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24609
24610 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24611 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24612 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24613 implementations of TLS.
24614
24615 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24616 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24617 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24618 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24619 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24620 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24621 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24622 option is:
24623 .code
24624 $primary_hostname
24625 .endd
24626 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24627 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24628 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24629 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24630 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24631 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24632 interface address, you could use this:
24633 .code
24634 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24635 {$primary_hostname}}
24636 .endd
24637 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24638 callouts.
24639
24640 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24641 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24642 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24643 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24644 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24645 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24646
24647 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24648 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24649 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24650 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24651
24652 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24653 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24654 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24655 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24656 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24657 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24658 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24659
24660 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24661 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24662 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24663 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24664 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24665 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24666 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24667 address are used.
24668
24669 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24670 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24671
24672
24673 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24674 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24675 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24676 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24677 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24678 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24679 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24680 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24681 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24682 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24683
24684
24685 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24686 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24687 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24688 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24689
24690 .new
24691 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24692 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24693 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24694 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24695 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24696 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24697
24698 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24699 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24700 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24701 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24702 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24703
24704 Note:
24705 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24706 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24707 is filled in.
24708 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24709 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24710 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24711 You have been warned.
24712 .wen
24713
24714
24715 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24716 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24717 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24718 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24719
24720 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24721 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24722 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24723 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24724 to any host that matches this list.
24725
24726
24727 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24728 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24729 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24730 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24731 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24732 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24733 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24734 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24735
24736
24737 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24738 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24739 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24740 why it exists.
24741
24742
24743
24744 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24745 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24746 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24747 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24748 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24749 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24750 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24751 explanation of when this might be needed.
24752
24753 .new
24754 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24755 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24756 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24757 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24758 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24759 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24760 message on the same session.
24761 .wen
24762
24763 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24764 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24765 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24766 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24767 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24768 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24769 logging.
24770
24771
24772
24773 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24774 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24775 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24776 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24777 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24778
24779
24780 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24781 .cindex "randomized host list"
24782 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24783 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24784 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24785 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24786 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24787 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24788 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24789 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24790
24791 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24792 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24793 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24794 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24795 .code
24796 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24797 .endd
24798 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24799 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24800 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24801
24802 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24803 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24804 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24805 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24806 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24807 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24808 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24809 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24810 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24811
24812
24813 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24814 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24815 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24816 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24817 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24818
24819 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24820 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24821 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24822 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24823 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24824 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24825 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24826 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24827 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24828
24829 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24830 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24831 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24832 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24833 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24834
24835 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24836 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24837 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24838 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24839 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24840 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24841
24842 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24843 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24844 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24845 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24846 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24847 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24848 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24849
24850 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24851 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24852 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24853 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24854 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24855 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24856 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24857
24858 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24859 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24860 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24861 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24862 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24863 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24864 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24865 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24866 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24867
24868 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24869 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24870 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24871 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24872 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24873 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24874 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24875 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24876 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24877 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24878
24879 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24880 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24881
24882 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24883 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24884 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24885 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24886 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24887
24888 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24889 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24890 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24891 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24892 for multi-recipient messages.
24893 The option can usually be left as default.
24894
24895 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24896 .cindex "bind IP address"
24897 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24898 .vindex "&$host$&"
24899 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24900 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24901 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24902 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24903 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24904 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24905 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24906 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24907 unknown.
24908
24909 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24910 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24911 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24912 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24913 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24914 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24915 For example:
24916 .code
24917 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24918 .endd
24919 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24920 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24921 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24922 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24923
24924
24925 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24926 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24927 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24928 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24929 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24930 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24931 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24932 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24933 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24934 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24935 unreachable hosts.
24936
24937
24938 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24939 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24940 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24941 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24942 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24943
24944 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24945 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24946 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24947 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24948 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24949 permits this.
24950
24951
24952 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24953 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24954 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24955 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24956 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24957 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24958 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24959 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24960
24961 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24962 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24963 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24964
24965 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24966 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24967 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24968 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24969 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24970 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24971 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24972 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24973
24974 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24975 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24976 normally &"smtp"&,
24977 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24978 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24979 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24980 is deferred.
24981
24982 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24983 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24984
24985
24986
24987 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24988 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24989 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24990 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24991 .vindex "&$port$&"
24992 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24993 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24994 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24995 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24996 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24997
24998 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24999 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25000 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25001 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25002 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25003 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25004
25005
25006 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25007 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25008 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25009 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25010 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25011 addresses is not affected.
25012
25013 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25014 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25015 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25016 Exim to use only the host name.
25017 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25018
25019
25020 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25021 .cindex "serializing connections"
25022 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25023 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25024 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25025 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25026 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25027 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25028 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25029
25030 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25031 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25032 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25033 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25034 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25035 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25036
25037 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25038 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25039 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25040 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25041 are used for ETRN serialization.
25042
25043 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25044
25045
25046 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25047 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25048 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25049 .cindex "size" "of message"
25050 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25051 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25052 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25053 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25054 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25055 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25056 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25057 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25058
25059 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25060 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25061
25062
25063 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25064 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25065 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25066 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25067
25068
25069 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25070 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25071 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25072 .vindex "&$host$&"
25073 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25074 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25075 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25076 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25077 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25078 details of TLS.
25079
25080 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25081 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25082 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25083 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25084 client.
25085
25086
25087 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25088 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25089 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25090 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25091 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25092
25093
25094 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25095 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25096 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25097 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25098 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25099 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25100 will fail.
25101
25102 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25103
25104
25105 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25106 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25107 .vindex "&$host$&"
25108 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25109 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25110 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25111 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25112 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25113 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25114 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25115 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25116
25117
25118 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25119 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25120 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25121 .vindex "&$host$&"
25122 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25123 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25124 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25125 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25126 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25127 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25128 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25129 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25130 ciphers is a preference order.
25131
25132
25133
25134 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25135 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25136 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25137 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25138 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25139 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25140 certificate and private key for the session.
25141
25142 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25143
25144 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25145 TLS extensions.
25146
25147
25148
25149
25150 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25151 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25152 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25153 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25154 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25155 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25156 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25157 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25158 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25159 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25160 in clear.
25161
25162
25163 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25164 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25165 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25166 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25167 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25168 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25169 Note that unless the host is in this list
25170 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25171 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25172 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25173 certificate verification succeeds.
25174
25175
25176 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25177 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25178 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25179 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25180 while verifying the server certificate,
25181 checks will be included on the host name
25182 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25183 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25184 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25185
25186 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25187
25188
25189 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25190 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25191 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25192 .vindex "&$host$&"
25193 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25194 The value of this option must be either the
25195 word "system"
25196 or the absolute path to
25197 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25198 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25199
25200 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25201 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25202 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25203 must be specified.
25204
25205 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25206 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25207
25208 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25209 explicitly
25210 either by file or directory
25211 are added to those given by the system default location.
25212
25213 The values of &$host$& and
25214 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25215 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25216
25217 For back-compatibility,
25218 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25219 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25220 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25221
25222
25223 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25224 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25225 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25226 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25227 certificate verification must succeed.
25228 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25229 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25230 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25231
25232 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25233 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25234 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25235 If built with internationalization support,
25236 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25237 to a-label form.
25238 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25239
25240
25241
25242
25243 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25244 "SECTvalhosmax"
25245 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25246 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25247 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25248 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25249 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25250
25251
25252 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25253 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25254 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25255 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25256 retrying.
25257
25258 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25259 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25260 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25261
25262 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25263 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25264 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25265 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25266 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25267
25268 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25269 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25270 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25271 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25272 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25273 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25274 see below for an exception).
25275
25276 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25277 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25278 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25279 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25280 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25281
25282 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25283 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25284 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25285 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25286 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25287 reached their retry times.
25288
25289 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25290 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25291 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25292 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25293 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25294 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25295 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25296 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25297 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25298 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25299 reached.
25300
25301 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25302 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25303 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25304 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25305 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25306 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25307
25308 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25309 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25310 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25311 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25312 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25313 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25314
25315
25316
25317
25318
25319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25320 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25321
25322 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25323 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25324 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25325 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25326 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25327 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25328
25329 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25330 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25331 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25332 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25333 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25334 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25335 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25336
25337 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25338 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25339 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25340 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25341
25342
25343 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25344 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25345 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25346 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25347
25348 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25349 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25350 facility; you do not have to use it.
25351
25352 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25353 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25354 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25355 address to which it applies.
25356
25357 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25358 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25359 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25360 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25361 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25362 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25363 rules.
25364
25365 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25366 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25367 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25368 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25369
25370
25371 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25372 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25373 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25374 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25375 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25376 discouraged.
25377
25378 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25379 illustrated by these examples:
25380
25381 .ilist
25382 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25383 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25384 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25385 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25386 .next
25387 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25388 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25389 .endlist
25390
25391
25392
25393 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25394 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25395 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25396 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25397 message's processing.
25398
25399 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25400 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25401 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25402 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25403 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25404 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25405 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25406 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25407 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25408
25409 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25410 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25411 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25412 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25413 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25414 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25415 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25416 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25417 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25418 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25419
25420 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25421 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25422 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25423 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25424 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25425 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25426
25427 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25428 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25429 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25430
25431 .cindex "envelope from"
25432 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25433 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25434 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25435 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25436 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25437 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25438 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25439 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25440 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25441
25442 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25443 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25444 transport time.
25445
25446
25447
25448
25449 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25450 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25451 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25452 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25453 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25454 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25455 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25456 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25457 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25458 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25459 .code
25460 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25461 .endd
25462 might produce the output
25463 .code
25464 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25465 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25466 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25467 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25468 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25469 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25470 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25471 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25472 .endd
25473 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25474 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25475 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25476 set for a particular transport.
25477
25478
25479 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25480 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25481 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25482 rules in the form
25483 .display
25484 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25485 .endd
25486 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25487 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25488 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25489 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25490
25491 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25492 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25493 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25494 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25495 ignored.
25496
25497 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25498 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25499 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25500
25501 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25502 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25503 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25504 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25505 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25506 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25507 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25508
25509 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25510 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25511 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25512 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25513 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25514 .code
25515 *@* ${lookup ...
25516 .endd
25517 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25518 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25519
25520
25521 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25522 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25523 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25524 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25525 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25526 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25527 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25528 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25529 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25530
25531 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25532 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25533 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25534
25535 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25536 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25537 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25538 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25539 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25540 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25541 of pattern they are set as follows:
25542
25543 .ilist
25544 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25545 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25546 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25547 pattern
25548 .code
25549 *queen@*.fict.example
25550 .endd
25551 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25552 .code
25553 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25554 $1 = hearts-
25555 $2 = wonderland
25556 .endd
25557 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25558 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25559
25560 .next
25561 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25562 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25563 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25564 rewriting rule of the form
25565 .display
25566 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25567 .endd
25568 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25569 .code
25570 $1 = foo
25571 $2 = bar
25572 $3 = baz.example
25573 .endd
25574 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25575 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25576 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25577 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25578 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25579 .endlist
25580
25581
25582 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25583 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25584 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25585 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25586 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25587 .code
25588 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25589 .endd
25590 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25591 &'From:'& headers.
25592
25593 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25594 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25595 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25596 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25597 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25598 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25599 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25600 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25601 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25602 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25603 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25604 entry written to the panic log.
25605
25606
25607
25608 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25609 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25610
25611 .ilist
25612 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25613 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25614 .next
25615 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25616 .next
25617 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25618 .endlist
25619
25620 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25621 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25622
25623
25624
25625 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25626 "SECID154"
25627 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25628 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25629 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25630 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25631 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25632 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25633 .display
25634 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25635 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25636 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25637 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25638 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25639 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25640 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25641 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25642 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25643 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25644 .endd
25645 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25646 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25647 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25648
25649 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25650 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25651
25652
25653 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25654 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25655 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25656 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25657 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25658 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25659 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25660 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25661 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25662
25663 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25664 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25665 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25666 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25667 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25668 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25669 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25670 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25671
25672
25673 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25674 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25675 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25676 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25677
25678 .ilist
25679 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25680 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25681 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25682 .next
25683 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25684 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25685 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25686 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25687 .next
25688 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25689 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25690 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25691 .next
25692 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25693 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25694 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25695 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25696 .code
25697 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25698 .endd
25699 into
25700 .code
25701 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25702 .endd
25703 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25704 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25705 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25706 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25707 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25708 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25709 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25710 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25711 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25712
25713 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25714 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25715 .endlist
25716
25717
25718 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25719 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25720 .code
25721 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25722 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25723 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25724 .endd
25725 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25726 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25727 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25728 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25729 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25730 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25731 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25732 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25733
25734 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25735 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25736 .code
25737 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25738 .endd
25739 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25740 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25741
25742 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25743 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25744 messages that originate outside the local host:
25745 .code
25746 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25747 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25748 .endd
25749 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25750 space.
25751
25752 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25753 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25754 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25755 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25756 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25757 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25758 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25759 components. For example, the rule
25760 .code
25761 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25762 .endd
25763 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25764 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25765 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25766 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25767 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25768 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25769 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25770 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25771
25772
25773
25774
25775
25776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25778
25779 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25780 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25781 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25782 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25783 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25784 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25785 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25786 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25787 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25788 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25789 address, domain and error.
25790
25791 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25792 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25793 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25794 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25795 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25796 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25797 log selector is set, the message
25798 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25799 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25800 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25801 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25802
25803 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25804 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25805 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25806 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25807 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25808 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25809 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25810 domain are maintained independently.
25811
25812 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25813 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25814 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25815 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25816 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25817 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25818 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25819 the local address is reached.
25820
25821 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25822 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25823 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25824 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25825 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25826
25827 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25828 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25829 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25830 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25831 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25832 messages that it should now be retaining.
25833
25834
25835
25836 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25837 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25838 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25839 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25840 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25841 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25842 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25843 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25844 message's sender, respectively.
25845
25846
25847 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25848 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25849 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25850 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25851 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25852 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25853 example,
25854 .code
25855 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25856 .endd
25857 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25858 whereas
25859 .code
25860 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25861 .endd
25862 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25863 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25864 part.
25865
25866 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25867 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25868 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25869 expressions work in address lists.
25870 .display
25871 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25872 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25873 .endd
25874
25875
25876 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25877 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25878 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25879 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25880 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25881 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25882 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25883 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25884 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25885
25886 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25887 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25888 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25889 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25890 local transports).
25891
25892 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25893 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25894 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25895 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25896 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25897 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25898 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25899 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25900 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25901 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25902 commands.
25903
25904
25905
25906 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25907 "SECID160"
25908 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25909 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25910 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25911 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25912 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25913 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25914 .code
25915 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25916 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25917 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25918 .endd
25919 and the retry rules are
25920 .code
25921 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25922 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25923 .endd
25924 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25925 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25926 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25927 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25928 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25929 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25930
25931 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25932 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25933 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25934 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25935
25936 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25937 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25938 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25939 .code
25940 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25941 .endd
25942 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25943 textual form of the IP address.
25944
25945 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25946 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25947 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25948 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25949
25950 .vlist
25951 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25952 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25953 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25954
25955 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25956 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25957 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25958
25959 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25960 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25961
25962 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25963 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25964 .endlist
25965
25966 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25967 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25968 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25969 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25970 retry rule of this form:
25971 .code
25972 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25973 .endd
25974 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25975 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25976
25977 .vlist
25978 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25979 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25980 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25981 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25982
25983 .vitem &%lookup%&
25984 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25985 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25986 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25987 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25988 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25989
25990 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25991 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25992
25993 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25994 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25995
25996 .vitem &%refused%&
25997 A connection was refused.
25998
25999 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26000 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26001
26002 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26003 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26004
26005 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26006 A connection attempt timed out.
26007
26008 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26009 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26010 obtained from an MX record.
26011
26012 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26013 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26014 obtained from an MX record.
26015
26016 .vitem &%timeout%&
26017 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26018
26019 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26020 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26021 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26022 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26023
26024 .vitem &%quota%&
26025 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26026 transport.
26027
26028 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26029 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26030 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26031 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26032 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26033 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26034 for four days.
26035 .endlist
26036
26037 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26038 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26039 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26040 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26041 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26042 heuristic rules:
26043
26044 .ilist
26045 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26046 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26047 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26048 .next
26049 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26050 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26051 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26052 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26053 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26054 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26055 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26056 .next
26057 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26058 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26059 .endlist
26060
26061 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26062 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26063 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26064 error).
26065
26066
26067
26068 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26069 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26070 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26071 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26072 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26073 form:
26074 .display
26075 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26076 .endd
26077 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26078 .code
26079 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26080 .endd
26081 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26082 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26083 For example:
26084 .code
26085 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26086 .endd
26087 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26088 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26089 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26090 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26091 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26092
26093 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26094 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26095 .code
26096 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26097 .endd
26098 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26099 list is never matched.
26100
26101
26102
26103
26104
26105 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26106 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26107 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26108 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26109 .display
26110 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26111 .endd
26112 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26113 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26114 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26115 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26116 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26117
26118 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26119 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26120 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26121 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26122 The available algorithms are:
26123
26124 .ilist
26125 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26126 the interval.
26127 .next
26128 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26129 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26130 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26131 .next
26132 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26133 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26134 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26135 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26136 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26137 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26138 queue processing times.
26139 .endlist
26140
26141 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26142 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26143 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26144 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26145 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26146 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26147 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26148 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26149 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26150 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26151 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26152 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26153
26154 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26155 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26156 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26157 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26158 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26159 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26160 time.
26161
26162 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26163 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26164 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26165 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26166 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26167 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26168 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26169 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26170 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26171 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26172 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26173 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26174
26175 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26176 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26177 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26178 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26179 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26180 deliveries that have been deferred.
26181
26182
26183 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26184 Here are some example retry rules:
26185 .code
26186 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26187 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26188 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26189 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26190 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26191 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26192 .endd
26193 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26194 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26195 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26196 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26197 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26198 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26199 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26200 days.
26201
26202 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26203 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26204 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26205 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26206 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26207
26208 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26209 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26210 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26211 were not obtained from an MX record.
26212
26213 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26214 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26215 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26216 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26217 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26218
26219
26220
26221 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26222 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26223 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26224 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26225 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26226 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26227 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26228 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26229 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26230 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26231 failing for the first time.
26232
26233 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26234 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26235 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26236 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26237
26238 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26239 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26240 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26241
26242
26243
26244
26245 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26246 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26247 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26248 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26249 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26250 default retry rule:
26251 .code
26252 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26253 .endd
26254 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26255 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26256 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26257
26258 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26259 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26260 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26261 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26262 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26263
26264 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26265 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26266 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26267
26268 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26269 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26270 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26271 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26272 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26273 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26274 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26275 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26276 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26277 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26278 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26279
26280 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26281 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26282 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26283 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26284 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26285 notice.
26286
26287 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26288 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26289 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26290 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26291 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26292 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26293 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26294 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26295 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26296 true.
26297
26298 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26299 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26300 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26301 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26302 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26303 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26304 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26305 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26306 reached.
26307
26308 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26309 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26310 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26311 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26312 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26313 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26314 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26315 time out the address.
26316
26317 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26318 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26319 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26320 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26321 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26322 considered immediately.
26323 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26324 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26325
26326
26327
26328
26329
26330
26331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26333
26334 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26335 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26336 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26337 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26338 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26339 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26340 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26341 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26342 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26343 other.
26344
26345 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26346 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26347
26348 .ilist
26349 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26350 the client's EHLO command.
26351 .next
26352 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26353 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26354 .next
26355 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26356 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26357 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26358 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26359 with the AUTH command.
26360 .next
26361 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26362 .next
26363 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26364 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26365 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26366 connection.
26367 .next
26368 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26369 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26370 unauthenticated connection.
26371 .endlist
26372
26373 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26374 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26375 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26376 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26377 .display
26378 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26379 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26380 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26381 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26382 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26383 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26384 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26385 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26386 &`250-PIPELINING`&
26387 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26388 &`250 HELP`&
26389 .endd
26390 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26391 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26392 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26393 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26394 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26395 included by setting
26396 .code
26397 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26398 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26399 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26400 AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26401 AUTH_GSASL=yes
26402 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26403 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26404 AUTH_SPA=yes
26405 AUTH_TLS=yes
26406 .endd
26407 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26408 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26409 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26410 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26411 work via a socket interface.
26412 .new
26413 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26414 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26415 .wen
26416 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26417 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26418 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26419 supporting setting a server keytab.
26420 The seventh can be configured to support
26421 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26422 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26423 The eighth authenticator
26424 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26425 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26426 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26427
26428 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26429 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26430 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26431 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26432 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26433 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26434 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26435
26436 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26437 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26438 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26439 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26440 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26441 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26442 .code
26443 cram:
26444 driver = cram_md5
26445 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26446 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26447 client_name = ph10
26448 client_secret = secret2
26449 .endd
26450 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26451 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26452
26453 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26454 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26455 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26456 in Exim.
26457
26458 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26459 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26460 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26461 authenticating data.
26462
26463 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26464 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26465 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26466 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26467 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26468 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26469 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26470 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26471 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26472 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26473 choose to honour.
26474
26475 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26476 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26477 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26478 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26479
26480
26481
26482 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26483 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26484 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26485
26486 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26487 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26488 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26489 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26490 encrypted by a setting such as:
26491 .code
26492 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26493 .endd
26494
26495
26496 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26497 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26498 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26499 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26500
26501
26502 .option driver authenticators string unset
26503 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26504 authenticators is to be used.
26505
26506
26507 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26508 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26509 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26510 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26511 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26512 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26513
26514
26515 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26516 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26517 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26518 mechanism is not advertised.
26519 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26520 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26521 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26522
26523
26524 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26525 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26526 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26527 for details.
26528
26529 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26530 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26531
26532 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26533 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26534 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26535 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26536 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26537 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26538 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26539 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26540 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26541 the error text.
26542
26543
26544 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26545 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26546 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26547 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26548 out the values of variables.
26549 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26550 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26551
26552
26553 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26554 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26555 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26556 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26557 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26558 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26559 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26560 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26561 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26562 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26563 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26564 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26565
26566
26567 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26568 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26569 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26570 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26571 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26572 remembered for later use.
26573 How it is used is described in the following section.
26574
26575
26576
26577
26578
26579 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26580 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26581 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26582 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26583 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26584 message:
26585
26586 .ilist
26587 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26588 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26589 .next
26590 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26591 .next
26592 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26593 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26594 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26595 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26596 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26597 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26598 given for the MAIL command.
26599 .next
26600 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26601 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26602 authenticated.
26603 .next
26604 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26605 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26606 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26607 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26608 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26609 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26610 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26611 message.
26612 .endlist
26613
26614
26615 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26616 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26617 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26618 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26619
26620 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26621 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26622 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26623 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26624 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26625 ACL is run.
26626
26627
26628
26629 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26630 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26631 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26632 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26633 conditions:
26634
26635 .ilist
26636 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26637 .next
26638 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26639 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26640 .endlist
26641
26642 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26643 the mechanisms are advertised.
26644
26645 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26646 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26647 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26648 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26649 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26650 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26651 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26652 .code
26653 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26654 .endd
26655 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26656
26657 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26658 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26659 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26660 such as:
26661 .code
26662 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26663 .endd
26664 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26665 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26666 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26667
26668 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26669 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26670 command. This is the case if
26671
26672 .ilist
26673 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26674 .next
26675 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26676 .next
26677 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26678 server authenticators.
26679 .endlist
26680
26681
26682 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26683 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26684 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26685
26686 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26687 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26688 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26689 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26690 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26691 rejected with a 504 error.
26692
26693 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26694 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26695 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26696 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26697 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26698 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26699 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26700 no successful authentication.
26701
26702 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26703 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26704 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26705
26706
26707
26708
26709 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26710 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26711 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26712 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26713 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26714 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26715 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26716 script:
26717 .code
26718 use MIME::Base64;
26719 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26720 .endd
26721 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26722 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26723 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26724 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26725 command line to run this script on such data might be
26726 .code
26727 encode '\0user\0password'
26728 .endd
26729 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26730 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26731 whose code value is zero.
26732
26733 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26734 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26735 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26736 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26737
26738 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26739 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26740 example, a command such as
26741 .code
26742 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26743 .endd
26744 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26745
26746 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26747 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26748 .code
26749 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26750 .endd
26751 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26752 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26753 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26754 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26755
26756
26757
26758 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26759 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26760 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26761 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26762 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26763 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26764
26765 .ilist
26766 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26767 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26768 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26769 of the authenticator.
26770 .next
26771 .vindex "&$host$&"
26772 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26773 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26774 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26775 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26776 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26777 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26778 delivery to be deferred.
26779 .next
26780 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26781 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26782 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26783 usual way.
26784 .next
26785 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26786 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26787 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26788 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26789 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26790 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26791 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26792 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26793 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26794 .endlist
26795
26796 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26797 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26798 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26799 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26800 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26801 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26802 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26803 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26804
26805 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26806
26807 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26808 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26809 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26810 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26811 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26812 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26813 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26814 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26815 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26816 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26817 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26818 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26819 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26820
26821
26822
26823
26824
26825
26826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26828
26829 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26830 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26831 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26832 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26833 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26834 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26835 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26836 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26837 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26838 connections as you do for login accounts.
26839
26840 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26841 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26842 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26843
26844 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26845 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26846 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26847
26848 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26849 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26850 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26851 given.
26852
26853 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26854 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26855 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26856 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26857 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26858 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26859 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26860
26861 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26862 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26863 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26864 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26865 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26866 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26867 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26868
26869 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26870 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26871 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26872 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26873
26874 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26875 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26876 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26877
26878 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26879 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26880 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26881 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26882 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26883 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26884 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26885 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26886 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26887 string as the error text.
26888
26889 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26890 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26891 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26892
26893
26894
26895 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26896 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26897 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26898 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26899 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26900 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26901 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26902 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26903
26904 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26905 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26906 configured as follows:
26907 .code
26908 fixed_plain:
26909 driver = plaintext
26910 public_name = PLAIN
26911 server_prompts = :
26912 server_condition = \
26913 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26914 server_set_id = $auth2
26915 .endd
26916 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26917 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26918 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26919 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26920
26921 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26922 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26923 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26924 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26925 .code
26926 250-AUTH PLAIN
26927 .endd
26928 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26929 .code
26930 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26931 .endd
26932 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26933 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26934 .code
26935 AUTH PLAIN
26936 .endd
26937 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26938 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26939
26940 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26941 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26942 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26943 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26944 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26945
26946 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26947 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26948 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26949
26950 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26951 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26952 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26953 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26954 This is an incorrect example:
26955 .code
26956 server_condition = \
26957 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26958 .endd
26959 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26960 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26961 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26962 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26963 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26964 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26965 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26966 .code
26967 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26968 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26969 .endd
26970 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26971 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26972 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26973 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26974 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26975
26976
26977 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26978 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26979 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26980 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26981 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26982 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26983 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26984 .code
26985 fixed_login:
26986 driver = plaintext
26987 public_name = LOGIN
26988 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26989 server_condition = \
26990 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26991 server_set_id = $auth1
26992 .endd
26993 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26994 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26995 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26996 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26997
26998 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26999 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27000 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27001 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27002 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27003 .code
27004 login:
27005 driver = plaintext
27006 public_name = LOGIN
27007 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27008 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27009 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27010 ldapauth{\
27011 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27012 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27013 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27014 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27015 .endd
27016 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27017 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27018 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27019 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27020 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27021 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27022 uninterpreted string.
27023
27024
27025 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27026 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27027 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27028 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27029 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27030 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27031
27032
27033
27034
27035 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27036 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27037 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27038
27039 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27040 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27041 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27042 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27043 usual.
27044
27045 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27046 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27047 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27048 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27049 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27050 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27051 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27052 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27053 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27054 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27055 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27056 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27057
27058 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27059 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27060
27061 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27062 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27063 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27064 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27065 the string.
27066
27067 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27068 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27069 .code
27070 fixed_plain:
27071 driver = plaintext
27072 public_name = PLAIN
27073 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27074 .endd
27075 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27076 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27077 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27078 .code
27079 fixed_login:
27080 driver = plaintext
27081 public_name = LOGIN
27082 client_send = : username : mysecret
27083 .endd
27084 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27085 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27086 prompts.
27087 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27088 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27089
27090
27091
27092
27093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27095
27096 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27097 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27098 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27099 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27100 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27101 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27102 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27103 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27104 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27105 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27106 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27107 available in plain text at either end.
27108
27109
27110 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27111 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27112 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27113 authenticator as a server:
27114
27115 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27116 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27117 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27118 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27119 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27120 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27121 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27122 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27123 returned to the client.
27124
27125 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27126 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27127 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27128 numeric variables for other things.
27129
27130 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27131 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27132 user name, authentication fails.
27133 .code
27134 fixed_cram:
27135 driver = cram_md5
27136 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27137 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27138 server_set_id = $auth1
27139 .endd
27140 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27141 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27142 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27143 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27144 .code
27145 lookup_cram:
27146 driver = cram_md5
27147 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27148 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27149 {$value}fail}
27150 server_set_id = $auth1
27151 .endd
27152 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27153 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27154
27155 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27156 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27157 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27158 realm, with:
27159 .code
27160 cyrusless_crammd5:
27161 driver = cram_md5
27162 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27163 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27164 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27165 server_set_id = $auth1
27166 .endd
27167
27168 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27169 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27170 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27171
27172
27173
27174 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27175 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27176 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27177
27178
27179 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27180 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27181 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27182
27183
27184 .vindex "&$host$&"
27185 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27186 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27187 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27188 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27189 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27190 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27191 send the message to the current server.
27192
27193 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27194 strings, is:
27195 .code
27196 fixed_cram:
27197 driver = cram_md5
27198 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27199 client_name = ph10
27200 client_secret = secret
27201 .endd
27202 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27203 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27204
27205
27206
27207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27209
27210 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27211 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27212 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27213 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27214 .cindex "Kerberos"
27215 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27216 at A L Digital Ltd.
27217
27218 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27219 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27220 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27221 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27222 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27223
27224 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27225 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27226 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27227 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27228
27229 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27230 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27231 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27232 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27233 depending on the driver you are using.
27234
27235 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27236 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27237 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27238 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27239 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27240 implementation.
27241
27242 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27243 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27244 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27245 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27246 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27247 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27248 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27249 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27250
27251
27252 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27253 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27254 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27255 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27256 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27257 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27258 things.
27259
27260
27261 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27262 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27263 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27264 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27265
27266
27267 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27268 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27269 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27270 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27271 example:
27272 .code
27273 sasl:
27274 driver = cyrus_sasl
27275 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27276 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27277 server_set_id = $auth1
27278 .endd
27279
27280 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27281 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27282
27283
27284 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27285 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27286
27287
27288 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27289 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27290 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27291 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27292 .code
27293 sasl_cram_md5:
27294 driver = cyrus_sasl
27295 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27296 server_set_id = $auth1
27297
27298 sasl_plain:
27299 driver = cyrus_sasl
27300 public_name = PLAIN
27301 server_set_id = $auth2
27302 .endd
27303 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27304 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27305 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27306 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27307 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27308
27309
27310
27311
27312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27314 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27315 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27316 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27317 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27318 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27319 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27320 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27321 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27322 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27323
27324 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27325
27326 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27327 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27328 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27329 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27330 .code
27331 dovecot_plain:
27332 driver = dovecot
27333 public_name = PLAIN
27334 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27335 server_set_id = $auth1
27336
27337 dovecot_ntlm:
27338 driver = dovecot
27339 public_name = NTLM
27340 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27341 server_set_id = $auth1
27342 .endd
27343 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27344 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27345 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27346 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27347 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27348 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27349 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27350 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27351
27352
27353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27355 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27356 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27357 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27358 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27359 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27360 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27361 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27362 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27363 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27364 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27365 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27366 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27367 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27368 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27369 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27370 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27371 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27372 without code changes in Exim.
27373
27374 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27375 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27376
27377
27378 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27379 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27380
27381 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27382 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27383 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27384 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27385 context.
27386
27387 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27388 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27389 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27390
27391 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27392 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27393 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27394
27395 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27396 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27397 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27398
27399 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27400 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27401 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27402
27403
27404 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27405 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27406 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27407 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27408
27409
27410 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27411 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27412 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27413 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27414 example:
27415 .code
27416 sasl:
27417 driver = gsasl
27418 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27419 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27420 server_set_id = $auth1
27421 .endd
27422
27423
27424 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27425 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27426 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27427 the password itself.
27428
27429 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27430 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27431 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27432 if available, else the empty string.
27433 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27434 else the empty string.
27435
27436 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27437
27438 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27439 option to be simply "true".
27440
27441
27442 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27443 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27444 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27445
27446
27447 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27448 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27449 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27450 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27451
27452
27453 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27454 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27455 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27456 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27457
27458
27459 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27460 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27461 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27462
27463
27464 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27465 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27466 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27467 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27468
27469 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27470 meanings for these variables:
27471
27472 .ilist
27473 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27474 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27475 .next
27476 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27477 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27478 .next
27479 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27480 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27481 .endlist
27482
27483 On a per-mechanism basis:
27484
27485 .ilist
27486 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27487 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27488 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27489 .next
27490 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27491 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27492 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27493 .next
27494 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27495 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27496 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27497 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27498 .endlist
27499
27500 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27501 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27502 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27503
27504
27505 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27506 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27507 .code
27508 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27509 driver = gsasl
27510 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27511 server_realm = imap.example.org
27512 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27513 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27514 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27515 server_condition = yes
27516 .endd
27517
27518
27519 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27520 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27521
27522 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27523 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27524 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27525 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27526 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27527 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27528 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27529 reliably.
27530
27531 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27532 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27533 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27534 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27535
27536 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27537 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27538 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27539 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27540
27541 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27542 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27543 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27544 from the keytab.
27545
27546
27547 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27548 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27549 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27550 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27551
27552 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27553 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27554 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27555 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27556
27557 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27558 .ilist
27559 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27560 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27561 .next
27562 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27563 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27564 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27565 GSS Display Name.
27566 .endlist
27567
27568
27569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27570 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27571
27572 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27573 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27574 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27575 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27576 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27577 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27578 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27579 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27580 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27581 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27582 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27583 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27584 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27585 follows:
27586
27587 .ilist
27588 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27589 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27590 .next
27591 The server sends back a challenge.
27592 .next
27593 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27594 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27595 .endlist
27596
27597 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27598
27599
27600
27601 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27602 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27603 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27604
27605 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27606 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27607 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27608 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27609 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27610 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27611 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27612 for other things. For example:
27613 .code
27614 spa:
27615 driver = spa
27616 public_name = NTLM
27617 server_password = \
27618 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27619 .endd
27620 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27621 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27622
27623
27624
27625
27626
27627 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27628 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27629 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27630
27631
27632
27633 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27634 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27635
27636
27637 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27638 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27639
27640
27641 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27642 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27643 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27644 &'msn.com'&:
27645 .code
27646 msn:
27647 driver = spa
27648 public_name = MSN
27649 client_username = msn/msn_username
27650 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27651 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27652 .endd
27653 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27654 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27655
27656
27657
27658
27659
27660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27662
27663 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27664 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27665 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27666 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27667 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27668 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27669 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27670 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27671 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27672 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27673 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27674 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27675 by the server configuration.
27676
27677 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27678 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27679 and for clients to only attempt,
27680 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27681
27682 One possible use, compatible with the
27683 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27684 is for using X509 client certificates.
27685
27686 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27687 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27688 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27689 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27690 client certificates only.
27691
27692 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27693 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27694
27695 The client must present a certificate,
27696 for which it must have been requested via the
27697 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27698 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27699 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27700 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27701
27702 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27703 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27704 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27705
27706 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27707 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27708 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27709 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27710 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27711 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27712 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27713
27714 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27715
27716 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27717 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27718 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27719 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27720 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27721 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27722
27723 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27724 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27725 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27726 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27727 an identity for authentication and
27728 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27729
27730 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27731 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27732 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27733 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27734
27735 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27736 Once an identity has been received,
27737 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27738 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27739 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27740 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27741 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27742 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27743 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27744 string as the error text.
27745
27746 Example:
27747 .code
27748 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27749 driver = external
27750 public_name = EXTERNAL
27751
27752 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27753 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27754 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27755 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27756 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27757 server_set_id = $auth1
27758 .endd
27759 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27760 of your configured trust-anchors
27761 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27762 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27763
27764 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27765 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27766 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27767 in this way.
27768 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27769
27770
27771 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27772 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27773 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27774
27775 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27776 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27777 identity being asserted.
27778
27779 Example:
27780 .code
27781 ext_ccert:
27782 driver = external
27783 public_name = EXTERNAL
27784
27785 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27786 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27787 .endd
27788
27789
27790 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27791 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27792
27793
27794
27795
27796
27797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27799
27800 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27801 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27802 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27803 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27804 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27805 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27806 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27807 authentication based on client certificates.
27808
27809 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27810 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27811 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27812 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27813 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27814 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27815
27816 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27817 for which it must have been requested via the
27818 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27819 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27820
27821 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27822 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27823 and can authenticate the connection.
27824 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27825
27826 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27827
27828
27829 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27830 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27831
27832 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27833 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27834 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27835 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27836 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27837 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27838
27839 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27840 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27841 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27842
27843 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27844
27845
27846 Example:
27847 .code
27848 tls:
27849 driver = tls
27850 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27851 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27852 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27853 {forany {$auth1} \
27854 {!= {0} \
27855 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27856 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27857 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27858 } } } }}}
27859 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27860 .endd
27861 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27862 of your configured trust-anchors
27863 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27864 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27865
27866 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27867 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27868 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27869 in this way.
27870 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27871
27872 . An alternative might use
27873 . .code
27874 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27875 . .endd
27876 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27877 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27878 . This would help for per-device use.
27879 .
27880 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27881 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27882
27883 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27884 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27885
27886
27887 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27888 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27889 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27890
27891
27892
27893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27895
27896 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27897 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27898 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27899 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27900 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27901 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27902 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27903 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27904 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27905 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27906 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27907 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27908 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27909 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27910 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27911 certificates are used.
27912
27913 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27914 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27915 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27916 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27917 between them is encrypted.
27918
27919 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27920 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27921 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27922 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27923 encryption state.
27924
27925 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27926 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27927 in order to get TLS to work.
27928
27929
27930
27931 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27932 "SECID284"
27933 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27934 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27935 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27936 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27937 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27938 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27939 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27940 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27941 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27942 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27943 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27944
27945 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27946 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27947 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27948
27949 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27950 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27951 reassigned for other use.
27952 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27953 this port.
27954 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27955 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27956 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27957
27958 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27959 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27960 the most common use is expected to be:
27961 .code
27962 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27963 .endd
27964 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27965 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27966 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27967 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27968 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27969 defined elsewhere.
27970
27971 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27972 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27973
27974
27975
27976
27977
27978
27979 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27980 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27981 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27982 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27983 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27984 .code
27985 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27986 .endd
27987 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27988 .code
27989 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27990 .endd
27991 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27992 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27993
27994 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27995
27996 .ilist
27997 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27998 cannot be the path of a directory
27999 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28000 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28001 .next
28002 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28003 .next
28004 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28005 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28006 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28007 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28008 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28009 .next
28010 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28011 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28012 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28013 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28014 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28015 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28016 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28017 option).
28018 .next
28019 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28020 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28021 .next
28022 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28023 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28024 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28025 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28026 .next
28027 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28028 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28029 .next
28030 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28031 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28032 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28033 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28034 .endlist
28035
28036
28037 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28038 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28039 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28040 but not the chosen filename.
28041 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28042 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28043
28044 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28045 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28046 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28047 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28048 of bits requested.
28049 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28050 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28051 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28052 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28053 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28054 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28055 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28056
28057 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28058 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28059 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28060 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28061 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28062
28063 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28064 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28065 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28066 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28067 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28068 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28069
28070 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28071 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28072 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28073
28074 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28075 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28076 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28077 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28078 .code
28079 # ls
28080 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28081 # rm -f new-params
28082 # touch new-params
28083 # chown exim:exim new-params
28084 # chmod 0600 new-params
28085 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28086 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28087 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28088 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28089 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28090 # chmod 0400 new-params
28091 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28092 .endd
28093 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28094 stalling is removed.
28095
28096 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28097 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28098 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28099 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28100 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28101 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28102 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28103 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28104 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28105 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28106 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28107
28108 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28109 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28110 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28111 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28112
28113 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28114 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28115 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28116 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28117 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28118
28119
28120 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28121 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28122 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28123 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28124 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28125 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28126 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28127 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28128 directly to this function call.
28129 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28130 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28131 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28132 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28133
28134 .ilist
28135 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28136 .next
28137 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28138 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28139 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28140 SSL v3 algorithms.
28141 .next
28142 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28143 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28144 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28145 algorithms.
28146 .endlist
28147
28148 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28149 &`-`& or &`+`&.
28150 .ilist
28151 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28152 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28153 stated.
28154 .next
28155 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28156 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28157 .next
28158 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28159 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28160 .endlist
28161
28162 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28163 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28164 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28165 not be moved to the end of the list.
28166 .endlist
28167
28168 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28169 string:
28170 .code
28171 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28172 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28173 .endd
28174
28175 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28176 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28177 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28178 choice of clients used:
28179 .code
28180 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28181 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28182 {DEFAULT}\
28183 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28184 .endd
28185
28186 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28187 .code
28188 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28189 .endd
28190
28191 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28192 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28193 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28194 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28195
28196 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28197 .code
28198 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28199 .endd
28200
28201
28202 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28203 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28204 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28205 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28206 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28207 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28208 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28209 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28210 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28211 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28212 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28213 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28214
28215 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28216 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28217
28218 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28219 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28220 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28221 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28222 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28223 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28224
28225 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28226 "Priority strings". This is online as
28227 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28228 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28229 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28230 then the example code
28231 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28232 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28233
28234 For example:
28235 .code
28236 # Disable older versions of protocols
28237 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28238 .endd
28239
28240 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28241 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28242 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28243
28244 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28245 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28246 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28247 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28248 used:
28249 .code
28250 # GnuTLS variant
28251 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28252 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28253 {SECURE128}}
28254 .endd
28255
28256
28257 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28258 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28259 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28260 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28261 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28262 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28263 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28264
28265 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28266 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28267
28268 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28269 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28270 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28271 with the error
28272 .code
28273 554 Security failure
28274 .endd
28275 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28276 rejected with a 554 error code.
28277
28278 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28279 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28280
28281 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28282 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28283 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28284 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28285
28286 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28287
28288 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28289 .code
28290 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28291 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28292 .endd
28293 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28294 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28295 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28296 that goes with it. These files need to be
28297 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28298 always be given as full path names.
28299 The key must not be password-protected.
28300 They can be the same file if both the
28301 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28302 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28303 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28304 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28305 the server's certificate.
28306
28307 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28308 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28309 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28310 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28311 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28312 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28313
28314 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28315 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28316 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28317
28318 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28319 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28320 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28321 transport.
28322
28323 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28324 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28325 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28326 .code
28327 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28328 .endd
28329 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28330 with the parameters contained in the file.
28331 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28332 available:
28333 .code
28334 tls_dhparam = none
28335 .endd
28336 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28337 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28338 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28339 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28340
28341 See the command
28342 .code
28343 openssl dhparam
28344 .endd
28345 for a way of generating file data.
28346
28347 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28348 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28349 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28350 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28351 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28352
28353 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28354 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28355 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28356 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28357 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28358 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28359 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28360 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28361 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28362
28363 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28364 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28365 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28366 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28367 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28368 documentation for more details.
28369
28370 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28371 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28372
28373
28374 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28375 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28376 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28377 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28378 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28379 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28380 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28381 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28382 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28383 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28384 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28385 an explicit file or,
28386 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28387 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28388
28389 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28390 directory is used
28391 (OpenSSL only),
28392 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28393 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28394 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28395 .code
28396 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28397 .endd
28398 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28399
28400 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28401 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28402
28403 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28404 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28405 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28406 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28407 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28408 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28409 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28410 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28411 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28412 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28413
28414 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28415 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28416 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28417 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28418
28419 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28420 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28421 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28422 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28423 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28424 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28425
28426
28427 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28428 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28429 .cindex "revocation list"
28430 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28431 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28432 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28433 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28434 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28435 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28436 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28437 CRL in PEM format.
28438 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28439 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28440
28441 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28442 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28443 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28444 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28445 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28446 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28447
28448 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28449 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28450 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28451 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28452
28453 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28454 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28455 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28456 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28457 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28458 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28459 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28460 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28461
28462 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28463 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28464 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28465
28466 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28467 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28468 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28469 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28470 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28471
28472 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28473 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28474 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28475 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28476 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28477 next connection.
28478
28479 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28480 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28481 ignored.
28482
28483 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28484 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28485 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28486 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28487 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28488 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28489
28490 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28491 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28492
28493 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28494
28495 .code
28496 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28497 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28498 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28499
28500 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28501 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28502 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28503 .endd
28504
28505
28506
28507
28508 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28509 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28510 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28511 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28512 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28513 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28514 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28515 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28516 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28517
28518 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28519 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28520 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28521 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28522 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28523
28524 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28525 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28526 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28527 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28528 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28529 usual way.
28530
28531 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28532 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28533 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28534 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28535 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28536 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28537 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28538 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28539 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28540 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28541 unencrypted.
28542
28543 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28544 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28545 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28546 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28547
28548 .new
28549 Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28550 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28551 As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28552 in failed connections.
28553 .wen
28554
28555 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28556 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28557 These may be
28558 the system default set (depending on library version),
28559 a file,
28560 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28561 The client verifies the server's certificate
28562 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28563 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28564 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28565 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28566
28567 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28568 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28569 or need not succeed respectively.
28570
28571 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28572 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28573 is valid for the certificate.
28574 The option defaults to always checking.
28575
28576 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28577 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28578 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28579 value is empty.
28580 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28581 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28582 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28583 otherwise.
28584
28585 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28586 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28587 for OCSP to be relevant.
28588
28589 If
28590 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28591 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28592 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28593 alternative hosts, if any.
28594
28595 &*Note*&:
28596 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28597 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28598 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28599 client.
28600
28601 .vindex "&$host$&"
28602 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28603 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28604 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28605 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28606 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28607
28608 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28609 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28610 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28611 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28612 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28613 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28614 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28615 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28616 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28617 outgoing connection.
28618
28619
28620
28621 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28622 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28623 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28624 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28625 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28626 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28627 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28628 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28629 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28630 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28631 for this session.
28632
28633 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28634 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28635 address.
28636
28637 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28638 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28639 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28640 be of limited use in that environment.
28641
28642 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28643 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28644 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28645 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28646 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28647
28648 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28649 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28650 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28651 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28652 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28653
28654 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28655 received from a client.
28656 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28657
28658 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28659 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28660 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28661
28662 .ilist
28663 &%tls_certificate%&
28664 .next
28665 &%tls_crl%&
28666 .next
28667 &%tls_privatekey%&
28668 .next
28669 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28670 .next
28671 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
28672 .endlist
28673
28674 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28675 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28676 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28677 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28678 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28679 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28680 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28681
28682 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28683 are re-expanded.
28684
28685 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28686 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28687 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28688 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28689
28690 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28691 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28692 built, then you have SNI support).
28693
28694
28695
28696 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28697 "SECTmulmessam"
28698 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28699 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28700 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28701 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28702 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28703 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28704 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28705 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28706 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28707 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28708
28709 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28710 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28711 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28712 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28713 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28714 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28715 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28716
28717 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28718 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28719 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28720 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28721 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28722 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28723 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28724 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28725 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28726
28727 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28728 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28729 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28730 information is recorded.
28731
28732 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28733 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28734 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28735
28736
28737
28738
28739 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28740 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28741 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28742 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28743 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28744 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28745
28746 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28747 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28748 document is currently at
28749 .display
28750 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28751 .endd
28752 and their FAQ is at
28753 .display
28754 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28755 .endd
28756
28757 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28758 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28759 descriptions.
28760 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28761 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28762 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28763 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28764
28765
28766 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28767 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28768 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28769 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28770 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28771 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28772 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28773 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28774 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28775 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28776 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28777 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28778 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28779
28780 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28781 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28782 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28783 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28784
28785
28786
28787 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28788 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28789 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28790 with OpenSSL, like this:
28791 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28792 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28793 .code
28794 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28795 -days 9999 -nodes
28796 .endd
28797 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28798 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28799 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28800 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28801 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28802 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28803 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28804
28805 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28806 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28807 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28808 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28809 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28810 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28811 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28812 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28813 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28814 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28815 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28816 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28817 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28818 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28819 be a sensible resolution).
28820
28821 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28822 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28823 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28824
28825 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28826 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28827 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28828 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28829 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28830 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28831
28832 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28833 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28834 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28835 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28836 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28837 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28838
28839
28840
28841 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28842 .cindex DANE
28843 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28844 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28845 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28846 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28847 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28848 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28849
28850 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28851 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28852 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28853
28854 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28855 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28856
28857 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28858 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28859 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28860
28861 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28862 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28863 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28864 DNSSEC.
28865 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28866 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28867
28868 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28869 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28870 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28871 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28872
28873 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
28874 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
28875 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
28876 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
28877
28878 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28879 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28880 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28881 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28882 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28883 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28884 well-known one.
28885 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28886 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28887 does require careful arrangement.
28888 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28889 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28890 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28891 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28892 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28893
28894 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28895 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28896 your certificate.
28897 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28898 "MTA-STS", described below.
28899
28900 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28901 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28902 connections to you.
28903 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28904 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28905 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28906 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28907 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28908 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28909
28910 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28911 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28912 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28913 random serial numbers.
28914 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28915 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28916 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28917 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28918
28919 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
28920 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
28921
28922 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
28923
28924 .code
28925 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28926 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28927 | openssl sha512 \
28928 | awk '{print $2}'
28929 .endd
28930
28931 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
28932
28933 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
28934
28935 .code
28936 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
28937 .endd
28938
28939 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28940 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
28941
28942
28943 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28944
28945 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28946 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28947 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28948 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28949 libraries.
28950 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28951 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28952
28953 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28954 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28955 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28956
28957 .code
28958 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28959 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28960 {*}{}}
28961 .endd
28962
28963 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28964 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28965 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28966 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28967 control the OCSP request.
28968
28969 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28970 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28971
28972
28973 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28974 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28975 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not
28976 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
28977 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
28978
28979 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28980
28981 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28982 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28983 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28984 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28985
28986 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28987 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28988 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28989 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28990 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28991 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28992 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28993
28994 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28995 .code
28996 hosts_require_tls
28997 tls_verify_hosts
28998 tls_try_verify_hosts
28999 tls_verify_certificates
29000 tls_crl
29001 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29002 .endd
29003
29004 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29005 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29006
29007 Currently the (router or transport options) &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29008
29009 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29010
29011 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29012 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29013 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29014 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29015
29016 .cindex DANE reporting
29017 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29018 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29019 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29020 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29021 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29022 Section 4.3 of that document.
29023
29024 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29025
29026 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29027 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29028 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29029 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29030 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29031 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29032 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29033 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29034 information.
29035
29036 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29037 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29038 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29039
29040 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29041 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29042 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29043 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29044 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29045 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29046 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29047
29048
29049
29050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29052
29053 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29054 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29055 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29056 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29057 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29058 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29059 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29060 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29061 one very small ACL:
29062 .code
29063 begin acl
29064 small_acl:
29065 accept hosts = one.host.only
29066 .endd
29067 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29068 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29069
29070 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29071 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29072 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29073 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29074 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29075 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29076 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29077 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29078
29079
29080 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29081 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29082 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29083
29084
29085 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29086 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29087 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29088 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29089 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29090 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29091 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29092 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29093 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29094 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29095 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29096 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29097 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29098 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29099 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29100 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29101 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29102 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29103 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29104 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29105
29106 .table2 140pt
29107 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29108 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29109 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29110 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29111 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29112 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29113 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29114 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29115 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29116 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29117 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29118 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29119 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29120 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29121 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29122 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29123 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29124 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29125 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29126 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29127 .endtable
29128
29129 For example, if you set
29130 .code
29131 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29132 .endd
29133 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29134 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29135 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29136 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29137 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29138 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29139 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29140
29141
29142 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29143 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29144 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29145 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29146 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29147 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29148 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29149 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29150 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29151 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29152 in any of these ACLs.
29153
29154 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29155 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29156 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29157 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29158 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29159 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29160 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29161 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29162 .code
29163 control = suppress_local_fixups
29164 .endd
29165 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29166 run, it is too late.
29167
29168 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29169 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29170
29171 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29172 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29173 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29174
29175
29176 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29177 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29178 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29179 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29180 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29181 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29182 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29183 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29184 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29185
29186
29187 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29188 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29189 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29190 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29191 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29192 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29193 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29194 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29195 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29196
29197 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29198 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29199 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29200
29201 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29202 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29203 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29204 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29205 an EHLO response.
29206
29207
29208 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29209 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29210 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29211 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29212 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29213 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29214 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29215 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29216 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29217 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29218
29219 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29220 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29221 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29222 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29223 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29224 associated with the DATA command.
29225
29226 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29227 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29228 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29229 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29230 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29231 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29232 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29233 the data specified is received.
29234
29235 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29236 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29237 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29238 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29239 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29240 your resources.
29241
29242 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29243 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29244 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29245 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29246
29247 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29248 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29249 enabled (which is the default).
29250
29251 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29252 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29253 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29254
29255 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29256
29257 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29258
29259
29260 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29261 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29262 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29263
29264 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29265
29266
29267 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29268 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29269 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29270 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29271 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29272 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29273 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29274 has been accepted.
29275
29276 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29277 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29278 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29279 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29280 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29281 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29282 for some or all recipients.
29283
29284 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29285 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29286 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29287 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29288 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29289 is &"yes"&.
29290 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29291 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29292 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29293
29294 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29295 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29296
29297 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29298 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29299 the feature was not requested by the client.
29300
29301 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29302 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29303 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29304 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29305 does not in fact control any access.
29306 For this reason, it may only accept
29307 or warn as its final result.
29308
29309 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29310 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29311 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29312 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29313
29314 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29315 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29316
29317 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29318 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29319 response to QUIT.
29320
29321 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29322 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29323 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29324 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29325 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29326
29327
29328 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29329 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29330 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29331 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29332 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29333 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29334 situation even worse.
29335
29336 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29337 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29338 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29339 and &%warn%&.
29340
29341 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29342 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29343 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29344 connection. The possible values are:
29345 .table2
29346 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29347 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29348 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29349 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29350 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29351 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29352 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29353 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29354 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29355 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29356 .endtable
29357 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29358 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29359 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29360 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29361 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29362 used.
29363
29364
29365 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29366 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29367 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29368 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29369 .code
29370 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29371 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29372 .endd
29373 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29374 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29375 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29376 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29377 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29378
29379 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29380 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29381 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29382
29383 .ilist
29384 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29385 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29386 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29387 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29388 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29389 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29390 .code
29391 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29392 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29393 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29394 .endd
29395 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29396 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29397 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29398 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29399 .next
29400 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29401 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29402 matches the string.
29403 .next
29404 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29405 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29406 want to have something like
29407 .code
29408 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29409 .endd
29410 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29411 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29412 .endlist
29413
29414
29415
29416
29417 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29418 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29419 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29420 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29421 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29422 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29423 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29424 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29425 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29426
29427 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29428 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29429 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29430
29431
29432 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29433 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29434 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29435 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29436
29437 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29438 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29439 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29440 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29441 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29442 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29443 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29444
29445 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29446 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29447
29448
29449 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29450 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29451 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29452
29453
29454
29455 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29456 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29457 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29458 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29459 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29460 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29461
29462 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29463 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29464 used to accept or reject anything.
29465
29466 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29467 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29468 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29469 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29470
29471 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29472 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29473 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29474 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29475 configuration file.
29476
29477
29478
29479
29480 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29481 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29482 .vindex &$domain$&
29483 .vindex &$local_part$&
29484 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29485 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29486 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29487 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29488 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29489 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29490 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29491 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29492 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29493
29494 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29495 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29496 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29497 how it is used.
29498
29499 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29500 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29501 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29502 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29503 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29504 received).
29505
29506 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29507 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29508 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29509 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29510 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29511 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29512 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29513 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29514
29515
29516
29517
29518
29519 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29520 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29521 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29522 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29523 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29524 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29525 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29526 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29527 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29528 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29529 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29530 unencrypted connections.
29531 .code
29532 acl_check_auth:
29533 accept encrypted = *
29534 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29535 {CRAM-MD5}}
29536 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29537 .endd
29538 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29539 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29540 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29541 option to do this.)
29542
29543
29544
29545 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29546 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29547 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29548 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29549 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29550 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29551 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29552
29553 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29554 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29555 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29556 example:
29557 .code
29558 deny dnslists = list1.example
29559 dnslists = list2.example
29560 .endd
29561 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29562 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29563 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29564 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29565 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29566
29567
29568 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29569 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29570
29571 .ilist
29572 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29573 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29574 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29575 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29576 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29577 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29578 check a RCPT command:
29579 .code
29580 accept domains = +local_domains
29581 endpass
29582 verify = recipient
29583 .endd
29584 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29585 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29586 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29587 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29588 &%endpass%&.
29589
29590 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29591 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29592 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29593 configuration.
29594
29595 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29596 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29597 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29598 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29599 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29600 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29601 .display
29602 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29603 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29604 .endd
29605 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29606 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29607 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29608
29609 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29610 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29611 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29612 of &%endpass%&.
29613
29614
29615 .next
29616 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29617 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29618 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29619 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29620 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29621 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29622 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29623
29624
29625 .next
29626 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29627 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29628 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29629 example,
29630 .code
29631 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29632 .endd
29633 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29634
29635
29636 .next
29637 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29638 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29639 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29640 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29641 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29642 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29643 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29644 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29645 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29646
29647 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29648 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29649 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29650
29651
29652 .next
29653 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29654 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29655 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29656 .code
29657 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29658 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29659 .endd
29660 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29661 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29662
29663 .next
29664 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29665 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29666 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29667 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29668 .code
29669 require message = Sender did not verify
29670 verify = sender
29671 .endd
29672 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29673 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29674 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29675 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29676
29677 .next
29678 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29679 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29680 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29681 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29682 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29683 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29684 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29685
29686 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29687 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29688 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29689 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29690 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29691
29692 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29693 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29694 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29695 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29696 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29697 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29698 onwards.
29699
29700
29701 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29702 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29703 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29704 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29705 .code
29706 warn !verify = sender
29707 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29708 .endd
29709 .endlist
29710
29711 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29712
29713 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29714 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29715 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29716 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29717 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29718
29719
29720
29721 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29722 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29723 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29724 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29725 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29726 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29727 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29728 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29729 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29730 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29731 .ilist
29732 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29733 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29734 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29735 on the same SMTP connection.
29736 .next
29737 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29738 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29739 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29740 .endlist
29741
29742 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29743 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29744 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29745 .code
29746 accept hosts = whatever
29747 set acl_m4 = some value
29748 accept authenticated = *
29749 set acl_c_auth = yes
29750 .endd
29751 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29752 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29753 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29754
29755 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29756 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29757 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29758 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29759 error is generated.
29760
29761 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29762 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29763
29764
29765 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29766 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29767 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29768 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29769 .code
29770 deny domains = *.dom.example
29771 !verify = recipient
29772 .endd
29773 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29774 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29775 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29776 two statements are equivalent:
29777 .code
29778 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29779 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29780 .endd
29781 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29782 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29783
29784 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29785 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29786 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29787 .code
29788 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29789 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29790 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29791 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29792 .endd
29793 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29794 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29795 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29796 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29797 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29798 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29799 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29800
29801 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29802 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29803 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29804 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29805 message is handled.
29806
29807 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29808 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29809 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29810 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29811 .code
29812 require message = Can't verify sender
29813 verify = sender
29814 message = Can't verify recipient
29815 verify = recipient
29816 message = This message cannot be used
29817 .endd
29818 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29819 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29820 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29821 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29822 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29823 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29824
29825 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29826 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29827 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29828 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29829 .code
29830 deny hosts = ...
29831 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29832 message = Invalid sender from client host
29833 .endd
29834 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29835 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29836
29837
29838
29839 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29840 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29841 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29842
29843 .vlist
29844 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29845 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29846 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29847 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29848
29849 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29850 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29851 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29852 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29853 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29854 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29855 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29856 write rather ugly lines like this:
29857 .display
29858 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29859 .endd
29860 Instead, all you need is
29861 .display
29862 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29863 .endd
29864
29865 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29866 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29867 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29868 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29869 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29870 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29871 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29872 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29873
29874 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29875 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29876 in several different ways. For example:
29877
29878 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29879 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29880 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29881 . ==== way.
29882
29883 .ilist
29884 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29885 .code
29886 accept ...some conditions
29887 control = queue_only
29888 .endd
29889 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29890 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29891
29892 .next
29893 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29894 .code
29895 accept ...some conditions...
29896 control = queue_only
29897 ...some more conditions...
29898 .endd
29899 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29900 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29901 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29902 to be relevant.
29903
29904 .next
29905 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29906 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29907 example:
29908 .code
29909 warn ...some conditions...
29910 control = freeze
29911 accept ...
29912 .endd
29913 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29914 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29915 log entry.
29916
29917 .next
29918 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29919 &%require%& verb. For example:
29920 .code
29921 require control = no_multiline_responses
29922 .endd
29923 .endlist
29924
29925 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29926 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29927 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
29928 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29929 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29930 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29931 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29932 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29933 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29934
29935 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29936 example:
29937 .code
29938 deny ...some conditions...
29939 delay = 30s
29940 .endd
29941 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29942 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29943 .code
29944 deny delay = 30s
29945 ...some conditions...
29946 .endd
29947 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29948 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29949 .code
29950 warn ...some conditions...
29951 delay = 2m
29952 control = freeze
29953 accept ...
29954 .endd
29955
29956 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29957 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29958 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29959 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29960 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29961 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29962 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29963
29964
29965 .vitem &*endpass*&
29966 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29967 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29968 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29969 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29970 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29971 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29972 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29973
29974
29975 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29976 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29977 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29978 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29979 .code
29980 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29981 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29982 .endd
29983 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29984 example:
29985 .display
29986 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29987 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29988 .endd
29989 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29990 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29991 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29992 message.
29993
29994 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29995 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29996 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29997 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29998 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29999 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30000 ignored.
30001
30002 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30003 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30004 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30005 error message.
30006
30007 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30008 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30009 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30010 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30011 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30012 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30013
30014 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30015 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30016 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30017 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30018 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30019 logging rejections.
30020
30021
30022 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30023 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30024 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30025 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30026 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30027 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30028 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30029 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30030 .display
30031 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30032 &` log_reject_target =`&
30033 .endd
30034 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30035 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30036 current ACL.
30037
30038
30039 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30040 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30041 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30042 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30043 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30044 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30045 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30046 ACLs. For example:
30047 .display
30048 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30049 &` control = freeze`&
30050 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30051 .endd
30052 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30053 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30054 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30055 example:
30056 .code
30057 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30058 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30059 .endd
30060
30061
30062 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30063 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30064 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30065 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30066 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30067 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30068 &%accept%& for details.)
30069
30070 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30071 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30072 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30073 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30074 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30075 .code
30076 require message = Host not recognized
30077 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30078 .endd
30079 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30080 processed.)
30081
30082 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30083 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30084 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30085 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30086 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30087 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30088 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30089 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30090 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30091 EHLO options.
30092
30093 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30094 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30095 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30096 .code
30097 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30098 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30099 .endd
30100 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30101 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30102 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30103 2&'xx'&.
30104
30105 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30106 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30107
30108 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30109 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30110 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30111 response.
30112
30113 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30114 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30115 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30116
30117 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30118 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30119 However, the original message is available in the variable
30120 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30121 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30122 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30123 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30124
30125 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30126 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30127 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30128 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30129 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30130 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30131 effect.
30132
30133
30134 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30135 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30136 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30137 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30138 for the message.
30139 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30140 the DATA ACL).
30141 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30142 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30143 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30144 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30145
30146
30147 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30148 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30149 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30150 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30151
30152
30153 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30154 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30155 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30156 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30157
30158
30159 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30160 .cindex "UDP communications"
30161 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30162 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30163 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30164 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30165 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30166 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30167 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30168 when:
30169 .code
30170 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30171 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30172 .endd
30173 .endlist
30174
30175
30176
30177
30178 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30179 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30180 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30181
30182 .vlist
30183 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30184 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30185 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30186 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30187 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30188 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30189 not work without it. For example:
30190 .code
30191 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30192 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30193 .endd
30194 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30195 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30196 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30197 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30198 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30199
30200
30201 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30202 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30203 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30204 .cindex "case of local parts"
30205 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30206 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30207 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30208 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30209 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30210 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30211 is encountered.
30212
30213 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30214 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30215 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30216 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30217 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30218
30219 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30220 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30221 spam score:
30222 .code
30223 warn control = caseful_local_part
30224 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30225 $acl_m4 + \
30226 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30227 }
30228 control = caselower_local_part
30229 .endd
30230 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30231 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30232
30233
30234 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30235 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30236 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30237 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30238
30239 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30240 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30241 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30242 is used for all recipients of the message,
30243 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30244 and data is copied from one to the other.
30245
30246 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30247 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30248 If a recipient-verify callout
30249 (with use_sender)
30250 connection is subsequently
30251 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30252 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30253 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30254
30255 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30256 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30257 Note also that headers cannot be
30258 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30259 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30260 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30261 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30262 this will affect the timestamp.
30263
30264 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30265 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30266 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30267 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30268 message body.
30269
30270 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30271 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30272 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30273 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30274 or CHUNKING
30275 options in use.
30276
30277 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30278 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30279 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30280 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30281 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30282
30283 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30284 usual fashion.
30285 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30286 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30287 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30288 and does not queue the message.
30289 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30290
30291 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30292 (possibly faked)
30293 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30294
30295
30296 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30297 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30298 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30299 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30300 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30301 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30302 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30303 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30304 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30305 option.
30306 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30307 with the &'kill'& option.
30308 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30309 contexts):
30310 .code
30311 control = debug
30312 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30313 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30314 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30315 control = debug/kill
30316 .endd
30317
30318
30319 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30320 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30321 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30322 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30323 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30324
30325
30326 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30327 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30328 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30329 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30330 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30331 strings or to numeric value.
30332 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30333 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30334 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30335
30336 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30337 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30338 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30339 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30340 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30341
30342
30343 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30344 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30345 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30346 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30347 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30348 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30349 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30350 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30351
30352 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30353 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30354 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30355 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30356 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30357 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30358 work with.
30359
30360
30361 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30362 .cindex "fake defer"
30363 .cindex "defer, fake"
30364 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30365 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30366 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30367 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30368 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30369
30370 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30371 .cindex "fake rejection"
30372 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30373 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30374 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30375 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30376 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30377 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30378 the same SMTP connection.
30379
30380 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30381 message is supplied, the following is used:
30382 .code
30383 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30384 550-kept for evaluation.
30385 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30386 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30387 .endd
30388 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30389
30390 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30391 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30392 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30393 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30394 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30395 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30396 SMTP connection.
30397
30398 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30399 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30400 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30401 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30402
30403 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30404 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30405 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30406 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30407 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30408 disables such output flushing.
30409
30410 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30411 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30412 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30413 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30414 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30415 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30416
30417 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30418 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30419 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30420 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30421 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30422 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30423 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30424 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30425 to be useful in production.
30426
30427 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30428 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30429 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30430 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30431 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30432
30433 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30434 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30435 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30436 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30437 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30438 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30439
30440 .ilist
30441 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30442 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30443 verification failed"&) is sent.
30444 .next
30445 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30446 line is output.
30447 .endlist
30448
30449 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30450 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30451
30452 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30453 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30454 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30455 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30456 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30457 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30458 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30459
30460 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30461 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30462 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30463 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30464 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30465 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30466 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30467 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30468 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30469 same SMTP connection.
30470
30471 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30472 .cindex "message" "submission"
30473 .cindex "submission mode"
30474 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30475 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30476 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30477 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30478 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30479 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30480 late (the message has already been created).
30481
30482 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30483 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30484 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30485 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30486 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30487
30488 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30489 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30490 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30491 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30492 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30493
30494 .ilist
30495 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30496 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30497 .next
30498 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30499 .next
30500 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30501 .endlist ilist
30502
30503 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30504 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30505 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30506 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30507 data is read.
30508
30509 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30510 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30511
30512 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30513 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30514 to a-label form.
30515 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30516 .endlist vlist
30517
30518
30519 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30520 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30521
30522 .ilist
30523 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30524 .next
30525 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30526 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30527 .next
30528 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30529 .next
30530 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30531 .endlist
30532
30533
30534
30535 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30536 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30537 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30538 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30539 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30540 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30541 .code
30542 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30543 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30544 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30545 .endd
30546 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30547 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30548 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30549 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30550 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30551 RCPT ACL).
30552
30553 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30554 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30555
30556 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30557 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30558 contains one or more newlines that
30559 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30560 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30561 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30562
30563 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30564 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30565 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30566 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30567 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30568 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30569 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30570 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30571 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30572 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30573 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30574
30575 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30576 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30577 of message headers
30578 until they are added to the
30579 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30580 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30581 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30582 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30583 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30584 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30585 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30586
30587 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30588
30589 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30590 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30591 .display
30592 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30593 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30594
30595 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30596 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30597 .endd
30598 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30599 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30600 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30601 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30602 honoured.
30603
30604 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30605 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30606 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30607 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30608 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30609 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30610 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30611 specifications.
30612
30613 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30614 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30615 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30616 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30617 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30618
30619 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30620 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30621 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30622 to be a header name first.) For example:
30623 .code
30624 warn add_header = \
30625 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30626 .endd
30627 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30628 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30629 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30630 up in reverse order.
30631
30632 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30633 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30634 system filter or in a router or transport.
30635
30636
30637
30638 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30639 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30640 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30641 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30642 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30643 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30644 .code
30645 warn message = Remove internal headers
30646 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30647 .endd
30648 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30649 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30650 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30651 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30652 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30653 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30654
30655 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30656 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30657
30658 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30659 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30660 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30661 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30662 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30663 .code
30664 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30665 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30666 warn message = Remove internal headers
30667 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30668 .endd
30669 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30670 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30671 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30672 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30673 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30674 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30675 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30676 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30677 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30678 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30679 would have been removed.
30680
30681 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30682 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30683 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30684 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30685 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30686 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30687 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30688 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30689 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30690
30691 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30692 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30693 .display
30694 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30695 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30696
30697 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30698 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30699 .endd
30700 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30701 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30702 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30703 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30704 are honoured.
30705
30706 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30707 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30708 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30709
30710
30711
30712
30713 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30714 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30715 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30716 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30717 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30718 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30719
30720 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30721 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30722 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30723 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30724 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30725 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30726 The conditions are as follows:
30727
30728
30729 .vlist
30730 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30731 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30732 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30733 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30734 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30735 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30736 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30737 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30738 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30739 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30740 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30741 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30742
30743 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30744 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30745 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30746 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30747 The name and values are expanded separately.
30748 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30749 will act as argument separators.
30750
30751 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30752 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30753 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30754 conditions are tested.
30755
30756 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30757 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30758 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30759 for different local users or different local domains.
30760
30761 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30762 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30763 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30764 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30765 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30766 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30767 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30768 .code
30769 authenticated = *
30770 .endd
30771
30772 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30773 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30774 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30775 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30776 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30777 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30778 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30779 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30780 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30781 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30782 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30783 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30784 negative.
30785
30786 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30787 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30788 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30789 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30790 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30791 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30792 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30793 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30794
30795 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30796 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30797 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30798 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30799 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30800 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30801 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30802 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30803 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30804 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30805
30806 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30807 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30808 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30809 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30810 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30811 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30812 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30813 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30814 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30815 &%domains%& test.
30816
30817 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30818 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30819
30820
30821 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30822 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30823 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30824 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30825 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30826 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30827 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30828 .code
30829 encrypted = *
30830 .endd
30831
30832
30833 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30834 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30835 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30836 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30837 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30838 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30839 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30840 .code
30841 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30842 .endd
30843 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30844 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30845 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30846
30847 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30848 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30849 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30850 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30851 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30852 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30853
30854 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30855 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30856 .code
30857 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30858 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30859 .endd
30860 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30861 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30862 statement can then check the IP address.
30863
30864 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30865 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30866 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30867 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30868 .code
30869 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30870 message = $host_data
30871 .endd
30872 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30873
30874 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30875 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30876 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30877 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30878 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30879 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30880 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30881 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30882 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30883 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30884
30885 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30886 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30887 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30888 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30889 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30890 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30891 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30892
30893 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30894 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30895 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30896 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30897 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30898 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30899 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30900 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30901
30902 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30903 .cindex "rate limiting"
30904 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30905 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30906
30907 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30908 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30909 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30910 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30911 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30912 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30913
30914 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30915 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30916 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30917 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30918 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30919 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30920 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30921
30922 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30923 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30924 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30925 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30926 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30927 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30928 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30929 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30930 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30931 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30932 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30933 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30934 influence the sender checking.
30935
30936 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30937 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30938
30939 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30940 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30941 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30942 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30943 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30944 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30945 .code
30946 senders = :
30947 .endd
30948 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30949 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30950
30951 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30952 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30953 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30954 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30955 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30956 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30957
30958 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30959 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30960 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30961 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30962 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30963 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30964 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30965 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30966 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30967 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30968
30969 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30970 .cindex "CSA verification"
30971 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30972 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30973 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30974
30975 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30976 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30977 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30978 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30979 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30980 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30981 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30982 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30983 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30984 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30985
30986 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30987 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30988 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30989
30990 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30991 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30992 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30993 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30994 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30995 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30996 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30997 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30998 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30999 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31000 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31001 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31002 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31003 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31004 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31005
31006 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31007 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31008 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31009 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31010 .code
31011 deny senders = :
31012 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31013 !verify = header_sender
31014 .endd
31015
31016 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31017 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31018 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31019 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31020 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31021 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31022 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31023 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31024 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31025 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31026 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31027 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31028 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31029 appropriate.
31030
31031 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31032 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31033 .code
31034 To: @
31035 .endd
31036 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31037 common as they used to be.
31038
31039 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31040 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31041 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31042 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31043 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31044 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31045 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31046 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31047 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31048 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31049 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31050 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31051 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31052
31053 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31054 option), this condition is always true.
31055
31056
31057 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31058 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31059 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31060 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31061 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31062 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31063 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31064 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31065 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31066
31067 .new
31068 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31069 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31070 .wen
31071
31072 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31073 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31074
31075
31076 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31077 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31078 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31079 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31080 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31081 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31082 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31083 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31084 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31085 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31086 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31087 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31088 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31089 value for the child address.
31090
31091 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31092 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31093 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31094 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31095 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31096 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31097 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31098 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31099 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31100 original IP address.
31101
31102 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31103 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31104
31105 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31106 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31107
31108 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31109 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31110 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31111 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31112 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31113 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31114 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31115 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31116 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31117
31118 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31119 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31120 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31121 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31122 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31123 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31124 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31125
31126 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31127 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31128 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31129
31130 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31131 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31132 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31133 verified as a sender.
31134
31135 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31136 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31137 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31138 .code
31139 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31140 .endd
31141 .endlist
31142
31143
31144
31145 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31146 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31147 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31148 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31149 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31150 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31151 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31152 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31153 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31154 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31155 .code
31156 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31157 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31158 .endd
31159 the following records are looked up:
31160 .code
31161 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31162 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31163 .endd
31164 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31165 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31166 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31167 use two separate conditions:
31168 .code
31169 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31170 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31171 .endd
31172 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31173 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31174 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31175 processed.
31176
31177 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31178 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31179 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31180 following special items in the list:
31181 .display
31182 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31183 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31184 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31185 .endd
31186 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31187 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31188 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31189 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31190 .code
31191 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31192 .endd
31193 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31194 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31195 .code
31196 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31197 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31198 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31199 .endd
31200 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31201 .cindex DNS TTL
31202 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31203 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31204 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31205 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31206 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31207 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31208
31209 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31210 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31211 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31212
31213
31214
31215 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31216 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31217 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31218 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31219 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31220 .code
31221 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31222 .endd
31223 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31224 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31225 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31226 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31227
31228
31229
31230
31231 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31232 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31233 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31234 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31235 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31236 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31237 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31238 .code
31239 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31240 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31241 .endd
31242 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31243 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31244 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31245 up by this example is
31246 .code
31247 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31248 .endd
31249 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31250 addresses. For example:
31251 .code
31252 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31253 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31254 .endd
31255 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31256 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31257
31258
31259
31260
31261 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31262 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31263 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31264 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31265 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31266 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31267 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31268 either to double the separators like this:
31269 .code
31270 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31271 .endd
31272 or to change the separator character, like this:
31273 .code
31274 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31275 .endd
31276 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31277 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31278 occurs. Consider this condition:
31279 .code
31280 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31281 .endd
31282 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31283 .code
31284 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31285 a.domain.black.list.tld
31286 .endd
31287 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31288 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31289 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31290 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31291 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31292 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31293 error for a previous item.
31294
31295 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31296 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31297 .code
31298 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31299 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31300 .endd
31301 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31302 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31303 .code
31304 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31305 $sender_address_domain \
31306 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31307 see $dnslist_text.
31308 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31309 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31310 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31311 .endd
31312 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31313 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31314 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31315 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31316 .code
31317 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31318 .endd
31319 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31320 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31321
31322 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31323 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31324
31325
31326
31327
31328 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31329 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31330 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31331 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31332 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31333 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31334 .display
31335 127.1.0.1 RBL
31336 127.1.0.2 DUL
31337 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31338 127.1.0.4 RSS
31339 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31340 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31341 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31342 .endd
31343 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31344 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31345 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31346
31347
31348 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31349 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31350 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31351 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31352 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31353 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31354 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31355 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31356 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31357 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31358 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31359 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31360 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31361 cases, for example:
31362 .code
31363 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31364 .endd
31365 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31366 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31367 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31368 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31369 .code
31370 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31371 .endd
31372 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31373 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31374
31375 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31376 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31377 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31378 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31379 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31380 information.
31381
31382 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31383 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31384 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31385 .code
31386 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31387 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31388 at $dnslist_domain
31389 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31390 .endd
31391
31392
31393
31394 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31395 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31396 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31397 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31398 For example,
31399 .code
31400 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31401 .endd
31402 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31403 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31404 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31405 describes how multiple records are handled.
31406
31407 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31408 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31409 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31410 .code
31411 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31412 .endd
31413 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31414 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31415 first. For example:
31416 .code
31417 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31418 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31419 .endd
31420
31421 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31422 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31423 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31424 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31425 tested. For example:
31426 .code
31427 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31428 .endd
31429 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31430 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31431 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31432 .code
31433 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31434 .endd
31435 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31436 an odd number.
31437
31438
31439
31440 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31441 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31442 condition. Whereas
31443 .code
31444 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31445 .endd
31446 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31447 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31448 .code
31449 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31450 .endd
31451 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31452 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31453 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31454 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31455
31456 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31457 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31458
31459 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31460 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31461 .code
31462 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31463 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31464 .endd
31465 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31466 Consider this example:
31467 .code
31468 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31469 list.dsbl.org : \
31470 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31471 relays.ordb.org
31472 .endd
31473 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31474 .code
31475 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31476 list.dsbl.org
31477 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31478 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31479 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31480 .endd
31481 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31482
31483
31484
31485
31486 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31487 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31488 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31489 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31490 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31491 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31492 .code
31493 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31494 .endd
31495 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31496 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31497 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31498 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31499 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31500 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31501
31502 .ilist
31503 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31504 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31505 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31506 .next
31507 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31508 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31509 changed to:
31510 .code
31511 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31512 .endd
31513 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31514 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31515 .code
31516 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31517 .endd
31518 for the condition to be true.
31519 .endlist
31520
31521 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31522 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31523 .ilist
31524 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31525 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31526 .code
31527 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31528 .endd
31529 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31530 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31531 .next
31532 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31533 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31534 .code
31535 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31536 .endd
31537 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31538 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31539 .code
31540 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31541 .endd
31542 for the condition to be false.
31543 .endlist
31544 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31545 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31546
31547
31548
31549
31550 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31551 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31552 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31553 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31554 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31555 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31556 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31557 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31558 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31559 lists.
31560
31561 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31562 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31563 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31564 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31565 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31566 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31567 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31568 .code
31569 deny message = \
31570 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31571 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31572 dnslists = \
31573 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31574 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31575 .endd
31576 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31577 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31578 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31579 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31580 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31581 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31582
31583 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31584 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31585 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31586 .code
31587 deny dnslists = \
31588 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31589 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31590 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31591 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31592 .endd
31593 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31594 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31595 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31596
31597
31598
31599 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31600 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31601 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31602 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31603 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31604 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31605 .code
31606 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31607 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31608 .endd
31609 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31610 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31611 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31612 .code
31613 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31614 .endd
31615 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31616 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31617
31618 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31619 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31620 .code
31621 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31622 dnslists = some.list.example
31623 .endd
31624
31625 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31626 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31627 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31628 .code
31629 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31630 .endd
31631
31632 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31633 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31634 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31635 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31636 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31637 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31638 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31639 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31640 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31641 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31642 .display
31643 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31644 .endd
31645 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31646 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31647
31648 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31649 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31650 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31651 of &'p'&.
31652
31653 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31654 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31655 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31656 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31657 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31658 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31659 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31660 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31661 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31662
31663 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31664 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31665 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31666 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31667
31668 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31669 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31670 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31671 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31672 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31673 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31674 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31675 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31676 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31677 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31678
31679 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31680 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31681 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31682 ACL.
31683
31684 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31685 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31686 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31687 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31688 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31689 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31690
31691 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31692 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31693 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31694 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31695 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31696 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31697 the &%count=%& option.
31698
31699
31700 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31701 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31702 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31703 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31704 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31705
31706 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31707 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31708 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31709 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31710
31711 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31712 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31713 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31714 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31715 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31716 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31717 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31718
31719 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31720 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31721 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31722 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31723 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31724 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31725 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31726
31727 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31728 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31729 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31730 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31731 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31732
31733 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31734 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31735 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31736 multiple different commands.
31737
31738 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31739 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31740 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31741 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31742 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31743
31744 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31745
31746
31747 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31748 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31749 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31750 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31751 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31752
31753 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31754 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31755
31756 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31757 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31758 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31759 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31760 new rate.
31761 .code
31762 acl_check_connect:
31763 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31764 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31765 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31766 # ...
31767 acl_check_mail:
31768 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31769 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31770 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31771 .endd
31772
31773 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31774 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31775 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31776 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31777 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31778 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31779 checks.
31780
31781 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31782 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31783 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31784 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31785 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31786
31787
31788 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31789 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31790 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31791 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31792 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31793 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31794 rest of the ACL.
31795
31796 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31797 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31798 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31799 up to the given limit.
31800 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31801 consists of refusing the message, and
31802 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31803 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31804 likely not what is wanted.
31805
31806 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31807 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31808 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31809 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31810 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31811 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31812 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31813 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31814 .code
31815 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31816 .endd
31817
31818
31819 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31820 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31821 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31822 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31823 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31824 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31825 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31826 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31827 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31828
31829 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31830 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31831 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31832 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31833 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31834 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31835
31836 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31837 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31838 rate.
31839
31840 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31841 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31842 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31843 required increases with larger limits.
31844
31845 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31846 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31847 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31848 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31849 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31850 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31851 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31852 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31853 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31854 as intended.
31855
31856
31857 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31858 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31859 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31860 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31861 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31862 message. For example:
31863 .code
31864 # Log all senders' rates
31865 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31866 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31867
31868 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31869 # at the decimal point.
31870 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31871 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31872 $sender_rate_limit }s
31873
31874 # Keep authenticated users under control
31875 deny authenticated = *
31876 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31877
31878 # System-wide rate limit
31879 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31880 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31881
31882 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31883 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31884 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31885 messages per $sender_rate_period
31886 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31887 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31888 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31889 .endd
31890 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31891 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31892 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31893 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31894 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31895 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31896 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31897
31898
31899
31900 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31901 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31902 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31903 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31904 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31905 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31906 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31907 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31908 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31909 .code
31910 verify = sender/callout
31911 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31912 .endd
31913 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31914 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31915 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31916 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31917 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31918 The available options are as follows:
31919
31920 .ilist
31921 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31922 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31923 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31924 .next
31925 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31926 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31927 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31928 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31929 .next
31930 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31931 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31932 .next
31933 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31934 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31935 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31936 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31937 .endlist
31938
31939 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31940 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31941 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31942 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31943 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31944 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31945 coding like this:
31946 .code
31947 warn !verify = sender
31948 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31949 .endd
31950 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31951 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31952 verification failure.
31953
31954 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31955 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31956
31957 .ilist
31958 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31959 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31960 .next
31961 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31962 .next
31963 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31964 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31965 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31966 .next
31967 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31968 .next
31969 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31970 .endlist
31971
31972 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31973 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31974
31975 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31976 address verification to:
31977
31978 .ilist
31979 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31980 .endlist
31981
31982
31983
31984
31985 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31986 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31987 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31988 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31989 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31990 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31991 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31992 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31993 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31994 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31995 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31996 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31997 sender's domain.
31998
31999 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32000 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32001 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32002 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32003 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32004 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32005
32006 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32007 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32008 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32009 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32010 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32011
32012 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32013 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32014 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32015 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32016 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32017 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32018 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32019 supplies a host list.
32020 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32021
32022 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32023 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32024 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32025 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32026 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32027 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32028 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32029
32030 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32031 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32032 following SMTP commands are sent:
32033 .display
32034 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32035 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32036 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32037 &`QUIT`&
32038 .endd
32039 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32040 set to &"lmtp"&.
32041
32042 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32043 settings.
32044
32045 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32046 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32047 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32048 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32049 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32050 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32051
32052 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32053 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32054 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32055 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32056 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32057
32058 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32059 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32060 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32061 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32062 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32063
32064
32065
32066
32067 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32068 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32069 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32070 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32071 .code
32072 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32073 .endd
32074 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32075 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32076 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32077
32078
32079 .vlist
32080 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32081 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32082 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32083 For example:
32084 .code
32085 verify = sender/callout=5s
32086 .endd
32087 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32088 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32089 the &%connect%& parameter.
32090
32091
32092 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32093 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32094 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32095 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32096 .code
32097 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32098 .endd
32099 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32100
32101 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32102 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32103 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32104 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32105 updated in this circumstance.
32106
32107 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32108 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32109 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32110 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32111 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32112 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32113
32114
32115 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32116 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32117 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32118 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32119 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32120 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32121 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32122 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32123 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32124 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32125 .code
32126 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32127 .endd
32128 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32129
32130
32131 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32132 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32133 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32134 For example:
32135 .code
32136 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32137 .endd
32138 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32139 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32140 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32141 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32142 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32143
32144
32145 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32146 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32147 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32148 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32149
32150 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32151 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32152 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32153 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32154 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32155 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32156 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32157 made, until the cache record expires.
32158
32159 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32160 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32161 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32162 For example:
32163 .code
32164 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32165 .endd
32166 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32167 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32168 .code
32169 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32170 .endd
32171 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32172 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32173 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32174 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32175
32176
32177 .vitem &*random*&
32178 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32179 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32180 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32181 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32182 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32183 .code
32184 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32185 .endd
32186 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32187 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32188 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32189 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32190 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32191
32192 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32193 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32194 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32195 .code
32196 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32197 .endd
32198 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32199 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32200 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32201 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32202 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32203
32204 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32205 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32206 .code
32207 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32208 .endd
32209 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32210 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32211 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32212 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32213 usefulness of callout caching.
32214
32215 .vitem &*hold*&
32216 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32217 .code
32218 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32219 .endd
32220 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32221 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32222 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32223 when that is used for the connections.
32224 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32225 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32226 if the use_sender option is used,
32227 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32228 and if no other callouts intervene.
32229 .endlist
32230
32231 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32232 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32233 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32234 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32235 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32236 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32237 these circumstances.
32238
32239 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32240 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32241 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32242 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32243 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32244 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32245 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32246
32247 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32248 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32249 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32250 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32251
32252
32253
32254
32255 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32256 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32257 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32258 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32259 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32260 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32261 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32262 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32263 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32264 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32265
32266 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32267 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32268 is not available.
32269
32270 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32271 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32272 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32273
32274 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32275 commands up to and including
32276 .code
32277 MAIL FROM:<>
32278 .endd
32279 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32280 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32281 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32282 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32283 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32284 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32285 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32286
32287 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32288 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32289 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32290 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32291 will eventually be noticed.
32292
32293 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32294 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32295 behaviour will be the same.
32296
32297
32298
32299 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32300 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32301 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32302 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32303 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32304 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32305 you might see:
32306 .code
32307 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32308 250 OK
32309 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32310 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32311 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32312 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32313 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32314 550 Sender verification failed
32315 .endd
32316 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32317 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32318 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32319 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32320 example:
32321 .code
32322 verify = sender/no_details
32323 .endd
32324
32325 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32326 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32327 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32328 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32329 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32330 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32331 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32332
32333 .ilist
32334 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32335 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32336 verification also fails.
32337 .next
32338 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32339 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32340 .endlist
32341
32342 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32343 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32344 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32345 .code
32346 A.Wol: aw123
32347 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32348 .endd
32349 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32350 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32351 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32352 verification to succeed.
32353
32354 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32355 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32356 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32357 option. For example:
32358 .code
32359 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32360 .endd
32361 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32362 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32363
32364 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32365 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32366 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32367 address and a report is output for each of them.
32368
32369
32370
32371 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32372 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32373 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32374 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32375 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32376 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32377 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32378 .code
32379 verify = csa
32380 .endd
32381 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32382 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32383 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32384 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32385 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32386 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32387
32388 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32389 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32390 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32391 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32392
32393 .ilist
32394 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32395 .next
32396 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32397 .next
32398 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32399 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32400 .next
32401 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32402 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32403 .endlist
32404
32405 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32406 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32407 .code
32408 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32409 .endd
32410 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32411 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32412 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32413 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32414 meaningful to say:
32415 .code
32416 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32417 .endd
32418 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32419 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32420 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32421
32422 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32423 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32424 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32425 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32426 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32427 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32428 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32429 of legitimate HELO domains.
32430
32431 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32432 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32433 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32434 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32435 lookup such as:
32436 .code
32437 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32438 .endd
32439 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32440 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32441 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32442
32443
32444
32445
32446 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32447 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32448 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32449 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32450 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32451 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32452 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32453 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32454
32455 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32456 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32457 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32458 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32459 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32460 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32461 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32462 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32463
32464 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32465 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32466 like this:
32467 .code
32468 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32469 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32470 }{$value}}
32471 .endd
32472 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32473 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32474 use this:
32475 .code
32476 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32477 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32478 senders = :
32479 recipients = +batv_senders
32480
32481 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32482 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32483 senders = :
32484 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32485 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32486 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32487 .endd
32488 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32489 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32490 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32491 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32492 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32493
32494 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32495 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32496 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32497 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32498 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32499 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32500 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32501
32502 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32503 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32504 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32505 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32506 .code
32507 batv_redirect:
32508 driver = redirect
32509 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32510 .endd
32511 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32512 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32513 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32514 local addresses.
32515
32516 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32517 can be used:
32518 .code
32519 external_smtp_batv:
32520 driver = smtp
32521 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32522 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32523 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32524 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32525 {$value}fail}}}
32526 .endd
32527 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32528
32529
32530
32531 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32532 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32533 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32534 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32535 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32536 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32537 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32538 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32539 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32540 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32541
32542 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32543 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32544 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32545 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32546 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32547 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32548 . ///
32549 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32550 . ///
32551 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32552 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32553 system to arbitrary domains.
32554
32555
32556 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32557 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32558 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32559 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32560
32561 .ilist
32562 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32563 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32564 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32565 .next
32566 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32567 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32568 .next
32569 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32570 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32571 .endlist
32572
32573
32574 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32575 .code
32576 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32577 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32578 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32579 .endd
32580 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32581 command:
32582 .code
32583 acl_check_rcpt:
32584 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32585 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32586 .endd
32587 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32588 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32589 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32590 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32591 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32592 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32593 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32594
32595
32596
32597 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32598 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32599 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32600 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32601 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32602 .ecindex IIDacl
32603
32604
32605
32606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32608
32609 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32610 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32611 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32612 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32613 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32614 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32615 specification.
32616
32617 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32618 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32619 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32620 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32621 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32622
32623 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32624 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32625 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32626
32627 .ilist
32628 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32629 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32630 .next
32631 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32632 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32633 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32634 .next
32635 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32636 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32637 .next
32638 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32639 conditions.
32640 .next
32641 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32642 .endlist
32643
32644 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32645 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32646 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32647 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32648 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32649 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32650
32651 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32652 temporarily created in a file called:
32653 .display
32654 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32655 .endd
32656 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32657 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32658 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32659 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32660 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32661 .code
32662 control = no_mbox_unspool
32663 .endd
32664 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32665 same directory by default.
32666
32667
32668
32669 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32670 .cindex "virus scanning"
32671 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32672 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32673 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32674 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32675 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32676 in memory and thus are much faster.
32677
32678 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32679 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32680
32681 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32682 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32683 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32684 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32685 .display
32686 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32687 .endd
32688 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32689 .code
32690 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32691 .endd
32692 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32693 before use.
32694 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32695 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32696 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32697
32698 .vlist
32699 .vitem &%avast%&
32700 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32701 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32702 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32703 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32704 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32705 This scanner type takes one option,
32706 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32707 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32708 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32709 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32710 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32711 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32712 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32713
32714 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32715 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32716 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32717 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32718 care.
32719
32720 For example:
32721 .code
32722 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32723 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32724 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32725 .endd
32726 If you omit the argument, the default path
32727 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32728 is used.
32729 If you use a remote host,
32730 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32731 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32732 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32733 .code
32734 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32735 FLAGS
32736 SENSITIVITY
32737 PACK
32738 .endd
32739
32740 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32741 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32742 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32743
32744 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32745 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32746 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32747 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32748 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32749 example:
32750 .code
32751 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32752 .endd
32753
32754
32755 .vitem &%clamd%&
32756 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32757 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32758 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32759 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32760 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32761
32762 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32763 a UNIX socket specification,
32764 a TCP socket specification,
32765 or a (global) option.
32766
32767 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32768 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32769 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32770 and the second a port number,
32771 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32772 These per-server options are supported:
32773 .code
32774 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32775 .endd
32776
32777 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32778 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32779
32780 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32781
32782 Examples:
32783 .code
32784 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32785 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32786 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32787 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32788 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32789 .endd
32790 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32791 &`local`&
32792 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32793 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32794 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32795 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32796
32797 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32798 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32799 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32800 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32801 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32802 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32803 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32804 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32805 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32806 .code
32807 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32808 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32809 (Connection refused)
32810 .endd
32811
32812 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32813 contributing the code for this scanner.
32814
32815 .vitem &%cmdline%&
32816 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32817 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32818 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32819 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32820
32821 .olist
32822 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32823 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32824
32825 .next
32826 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32827 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32828 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32829 the &"trigger"& expression.
32830
32831 .next
32832 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32833 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32834 &"name"& expression.
32835 .endlist olist
32836
32837 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32838 .code
32839 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32840 .endd
32841 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32842 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32843 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32844 configuration setting:
32845 .code
32846 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32847 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32848 found in file:'(.+)'
32849 .endd
32850 .vitem &%drweb%&
32851 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32852 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32853 takes one option,
32854 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32855 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32856 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32857 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32858 For example:
32859 .code
32860 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32861 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32862 .endd
32863 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32864 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32865
32866 .vitem &%f-protd%&
32867 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32868 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32869 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32870 (or port-range).
32871 For example:
32872 .code
32873 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32874 .endd
32875 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32876
32877 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32878 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32879 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32880 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32881 For example:
32882 .code
32883 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32884 .endd
32885 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32886
32887 .vitem &%fsecure%&
32888 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32889 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32890 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32891 .code
32892 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32893 .endd
32894 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32895 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32896
32897 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32898 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32899 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32900 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32901 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32902 For example:
32903 .code
32904 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32905 .endd
32906 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32907
32908 .vitem &%mksd%&
32909 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32910 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32911 though some documentation was available in English.
32912 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32913 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32914 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32915 to integrate.
32916 The only option for this scanner type is
32917 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32918 provided that mksd has
32919 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32920 .code
32921 av_scanner = mksd:2
32922 .endd
32923 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32924
32925 .vitem &%sock%&
32926 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32927 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32928 running on the local machine.
32929 There are four options:
32930 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32931 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32932 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32933 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32934 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32935 For example:
32936 .code
32937 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32938 .endd
32939 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32940 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32941 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32942 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32943 specify an empty element to get this.
32944
32945 .vitem &%sophie%&
32946 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32947 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32948 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32949 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32950 client communication. For example:
32951 .code
32952 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32953 .endd
32954 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32955 the option.
32956 .endlist
32957
32958 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32959 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32960 ACL.
32961
32962 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32963 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32964 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32965 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32966 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32967 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32968 message.
32969
32970 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32971 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32972 The first element can then be one of
32973
32974 .ilist
32975 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32976 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32977 recommended usage.
32978 .next
32979 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32980 the condition fails immediately.
32981 .next
32982 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32983 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32984 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32985 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32986 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32987 .endlist
32988
32989 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32990 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32991 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32992
32993 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32994 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32995 For example:
32996 .code
32997 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32998 .endd
32999 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33000
33001 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33002 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33003 is set to record the actual address used.
33004
33005 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33006 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33007 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33008 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33009 logging data.
33010
33011 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33012 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33013
33014 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33015 .code
33016 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33017 malware = *
33018 .endd
33019 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33020 .code
33021 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33022 malware = */defer_ok
33023 .endd
33024 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33025 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33026 .code
33027 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33028 .endd
33029 in the main Exim configuration.
33030 .code
33031 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33032 set acl_m0 = sophie
33033 malware = *
33034
33035 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33036 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33037 malware = *
33038 .endd
33039
33040
33041 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33042 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33043 .cindex "spam scanning"
33044 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33045 .cindex "Rspamd"
33046 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33047 score and a report for the message.
33048 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33049
33050 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33051 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33052 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33053
33054 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33055 .code
33056 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33057 .endd
33058 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33059 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33060 nicely, however.
33061
33062 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33063 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33064 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33065 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33066 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33067 configuration as follows (example):
33068 .code
33069 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33070 .endd
33071 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33072 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33073 iptables firewall, consider setting
33074 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33075 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33076 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33077 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33078 soon.
33079
33080
33081 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33082 on TCP port 11333)
33083 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33084 .code
33085 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33086 .endd
33087
33088 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33089 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33090 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33091 .code
33092 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33093 .endd
33094 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33095 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33096 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33097 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33098 .code
33099 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33100 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33101 192.168.2.12 783
33102 .endd
33103 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33104 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33105 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33106 condition defers.
33107
33108 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33109 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33110 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33111 take care to not double the separator.
33112
33113 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33114 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33115 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33116 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33117
33118 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33119 are options.
33120 The supported options are:
33121 .code
33122 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33123 weight=<value> Selection bias
33124 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33125 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33126 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33127 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33128 .endd
33129
33130 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33131 higher values being tried first.
33132 The default priority is 1.
33133
33134 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33135 Within a priority set
33136 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33137 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33138
33139 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33140 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33141 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33142 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33143
33144 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33145 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33146
33147 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33148 The default value is two minutes.
33149
33150 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33151 a failed connect is made.
33152 The default is to not retry.
33153
33154 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33155 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33156 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33157 expansion.
33158
33159 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33160 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33161 is set to record the actual address used.
33162
33163 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33164 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33165 .code
33166 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33167 spam = joe
33168 .endd
33169 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33170 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33171 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33172 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33173 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33174 right-hand side.
33175
33176 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33177 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33178 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33179 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33180 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33181 are not set.
33182 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33183 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33184 after the first),
33185 or the use of PRDR,
33186 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33187 are needed to use this feature.
33188
33189 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33190 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33191 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33192
33193
33194 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33195 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33196 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33197 example:
33198 .code
33199 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33200 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33201 spam = nobody
33202 .endd
33203
33204 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33205 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33206 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33207 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33208
33209 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33210 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33211 variables.
33212 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33213 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33214 available for use at delivery time.
33215
33216 .vlist
33217 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33218 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33219 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33220
33221 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33222 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33223 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33224 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33225 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33226
33227 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33228 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33229 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33230 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33231 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33232 spam bar is 50 characters.
33233
33234 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33235 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33236 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33237 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33238 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33239 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33240 unencoded in headers.
33241
33242 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33243 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33244 spam score versus threshold.
33245 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33246
33247 .endlist
33248
33249 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33250 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33251 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33252
33253 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33254 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33255 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33256 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33257 spam condition, like this:
33258 .code
33259 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33260 spam = joe/defer_ok
33261 .endd
33262 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33263
33264 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33265 condition:
33266 .code
33267 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33268 warn spam = nobody:true
33269 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33270 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33271
33272 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33273 # is over threshold
33274 warn spam = nobody
33275 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33276
33277 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33278 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33279 spam = nobody:true
33280 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33281 .endd
33282
33283
33284
33285 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33286 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33287 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33288 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33289 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33290 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33291 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33292 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33293 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33294 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33295 cases.
33296
33297 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33298 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33299 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33300 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33301 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33302 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33303 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33304
33305 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33306 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33307 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33308 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33309 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33310
33311 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33312 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33313 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33314 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33315 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33316 syntax is:
33317 .display
33318 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33319 .endd
33320 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33321 the value can be:
33322
33323 .olist
33324 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33325 .next
33326 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33327 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33328 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33329 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33330 .next
33331 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33332 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33333 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33334 the full path and filename.
33335 .next
33336 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33337 filename, and the default path is then used.
33338 .endlist
33339 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33340 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33341 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33342 .code
33343 decode = $mime_filename
33344 .endd
33345 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33346 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33347 automatically unlinked.
33348
33349 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33350 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33351 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33352 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33353 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33354
33355 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33356 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33357 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33358
33359 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33360 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33361 available in the MIME ACL:
33362
33363 .vlist
33364 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33365 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33366 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33367 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33368 contains the empty string.
33369
33370 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33371 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33372 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33373 .code
33374 us-ascii
33375 gb2312 (Chinese)
33376 iso-8859-1
33377 .endd
33378 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33379 case-insensitively.
33380
33381 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33382 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33383 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33384 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33385 only used for display purposes.
33386
33387 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33388 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33389 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33390
33391 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33392 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33393 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33394
33395 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33396 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33397 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33398 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33399 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33400
33401 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33402 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33403 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33404 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33405
33406 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33407 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33408 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33409 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33410 .code
33411 text/plain
33412 text/html
33413 application/octet-stream
33414 image/jpeg
33415 audio/midi
33416 .endd
33417 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33418 empty string.
33419
33420 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33421 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33422 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33423 containing the decoded data.
33424 .endlist
33425
33426 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33427 .vlist
33428 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33429 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33430 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33431 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33432 RFC2047
33433 or RFC2231
33434 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33435 If no filename was
33436 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33437
33438 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33439 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33440 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33441 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33442
33443 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33444 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33445 follows:
33446
33447 .olist
33448 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33449
33450 .next
33451 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33452 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33453
33454 .next
33455 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33456 and the rest are attachments.
33457
33458 .next
33459 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33460 .endlist olist
33461
33462 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33463 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33464 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33465 .code
33466 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33467 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33468 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33469 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33470 .endd
33471 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33472 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33473 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33474 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33475 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33476
33477 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33478 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33479 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33480 decoding is fully recursive.
33481
33482 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33483 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33484 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33485 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33486 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33487 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33488 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33489 .endlist
33490
33491
33492
33493 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33494 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33495 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33496 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33497 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33498
33499 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33500 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33501 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33502 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33503 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33504
33505 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33506 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33507 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33508 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33509 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33510 32K characters are checked.
33511
33512 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33513 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33514 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33515 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33516 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33517 .code
33518 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33519 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33520 .endd
33521 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33522 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33523 matching regular expression.
33524 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33525 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33526
33527 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33528 CPU-intensive.
33529
33530 .ecindex IIDcosca
33531
33532
33533
33534
33535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33537
33538 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33539 "Local scan function"
33540 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33541 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33542 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33543 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33544 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33545
33546 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33547 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33548 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33549 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33550 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33551
33552 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33553 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33554 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33555 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33556
33557 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33558 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33559 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33560 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33561
33562 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33563 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33564 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33565 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33566 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33567 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33568 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33569 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33570 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33571
33572
33573
33574 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33575 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33576 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33577 function is before building Exim, by setting
33578 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33579 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33580 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33581 directory, so you might set
33582 .code
33583 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33584 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33585 .endd
33586 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33587 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33588 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33589 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33590 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33591 _src/local_scan.c_.
33592
33593 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33594 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33595 .code
33596 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33597 .endd
33598 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33599
33600
33601
33602
33603 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33604 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33605 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33606 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33607 .code
33608 #include "local_scan.h"
33609 .endd
33610 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33611 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33612 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33613 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33614 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33615 strings and pointers to character strings:
33616 .code
33617 #define CS (char *)
33618 #define CCS (const char *)
33619 #define CSS (char **)
33620 #define US (unsigned char *)
33621 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33622 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33623 .endd
33624 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33625 .code
33626 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33627 .endd
33628 The arguments are as follows:
33629
33630 .ilist
33631 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33632 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33633 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33634
33635 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33636 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33637 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33638 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33639 case this changes in some future version.
33640 .next
33641 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33642 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33643 .endlist
33644
33645 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33646
33647 .vlist
33648 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33649 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33650 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33651 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33652 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33653 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33654
33655 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33656 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33657 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33658
33659 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33660 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33661 queued without immediate delivery.
33662
33663 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33664 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33665 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33666 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33667 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33668 used.
33669
33670 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33671 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33672 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33673 problem"& is used.
33674
33675 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33676 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33677 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33678 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33679 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33680 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33681 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33682
33683 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33684 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33685 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33686 .endlist
33687
33688 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33689 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33690 &%-oe%& command line options.
33691
33692
33693
33694 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33695 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33696 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33697 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33698 want to do this, you must have the line
33699 .code
33700 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33701 .endd
33702 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33703 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33704 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33705 to define them.
33706
33707 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33708 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33709 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33710 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33711 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33712 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33713 .code
33714 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33715 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33716
33717 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33718 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33719 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33720 };
33721
33722 int local_scan_options_count =
33723 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33724 .endd
33725 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33726 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33727 .code
33728 begin local_scan
33729 my_integer = 99
33730 my_string = some string of text...
33731 .endd
33732 The available types of option data are as follows:
33733
33734 .vlist
33735 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33736 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33737 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33738 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33739 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33740 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33741 values.)
33742
33743 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33744 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33745 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33746 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33747
33748 .vitem &*opt_int*&
33749 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33750 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33751 Exim.
33752
33753 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33754 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33755 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33756 printed with the suffix K or M.
33757
33758 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33759 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33760 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33761 always output in octal.
33762
33763 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33764 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33765 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33766
33767 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33768 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33769 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33770 .endlist
33771
33772 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33773 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33774
33775
33776
33777 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33778 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33779 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33780 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33781 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33782 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33783 C variables are as follows:
33784
33785 .vlist
33786 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33787 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33788 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33789
33790 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33791 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33792 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33793
33794 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33795 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33796 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33797 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33798
33799 .ilist
33800 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33801 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33802 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33803
33804 .next
33805 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33806 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33807 of debugging bits.
33808 .endlist ilist
33809
33810 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33811 selected, you should use code like this:
33812 .code
33813 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33814 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33815 .endd
33816 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33817 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33818 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33819
33820 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33821 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33822 discussed below.
33823
33824 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33825 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33826
33827 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33828 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33829
33830 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33831 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33832 &%-bh%& command line option.
33833
33834 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33835 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33836 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33837
33838 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33839 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33840 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33841 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33842
33843 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33844 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33845 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33846
33847 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33848 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33849
33850 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33851 The number of accepted recipients.
33852
33853 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33854 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33855 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33856 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33857 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33858 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33859 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33860 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33861 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33862 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33863 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33864 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33865
33866 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33867 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33868
33869 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33870 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33871 locally-submitted messages.
33872
33873 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33874 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33875 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33876
33877 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33878 The name of the sending host, if known.
33879
33880 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33881 The port on the sending host.
33882
33883 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33884 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33885
33886 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33887 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33888
33889 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33890 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33891 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33892 .endlist
33893
33894
33895 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33896 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33897 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33898 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33899 their type to *.
33900
33901
33902 .vlist
33903 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33904 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33905
33906 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33907 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33908 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33909 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33910 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33911 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33912 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33913
33914 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33915 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33916 internal newlines.
33917
33918 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33919 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33920 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33921 .endlist
33922
33923
33924
33925 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33926 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33927
33928 .vlist
33929 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33930 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33931
33932 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33933 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33934 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33935 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33936
33937 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33938 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33939 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33940 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33941 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33942 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33943 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33944 is NULL for all recipients.
33945 .endlist
33946
33947
33948
33949 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33950 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33951 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33952 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33953 release:
33954
33955 .vlist
33956 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33957 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33958
33959 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33960 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33961 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33962 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33963
33964 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33965 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33966 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33967 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33968 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33969
33970 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33971
33972 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33973 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33974 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33975 return value is as follows:
33976
33977 .ilist
33978 >= 0
33979
33980 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33981 ending status.
33982
33983 .next
33984 < 0 and > &--256
33985
33986 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33987 signal number.
33988
33989 .next
33990 &--256
33991
33992 The process timed out.
33993 .next
33994 &--257
33995
33996 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33997 .endlist
33998
33999 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34000 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34001 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34002 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34003 forks a subprocess that is running
34004 .code
34005 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34006 .endd
34007 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34008 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34009 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34010 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34011
34012 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34013 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34014 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34015 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34016
34017
34018 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34019 *sender_authentication)*&
34020 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34021 that it runs is:
34022 .display
34023 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34024 .endd
34025 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34026
34027
34028 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34029 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34030 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34031 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34032 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34033 .code
34034 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34035 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34036 .endd
34037
34038 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34039 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34040 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34041 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34042 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34043 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34044 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34045 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34046
34047 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34048 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34049 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34050 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34051 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34052 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34053
34054 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34055 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34056 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34057 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34058
34059 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34060 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34061 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34062 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34063 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34064 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34065 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34066 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34067 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34068 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34069 .code
34070 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34071 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34072 .endd
34073 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34074 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34075
34076
34077 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34078 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34079 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34080 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34081 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34082
34083
34084 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34085 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34086 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34087 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34088 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34089 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34090 .code
34091 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34092 .endd
34093 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34094 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34095 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34096 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34097 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34098 zero-terminated.
34099
34100 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34101 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34102 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34103 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34104 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34105 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34106 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34107 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34108
34109 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34110 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34111 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34112 .display
34113 &`OK `& match succeeded
34114 &`FAIL `& match failed
34115 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34116 .endd
34117 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34118 inability to contact a database.
34119
34120 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34121 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34122 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34123 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34124 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34125
34126 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34127 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34128 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34129 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34130 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34131
34132 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34133 uschar&~*list)*&"
34134 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34135 expected to be
34136 .code
34137 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34138 .endd
34139 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34140 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34141 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34142 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34143 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34144 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34145 failed.
34146
34147 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34148 *format,&~...)*&"
34149 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34150 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34151 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34152 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34153 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34154 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34155
34156
34157 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34158 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34159 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34160 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34161
34162 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34163 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34164 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34165 value afterwards. For example:
34166 .code
34167 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34168 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34169 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34170 .endd
34171
34172 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34173 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34174 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34175 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34176 address.
34177 .endlist
34178
34179
34180 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34181 .vlist
34182 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34183 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34184 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34185 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34186 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34187 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34188 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34189 binary string is returned with an error message.
34190
34191 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34192 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34193 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34194
34195 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34196 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34197 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34198 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34199 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34200
34201 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34202 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34203 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34204
34205 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34206 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34207 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34208 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34209 with translation.
34210
34211
34212 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34213 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34214 below.
34215
34216 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34217 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34218 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34219 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34220 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34221 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34222 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34223 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34224 is involved.
34225
34226 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34227 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34228
34229 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34230 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34231 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34232 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34233 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34234 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34235 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34236 .code
34237 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34238 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34239 .endd
34240 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34241 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34242 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34243 multiple output lines.
34244
34245 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34246 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34247 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34248 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34249 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34250 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34251 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34252 is an error.
34253
34254 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34255 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34256 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34257 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34258
34259 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34260 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34261 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34262
34263 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34264 See below.
34265
34266 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34267 See below.
34268
34269 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34270 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34271 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34272 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34273 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34274 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34275 more discussion.
34276 .endlist
34277
34278
34279
34280 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34281 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34282 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34283 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34284 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34285 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34286 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34287 terminates.
34288
34289 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34290 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34291 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34292 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34293
34294 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34295 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34296 .code
34297 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34298 .endd
34299 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34300 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34301 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34302 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34303
34304 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34305 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34306 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34307 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34308 &%store_pool%&.
34309 .ecindex IIDlosca
34310
34311
34312
34313
34314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34315 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34316
34317 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34318 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34319 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34320 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34321 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34322 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34323 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34324 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34325
34326 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34327 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34328 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34329 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34330 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34331
34332 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34333 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34334 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34335 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34336 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34337 prevent it happening on retries.
34338
34339 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34340 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34341 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34342 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34343 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34344 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34345 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34346 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34347
34348
34349 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34350 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34351 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34352 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34353 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34354 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34355 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34356 .code
34357 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34358 system_filter_user = exim
34359 .endd
34360 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34361 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34362 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34363 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34364 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34365 by the &%reply%& command.
34366
34367
34368 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34369 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34370 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34371 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34372
34373 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34374 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34375
34376
34377
34378 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34379 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34380 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34381 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34382 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34383 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34384 they cause errors.
34385
34386 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34387 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34388 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34389 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34390 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34391 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34392 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34393
34394 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34395 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34396 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34397 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34398 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34399
34400 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34401 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34402 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34403 to which users' filter files can refer.
34404
34405
34406
34407 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34408 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34409 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34410 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34411 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34412
34413
34414
34415 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34416 .cindex "freezing messages"
34417 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34418 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34419 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34420 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34421 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34422 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34423 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34424 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34425 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34426 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34427 .code
34428 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34429 .endd
34430 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34431
34432 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34433 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34434 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34435 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34436 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34437 run.
34438
34439 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34440 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34441 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34442 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34443
34444 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34445 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34446 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34447 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34448 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34449 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34450 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34451 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34452 message. For example:
34453 .code
34454 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34455 because it contains attachments that we are \
34456 not prepared to receive."
34457 .endd
34458
34459 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34460 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34461 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34462 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34463 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34464 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34465 use, for example
34466 .code
34467 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34468 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34469 .endd
34470 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34471 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34472 generated by the filter.
34473
34474 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34475 &%defer%&,
34476 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34477 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34478 as
34479 .code
34480 mail ...
34481 freeze
34482 .endd
34483 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34484 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34485 take place.
34486
34487
34488
34489 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34490 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34491 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34492 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34493 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34494 .code
34495 headers add <string>
34496 headers remove <string>
34497 .endd
34498 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34499 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34500 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34501 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34502 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34503
34504 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34505 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34506 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34507 example:
34508 .code
34509 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34510 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34511 X-header-2: ...."
34512 .endd
34513 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34514 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34515 space after input continuations is ignored.
34516
34517 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34518 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34519 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34520 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34521 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34522
34523 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34524 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34525 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34526 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34527 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34528 used for all recipients of the message.
34529
34530 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34531 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34532 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34533 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34534 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34535 until the message is actually being written (see section
34536 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34537
34538 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34539 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34540 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34541 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34542 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34543 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34544 modified more than once.
34545
34546 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34547 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34548 For example:
34549 .code
34550 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34551 headers remove "Subject"
34552 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34553 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34554 .endd
34555
34556
34557
34558 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34559 .cindex "envelope from"
34560 .cindex "envelope sender"
34561 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34562 .code
34563 errors_to <some address>
34564 .endd
34565 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34566 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34567 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34568 might use
34569 .code
34570 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34571 .endd
34572 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34573 address if its delivery failed.
34574
34575
34576
34577 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34578 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34579 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34580 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34581 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34582 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34583 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34584 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34585 which implements such a filter:
34586 .code
34587 central_filter:
34588 check_local_user
34589 driver = redirect
34590 domains = +local_domains
34591 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34592 no_verify
34593 allow_filter
34594 allow_freeze
34595 .endd
34596 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34597 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34598 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34599 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34600
34601 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34602 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34603 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34604 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34605 normal way.
34606 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34607 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34608 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34609
34610
34611
34612
34613
34614
34615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34617
34618 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34619 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34620 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34621 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34622 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34623 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34624 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34625 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34626
34627 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34628 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34629 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34630 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34631 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34632
34633 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34634 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34635 loopback interface specially in any way.
34636
34637 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34638 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34639
34640
34641
34642
34643 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34644 .cindex "message" "submission"
34645 .cindex "submission mode"
34646 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34647 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34648 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34649 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34650 .code
34651 control = submission
34652 .endd
34653 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34654 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34655 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34656 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34657 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34658 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34659 .code
34660 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34661 control = submission
34662 .endd
34663 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34664 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34665 is used to separate options. For example:
34666 .code
34667 control = submission/sender_retain
34668 .endd
34669 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34670 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34671 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34672 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34673 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34674 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34675 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34676
34677 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34678 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34679 example:
34680 .code
34681 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34682 .endd
34683 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34684 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34685 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34686 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34687 .code
34688 accept authenticated = *
34689 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34690 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34691 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34692 .endd
34693 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34694 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34695 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34696 .code
34697 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34698 .endd
34699 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34700 line would be:
34701 .code
34702 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34703 .endd
34704 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34705 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34706 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34707 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34708
34709 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34710 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34711 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34712 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34713 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34714 spoof another's address.
34715
34716 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34717 .cindex "line endings"
34718 .cindex "carriage return"
34719 .cindex "linefeed"
34720 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34721 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34722 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34723 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34724 use CRLF or just CR.
34725
34726 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34727 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34728 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34729 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34730 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34731 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34732 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34733 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34734 follows:
34735
34736 .ilist
34737 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34738 .next
34739 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34740 is ignored.
34741 .next
34742 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34743 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34744 terminator.
34745 .next
34746 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34747 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34748 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34749 people trying to play silly games.
34750 .next
34751 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34752 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34753 line.
34754 .endlist
34755
34756
34757
34758
34759
34760 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34761 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34762 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34763 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34764 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34765 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34766 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34767 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34768
34769 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34770 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34771 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34772 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34773 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34774
34775 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34776 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34777 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34778 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34779 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34780 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34781 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34782 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34783
34784
34785
34786
34787 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34788 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34789 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34790 .cindex "sender" "address"
34791 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34792 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34793 .cindex "envelope from"
34794 .cindex "envelope sender"
34795 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34796 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34797 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34798 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34799 .code
34800 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34801 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34802 .endd
34803 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34804 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34805 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34806 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34807 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34808 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34809 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34810 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34811 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34812
34813 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34814 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34815 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34816 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34817 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34818 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34819 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34820
34821 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34822 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34823 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34824
34825 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34826 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34827 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34828 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34829
34830
34831
34832 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34833 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34834 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34835 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34836 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34837 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34838 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34839 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34840
34841 .blockquote
34842 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34843 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34844 .endblockquote
34845
34846 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34847 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34848 follows:
34849
34850 .ilist
34851 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34852 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34853 .next
34854 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34855 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34856 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34857 .next
34858 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34859 also removed.
34860 .next
34861 For a locally-submitted message,
34862 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34863 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34864 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34865 included in log lines in this case.
34866 .next
34867 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34868 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34869 .endlist
34870
34871
34872
34873
34874 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34875 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34876 includes the header line:
34877 .code
34878 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34879 .endd
34880
34881 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34882 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34883 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34884 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34885 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34886 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34887
34888
34889 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34890 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34891 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34892 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34893 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34894 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34895
34896 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34897 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34898 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34899 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34900 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34901 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34902 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34903 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34904 messages.
34905
34906
34907 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34908 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34909 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34910 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34911 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34912 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34913 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34914 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34915 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34916 messages.
34917
34918
34919 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34920 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34921 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34922 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34923 .cindex "message" "submission"
34924 .cindex "submission mode"
34925 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34926 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34927
34928 .ilist
34929 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34930 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34931 .next
34932 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34933 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34934 .olist
34935 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34936 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34937 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34938 .next
34939 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34940 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34941 .next
34942 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34943 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34944 .endlist
34945 .endlist
34946
34947 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34948
34949 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34950 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34951 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34952 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34953 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34954 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34955 &%qualify_domain%&.
34956
34957 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34958 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34959 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34960 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34961
34962
34963 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34964 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34965 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34966 .cindex "message" "submission"
34967 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34968 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34969 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34970 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34971 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34972 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34973 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34974 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34975 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34976 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34977
34978
34979 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34980 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34981 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34982 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34983 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34984 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34985
34986 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34987 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34988 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34989 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34990
34991 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34992 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34993 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34994
34995
34996 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34997 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34998 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34999 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35000 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35001 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35002 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35003 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35004 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35005 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35006 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35007 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35008
35009
35010
35011 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35012 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35013 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35014 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35015 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35016 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35017 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35018 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35019 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35020
35021
35022
35023 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35024 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35025 .cindex "message" "submission"
35026 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35027 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35028 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35029 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35030 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35031 control setting.
35032
35033 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35034 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35035 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35036 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35037 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35038 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35039 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35040 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35041 line is added to the message.
35042
35043 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35044 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35045 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35046 options true at the same time.
35047
35048 .cindex "submission mode"
35049 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35050 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35051 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35052 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35053
35054 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35055 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35056 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35057 created as follows:
35058
35059 .ilist
35060 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35061 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35062 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35063 .next
35064 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35065 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35066 .next
35067 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35068 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35069 .endlist
35070
35071 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35072 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35073 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35074 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35075
35076 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35077 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35078 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35079 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35080
35081
35082
35083 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35084 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35085 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35086 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35087 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35088 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35089 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35090 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35091 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35092
35093 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35094 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35095 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35096 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35097 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35098 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35099
35100 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35101 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35102 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35103
35104 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35105 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35106 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35107 .code
35108 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35109 X-added-second: another added header line
35110 .endd
35111 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35112
35113 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35114 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35115 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35116
35117 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35118 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35119 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35120 not part of the names. For example:
35121 .code
35122 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35123 .endd
35124
35125 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35126 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35127 Each item is separately expanded.
35128 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35129 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35130 will act as list separators.
35131
35132 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35133 items are expanded at routing time,
35134 and then associated with all addresses that are
35135 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35136 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35137 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35138
35139 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35140 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35141 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35142 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35143
35144 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35145 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35146 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35147 requirements.
35148
35149 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35150 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35151 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35152 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35153 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35154 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35155 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35156
35157 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35158 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35159 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35160 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35161
35162 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35163 the following consequences:
35164
35165 .ilist
35166 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35167 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35168 to it, at all times.
35169 .next
35170 Header lines that are added by a router's
35171 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35172 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35173 .next
35174 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35175 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35176 .next
35177 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35178 a later router or by a transport.
35179 .next
35180 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35181 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35182 .code
35183 headers_remove = subject
35184 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35185 .endd
35186 .endlist
35187
35188 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35189 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35190
35191
35192
35193
35194
35195 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35196 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35197 .cindex "constructed address"
35198 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35199 the form
35200 .display
35201 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35202 .endd
35203 For example:
35204 .code
35205 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35206 .endd
35207 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35208 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35209 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35210 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35211 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35212 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35213 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35214 there is no password file entry.
35215
35216 .cindex "RFC 2047"
35217 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35218 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35219 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35220 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35221 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35222 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35223 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35224 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35225
35226
35227
35228 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35229 .cindex "case of local parts"
35230 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35231 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35232 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35233 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35234 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35235 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35236 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35237 router option.
35238
35239 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35240 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35241 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35242 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35243 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35244 .code
35245 correct_case:
35246 driver = redirect
35247 domains = +local_domains
35248 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35249 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35250 @$domain
35251 .endd
35252 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35253 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35254 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35255 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35256 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35257
35258
35259
35260 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35261 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35262 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35263 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35264 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35265 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35266 empty components for compatibility.
35267
35268
35269
35270 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35271 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35272 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35273 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35274 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35275 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35276
35277 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35278 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35279 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35280 example, a header such as
35281 .code
35282 To: hare@teaparty
35283 .endd
35284 might get rewritten as
35285 .code
35286 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35287 .endd
35288 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35289 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35290 been routed.
35291
35292 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35293 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35294 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35295 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35296 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35297 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35298 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35299
35300
35301
35302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35303 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35304
35305 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35306 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35307 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35308 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35309 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35310 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35311 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35312
35313 .ilist
35314 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35315 .next
35316 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35317 .next
35318 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35319 .endlist
35320
35321 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35322
35323 .ilist
35324 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35325 .next
35326 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35327 &"lmtp"&);
35328 .next
35329 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35330 transport);
35331 .next
35332 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35333 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35334 .endlist
35335
35336 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35337 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35338 used to contain the envelope information.
35339
35340
35341
35342 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35343 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35344 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35345 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35346 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35347 .cindex "EHLO"
35348 .cindex "HELO"
35349 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35350 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35351 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35352 processing is the same in both cases.
35353
35354 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35355 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35356 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35357 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35358 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35359 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35360 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35361 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35362 suppressed.
35363
35364 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35365 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35366 required for the transaction.
35367
35368 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35369 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35370 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35371 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35372 is called for verification.
35373
35374 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35375 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35376 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35377
35378 .cindex "carriage return"
35379 .cindex "linefeed"
35380 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35381 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35382 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35383 line terminator.
35384
35385 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35386 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35387 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35388 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35389 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35390 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35391 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35392 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35393 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35394
35395 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35396 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35397 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35398 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35399
35400 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35401 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35402 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35403 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35404
35405 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35406 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35407 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35408 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35409 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35410 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35411 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35412 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35413 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35414 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35415
35416 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35417 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35418
35419 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35420 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35421 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35422 square bracket of the IP address.
35423
35424
35425
35426
35427 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35428 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35429 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35430 .cindex "host" "error"
35431 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35432 message errors, and recipient errors.
35433
35434 .vlist
35435 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35436 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35437 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35438
35439 .ilist
35440 Connection refused or timed out,
35441 .next
35442 Any error response code on connection,
35443 .next
35444 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35445 .next
35446 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35447 .next
35448 I/O errors at any time,
35449 .next
35450 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35451 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35452 .endlist ilist
35453
35454 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35455 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35456 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35457 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35458 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35459 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35460 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35461 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35462
35463 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35464 .cindex "message" "error"
35465 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35466 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35467 message errors are:
35468
35469 .ilist
35470 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35471 the data,
35472 .next
35473 Timeout after MAIL,
35474 .next
35475 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35476 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35477 connection at any other time.
35478 .endlist ilist
35479
35480 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35481 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35482 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35483 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35484 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35485 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35486 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35487 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35488 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35489 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35490
35491 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35492 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35493 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35494 response to MAIL.
35495
35496 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35497 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35498 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35499 recipient errors are:
35500
35501 .ilist
35502 Any error response to RCPT,
35503 .next
35504 Timeout after RCPT.
35505 .endlist
35506
35507 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35508 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35509 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35510 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35511 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35512 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35513 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35514 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35515 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35516 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35517 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35518 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35519 the retry clock is reset.
35520
35521 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35522 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35523 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35524 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35525 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35526 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35527 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35528 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35529 recipient's retry time.
35530 .endlist
35531
35532 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35533 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35534 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35535 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35536 until the next delivery attempt.
35537
35538 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35539 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35540 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35541 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35542 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35543 is created.
35544
35545 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35546 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35547 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35548 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35549 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35550 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35551 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35552
35553 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35554 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35555 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35556 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35557 then to be treated as a host error.
35558
35559 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35560 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35561 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35562 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35563 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35564
35565
35566
35567
35568 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35569 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35570 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35571 .cindex "inetd"
35572 .cindex "daemon"
35573 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35574 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35575 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35576 .code
35577 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35578 .endd
35579 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35580 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35581 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35582 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35583 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35584 stream and exits with an error code.
35585
35586 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35587 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35588 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35589 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35590
35591 .cindex "carriage return"
35592 .cindex "linefeed"
35593 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35594 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35595 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35596 line terminator.
35597 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35598 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35599 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35600
35601 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35602 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35603 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35604 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35605 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35606 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35607 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35608 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35609
35610 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35611 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35612 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35613 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35614 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35615 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35616 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35617 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35618 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35619
35620 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35621 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35622 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35623
35624 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35625 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35626 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35627 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35628 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35629
35630 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35631 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35632 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35633 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35634 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35635 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35636 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35637
35638 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35639 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35640 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35641 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35642 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35643
35644 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35645 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35646 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35647 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35648 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35649 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35650 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35651 a delivery process.
35652
35653 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35654 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35655 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35656 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35657 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35658
35659 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35660 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35661 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35662 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35663
35664 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35665 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35666 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35667
35668
35669
35670 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35671 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35672 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35673 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35674 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35675 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35676 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35677 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35678
35679
35680 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35681 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35682 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35683 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35684 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35685 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35686 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35687 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35688 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35689 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35690 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35691
35692
35693
35694 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35695 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35696 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35697 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35698 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35699 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35700 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35701 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35702
35703 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35704 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35705 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35706 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35707 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35708 counted.
35709
35710 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35711 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35712 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35713
35714 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35715 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35716 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35717 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35718 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35719
35720
35721
35722
35723 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35724 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35725 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35726 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35727
35728 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35729 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35730 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35731 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35732 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35733 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35734 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35735 SMTP response codes.
35736
35737 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35738 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35739 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35740 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35741 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35742 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35743 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35744 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35745 RCPT failures.
35746
35747
35748
35749 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35750 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35751 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35752 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35753 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35754 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35755 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35756
35757 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35758 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35759 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35760 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35761 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35762 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35763 argument. For example,
35764 .code
35765 ETRN #brigadoon
35766 .endd
35767 runs the command
35768 .code
35769 exim -R brigadoon
35770 .endd
35771 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35772 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35773 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35774 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35775 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35776
35777 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35778 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35779 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35780 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35781 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35782 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35783 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35784 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35785
35786 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35787 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35788 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35789 whatever the form of its argument. For
35790 example:
35791 .code
35792 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35793 $sender_host_address
35794 .endd
35795 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35796 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35797 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35798 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35799 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35800 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35801 for it to change them before running the command.
35802
35803
35804
35805 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35806 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35807 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35808 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35809 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35810 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35811 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35812 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35813 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35814 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35815 runs for RCPT commands:
35816 .code
35817 accept hosts = :
35818 .endd
35819 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35820
35821
35822
35823 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35824 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35825 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35826 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35827 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35828 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35829 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35830 envelope along with the message.
35831
35832 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35833 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35834 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35835 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35836 can be used to specify it.
35837
35838 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35839 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35840 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35841 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35842 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35843
35844 .vindex "&$host$&"
35845 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35846 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35847 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35848 router:
35849 .code
35850 begin routers
35851 route_append:
35852 driver = manualroute
35853 transport = smtp_appendfile
35854 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35855
35856 begin transports
35857 smtp_appendfile:
35858 driver = appendfile
35859 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35860 batch_max = 1000
35861 use_bsmtp
35862 user = exim
35863 .endd
35864 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35865 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35866 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35867
35868
35869
35870 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35871 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35872 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35873 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35874 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35875 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35876 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35877 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35878 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35879 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35880
35881 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35882 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35883
35884 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35885 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35886 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35887 make some use of automatically, for example:
35888 .code
35889 554 Unexpected end of file
35890 Transaction started in line 10
35891 Error detected in line 14
35892 .endd
35893 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35894 file, for example:
35895 .code
35896 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35897 The error message was:
35898
35899 501 '>' missing at end of address
35900
35901 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35902 The error was detected in line 12.
35903 The SMTP command at fault was:
35904
35905 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35906
35907 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35908 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35909 .endd
35910 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35911 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35912 accepted.
35913 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35914 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35915
35916
35917
35918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35920
35921 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35922 "Customizing messages"
35923 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35924 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35925 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35926 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35927 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35928
35929 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35930 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35931 option. Exim also adds the line
35932 .code
35933 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35934 .endd
35935 to all warning and bounce messages,
35936
35937
35938 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35939 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35940 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35941 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35942 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35943 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35944 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35945
35946 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35947 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35948 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35949 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35950 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35951 item.
35952
35953 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35954 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35955 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35956 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35957 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35958 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35959 option, rounded to a whole number.
35960
35961 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35962
35963 .ilist
35964 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35965 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35966 .next
35967 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35968 failing addresses with their error messages.
35969 .next
35970 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35971 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35972 .next
35973 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35974 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35975 .endlist
35976
35977 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35978 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35979 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35980 .code
35981 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35982 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35983 {: returning message to sender}}
35984 ****
35985 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35986
35987 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35988 {that you sent }{sent by
35989
35990 <$sender_address>
35991
35992 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35993 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35994 ****
35995 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35996 ****
35997 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35998 ------
35999 ****
36000 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36001 only the first
36002 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36003 ****
36004 .endd
36005 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36006 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36007 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36008 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36009 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36010 text sections:
36011
36012 .ilist
36013 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36014 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36015 .next
36016 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36017 the delayed addresses.
36018 .next
36019 The third item then ends the message.
36020 .endlist
36021
36022 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36023 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36024 .code
36025 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36026 $warn_message_delay
36027 ****
36028 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36029
36030 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36031 {that you sent }{sent by
36032
36033 <$sender_address>
36034
36035 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36036 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36037
36038 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36039 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36040 The date of the message is: $h_date
36041
36042 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36043 ****
36044 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36045 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36046 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36047 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36048 the message will be returned to you.
36049 .endd
36050 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36051 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36052 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36053 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36054 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36055 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36056 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36057 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36058 handled them.
36059
36060
36061
36062
36063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36064 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36065
36066 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36067 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36068 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36069
36070
36071
36072 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36073 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36074 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36075 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36076 routing explicitly:
36077 .code
36078 send_to_smart_host:
36079 driver = manualroute
36080 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36081 transport = remote_smtp
36082 .endd
36083 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36084 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36085 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36086 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36087 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36088
36089
36090
36091
36092 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36093 .cindex "mailing lists"
36094 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36095 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36096 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36097
36098 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36099 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36100 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36101 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36102 .code
36103 lists:
36104 driver = redirect
36105 domains = lists.example
36106 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36107 forbid_pipe
36108 forbid_file
36109 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36110 no_more
36111 .endd
36112 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36113 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36114 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36115 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36116
36117 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36118 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36119 a mailing list.
36120
36121 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36122 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36123 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36124 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36125 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36126
36127 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36128 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36129 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36130 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36131 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36132 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36133 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36134 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36135 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36136
36137
36138
36139 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36140 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36141 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36142 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36143 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36144 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36145 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36146
36147 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36148 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36149 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36150 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36151 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36152
36153
36154
36155 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36156 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36157 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36158 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36159 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36160 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36161 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36162 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36163 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36164 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36165
36166 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36167 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36168 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36169 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36170 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36171 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36172 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36173 pre-existing messages.
36174
36175 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36176 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36177 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36178 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36179 one level of expansion anyway.
36180
36181
36182
36183 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36184 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36185 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36186 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36187 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36188 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36189
36190 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36191 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36192 .code
36193 lists_request:
36194 driver = redirect
36195 domains = lists.example
36196 local_part_suffix = -request
36197 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36198 no_more
36199
36200 lists_post:
36201 driver = redirect
36202 domains = lists.example
36203 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36204 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36205 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36206 forbid_pipe
36207 forbid_file
36208 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36209 no_more
36210
36211 lists_closed:
36212 driver = redirect
36213 domains = lists.example
36214 allow_fail
36215 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36216 .endd
36217 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36218 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36219 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36220 mailing list.
36221
36222 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36223 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36224 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36225 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36226 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36227 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36228 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36229 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36230 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36231
36232 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36233 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36234 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36235
36236
36237
36238
36239 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36240 .cindex "VERP"
36241 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36242 .cindex "envelope from"
36243 .cindex "envelope sender"
36244 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36245 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36246 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36247 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36248 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36249 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36250
36251 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36252 .oindex &%return_path%&
36253 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36254 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36255 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36256 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36257 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36258 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36259 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36260 .code
36261 verp_smtp:
36262 driver = smtp
36263 max_rcpt = 1
36264 return_path = \
36265 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36266 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36267 .endd
36268 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36269 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36270 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36271 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36272 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36273 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36274 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36275 rewritten as
36276 .code
36277 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36278 .endd
36279 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36280 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36281 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36282 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36283 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36284 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36285
36286 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36287 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36288 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36289 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36290 .code
36291 dnslookup:
36292 driver = dnslookup
36293 domains = ! +local_domains
36294 transport = \
36295 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36296 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36297 no_more
36298 .endd
36299 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36300 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36301 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36302 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36303 address.
36304
36305 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36306 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36307 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36308 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36309 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36310 .code
36311 verp_dnslookup:
36312 driver = dnslookup
36313 domains = ! +local_domains
36314 transport = remote_smtp
36315 errors_to = \
36316 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36317 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36318 no_more
36319 .endd
36320 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36321 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36322 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36323 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36324 them.
36325
36326 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36327 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36328 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36329 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36330 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36331 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36332 used).
36333
36334
36335
36336
36337
36338
36339 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36340 .cindex "virtual domains"
36341 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36342 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36343 meanings:
36344
36345 .ilist
36346 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36347 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36348 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36349 .next
36350 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36351 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36352 have login accounts on that host.
36353 .endlist
36354
36355 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36356 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36357 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36358 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36359 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36360 to a router of this form:
36361 .code
36362 virtual:
36363 driver = redirect
36364 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36365 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36366 no_more
36367 .endd
36368 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36369 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36370 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36371 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36372 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36373 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36374
36375 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36376 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36377 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36378 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36379
36380 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36381 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36382 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36383 .code
36384 my_domains:
36385 driver = accept
36386 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36387 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36388 transport = my_mailboxes
36389 .endd
36390 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36391 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36392 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36393 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36394 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36395 follows:
36396 .code
36397 my_mailboxes:
36398 driver = appendfile
36399 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36400 user = mail
36401 .endd
36402 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36403 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36404
36405 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36406 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36407 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36408 information about the domains.
36409
36410
36411
36412 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36413 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36414 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36415 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36416 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36417 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36418 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36419 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36420 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36421 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36422 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36423 example, consider this router:
36424 .code
36425 userforward:
36426 driver = redirect
36427 check_local_user
36428 file = $home/.forward
36429 local_part_suffix = -*
36430 local_part_suffix_optional
36431 allow_filter
36432 .endd
36433 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36434 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36435 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36436 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36437 .code
36438 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36439 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36440 endif
36441 .endd
36442 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36443 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36444 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36445 control over which suffixes are valid.
36446
36447 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36448 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36449 another MTA:
36450 .code
36451 userforward:
36452 driver = redirect
36453 check_local_user
36454 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36455 local_part_suffix = -*
36456 local_part_suffix_optional
36457 allow_filter
36458 .endd
36459 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36460 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36461 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36462 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36463 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36464
36465
36466
36467 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36468 .cindex "vacation processing"
36469 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36470 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36471 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36472 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36473 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36474
36475 .ilist
36476 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36477 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36478 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36479 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36480 .code
36481 spqr, vacation-spqr
36482 .endd
36483 .next
36484 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36485 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36486 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36487 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36488 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36489 message.
36490 .endlist
36491
36492 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36493 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36494
36495
36496
36497 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36498 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36499 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36500 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36501 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36502 each day's messages.
36503
36504 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36505 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36506 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36507 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36508
36509
36510
36511 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36512 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36513 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36514 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36515 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36516 permanently connected.
36517
36518 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36519 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36520 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36521
36522
36523 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36524 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36525 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36526 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36527 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36528 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36529 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36530 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36531
36532 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36533 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36534 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36535 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36536 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36537 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36538 if required.
36539
36540 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36541 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36542 intermittent host. For example:
36543 .code
36544 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36545 .endd
36546 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36547 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36548 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36549 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36550 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36551 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36552 immediately.
36553
36554 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36555 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36556 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36557 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36558 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36559 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36560 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36561
36562
36563
36564 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36565 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36566 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36567 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36568 delivered immediately.
36569
36570 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36571 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36572 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36573 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36574 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36575 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36576 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36577 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36578 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36579 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36580 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36581 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36582 single SMTP connection.
36583
36584
36585
36586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36588
36589 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36590 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36591 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36592 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36593 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36594 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36595 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36596 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36597 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36598 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36599 messages this way.
36600
36601 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36602 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36603 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36604 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36605 email is not desirable.
36606
36607 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36608 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36609 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36610 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36611 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36612 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36613 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36614
36615 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36616 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36617 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36618 before sending a message to the smart host.
36619
36620 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36621 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36622 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36623
36624 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36625 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36626 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36627 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36628 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36629 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36630 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36631
36632 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36633 following ways:
36634
36635 .ilist
36636 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36637 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36638 .next
36639 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36640 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36641 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36642 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36643 successful, a zero return code is given.
36644 .next
36645 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36646 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36647 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36648 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36649 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36650 are.
36651 .next
36652 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36653 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36654 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36655 .next
36656 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36657 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36658 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36659 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36660 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36661 .next
36662 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36663 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36664 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36665 .next
36666 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36667 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36668 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36669 are ever generated.
36670 .next
36671 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36672 .next
36673 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36674 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36675 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36676 .endlist
36677
36678 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36679 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36680 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36681 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36682 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36683 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36684
36685
36686
36687
36688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36690
36691 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36692 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36693 .cindex "log" "types of"
36694 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36695 and the panic log:
36696
36697 .ilist
36698 .cindex "main log"
36699 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36700 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36701 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36702 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36703 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36704 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36705 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36706 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36707 .next
36708 .cindex "reject log"
36709 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36710 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36711 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36712 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36713 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36714 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36715 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36716 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36717 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36718 false.
36719 .next
36720 .cindex "panic log"
36721 .cindex "system log"
36722 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36723 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36724 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36725 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36726 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36727 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36728 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36729 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36730 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36731 .endlist
36732
36733 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36734 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36735 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36736 .code
36737 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36738 by QUIT
36739 .endd
36740 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36741 ways of changing this:
36742
36743 .ilist
36744 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36745 you set
36746 .code
36747 timezone = UTC
36748 .endd
36749 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36750 .next
36751 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36752 example:
36753 .code
36754 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36755 .endd
36756 .endlist
36757
36758 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36759 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36760 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36761 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36762 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36763 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36764
36765
36766
36767
36768 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36769 .cindex "log" "destination"
36770 .cindex "log" "to file"
36771 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36772 .cindex "syslog"
36773 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36774 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36775 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36776 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36777 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36778 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36779 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36780
36781 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36782 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36783 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36784 references to the host name:
36785 .code
36786 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36787 .endd
36788 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36789 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36790 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36791 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36792 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36793 log at all.
36794
36795 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36796 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36797 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36798 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36799 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36800 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36801 implying the use of a default path.
36802
36803 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36804 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36805 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36806 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36807 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36808 equivalent to the setting:
36809 .code
36810 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36811 .endd
36812 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36813 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36814 that is where the logs are written.
36815
36816 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36817 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36818
36819 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36820 .display
36821 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36822 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36823 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36824 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36825 .endd
36826 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36827 error is logged.
36828
36829
36830
36831 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36832 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36833 .cindex "cycling logs"
36834 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36835 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36836 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36837 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36838 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36839 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36840 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36841
36842 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36843 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36844 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36845 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36846 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36847 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36848 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36849 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36850 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36851 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36852 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36853 renamed.
36854
36855
36856
36857 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36858 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36859 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36860 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36861 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36862 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36863 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36864 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36865 .code
36866 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36867 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36868 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36869 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36870 .endd
36871 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36872 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36873 .code
36874 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36875 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36876 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36877 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36878 .endd
36879 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36880 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36881 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36882 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36883
36884 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36885 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36886 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36887 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36888 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36889 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36890 log names:
36891 .code
36892 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36893 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36894 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36895 /var/log/exim/panic
36896 .endd
36897
36898
36899 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36900 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36901 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36902 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36903 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36904 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36905 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36906 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36907 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36908 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36909 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36910 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36911 the time and host name to each line.
36912 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36913
36914 .ilist
36915 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36916 .next
36917 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36918 .next
36919 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36920 .endlist
36921
36922 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36923 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36924 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36925 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36926
36927 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36928 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36929 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36930 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36931 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36932 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36933 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36934 RFC 3164, you should set
36935 .code
36936 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36937 .endd
36938 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36939 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36940
36941 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36942 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36943 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36944 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36945 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36946 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36947 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36948 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36949 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36950 .code
36951 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36952 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36953 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36954 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36955 [5/5] mple>)
36956 .endd
36957 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36958 (LOG_NOTICE):
36959 .code
36960 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36961 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36962 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36963 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36964 [5\18] .example>)
36965 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36966 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36967 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36968 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36969 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36970 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36971 [12\18] F From: <>
36972 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36973 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36974 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36975 [16\18] le>
36976 [17\18] B Bcc:
36977 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36978 .endd
36979 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36980 without modification.
36981
36982 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36983 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36984 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36985 where it is.
36986
36987
36988
36989 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36990 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36991 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36992 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36993 timestamp. The flags are:
36994 .display
36995 &`<=`& message arrival
36996 &`(=`& message fakereject
36997 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36998 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36999 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37000 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37001 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37002 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37003 .endd
37004
37005
37006 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37007 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37008 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37009 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37010 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37011 .code
37012 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37013 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37014 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37015 .endd
37016 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37017 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37018 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37019 .code
37020 R=<message id>
37021 .endd
37022 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37023
37024 .cindex "HELO"
37025 .cindex "EHLO"
37026 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37027 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37028 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37029 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37030 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37031 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37032 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37033 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37034 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37035 name in parentheses.
37036
37037 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37038 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37039 the log containing text like these examples:
37040 .code
37041 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37042 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37043 .endd
37044 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37045 on.
37046
37047 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37048 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37049 of Exim.
37050
37051 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37052 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37053 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37054 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37055 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37056 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37057 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37058 suite that was used.
37059
37060 .cindex log protocol
37061 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37062 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37063 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37064 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37065 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37066 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37067 authenticator name.
37068
37069 .cindex "size" "of message"
37070 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37071 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37072 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37073 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37074 other).
37075
37076 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37077 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37078
37079
37080
37081 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37082 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37083 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37084 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37085 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37086 to fit it on the page:
37087 .code
37088 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37089 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37090 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37091 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37092 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37093 .endd
37094 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37095 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37096 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37097 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37098 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37099
37100 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37101 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37102 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37103 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37104
37105 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37106 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37107 .display
37108 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37109 .endd
37110 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37111 parentheses afterwards.
37112
37113 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37114 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37115 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37116 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37117 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37118 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37119 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37120 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37121 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37122 TLS cipher information is still available.
37123
37124 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37125 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37126 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37127 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37128 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37129
37130 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37131 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37132
37133 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37134 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37135
37136
37137 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37138 .cindex "discarded messages"
37139 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37140 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37141 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37142 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37143 .code
37144 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37145 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37146 .endd
37147 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37148 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37149 .code
37150 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37151 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37152 .endd
37153
37154
37155 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37156 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37157 .code
37158 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37159 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37160 .endd
37161 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37162 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37163 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37164 .code
37165 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37166 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37167 .endd
37168 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37169 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37170 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37171
37172
37173
37174 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37175 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37176 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37177 following form is logged:
37178 .code
37179 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37180 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37181 .endd
37182 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37183 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37184 .code
37185 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37186 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37187 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37188 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37189 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37190 .endd
37191 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37192 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37193 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37194 flagged with &`**`&.
37195
37196
37197
37198 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37199 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37200 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37201 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37202 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37203
37204
37205
37206 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37207 A line of the form
37208 .code
37209 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37210 .endd
37211 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37212 at the end of its processing.
37213
37214
37215
37216
37217 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37218 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37219 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37220 the following table:
37221 .display
37222 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37223 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37224 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37225 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37226 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37227 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37228 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37229 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37230 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37231 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37232 &`H `& host name and IP address
37233 &`I `& local interface used
37234 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37235 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37236 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37237 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37238 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37239 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37240 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37241 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37242 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37243 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37244 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37245 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37246 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37247 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37248 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37249 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37250 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37251 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37252 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37253 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37254 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37255 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37256 .endd
37257
37258
37259 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37260 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37261 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37262
37263 .ilist
37264 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37265 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37266 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37267 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37268 during the first delivery attempt.
37269 .next
37270 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37271 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37272 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37273 .next
37274 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37275 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37276 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37277 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37278 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37279 doing.
37280 .next
37281 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37282 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37283 message:
37284 .olist
37285 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37286 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37287 .next
37288 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37289 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37290 .next
37291 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37292 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37293 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37294 .code
37295 errors_to = <>
37296 .endd
37297 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37298 .endlist olist
37299 .next
37300 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37301 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37302 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37303 .endlist ilist
37304
37305
37306
37307
37308
37309 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37310 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37311 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37312 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37313 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37314 example:
37315 .code
37316 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37317 .endd
37318 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37319 selection marked by asterisks:
37320 .display
37321 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37322 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37323 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37324 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37325 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37326 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37327 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37328 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37329 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37330 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37331 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37332 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37333 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37334 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37335 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37336 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37337 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37338 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37339 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37340 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37341 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37342 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37343 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37344 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37345 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37346 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37347 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37348 &` pid `& Exim process id
37349 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37350 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37351 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37352 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37353 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37354 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37355 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37356 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37357 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37358 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37359 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37360 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37361 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37362 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37363 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37364 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37365 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37366 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37367 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37368 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37369 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37370 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37371 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37372 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37373 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37374
37375 &` all `& all of the above
37376 .endd
37377 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37378 section &<<SECID99>>&
37379
37380 More details on each of these items follows:
37381
37382 .ilist
37383 .cindex "8BITMIME"
37384 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37385 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37386 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37387 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37388 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37389 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37390 .next
37391 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37392 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37393 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37394 this log selector is set.
37395 .next
37396 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37397 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37398 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37399 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37400 such users cannot access the log).
37401 .next
37402 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37403 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37404 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37405 parentheses between them.
37406 .next
37407 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37408 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37409 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37410 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37411 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37412 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37413 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37414 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37415 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37416 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37417 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37418 between the caller and Exim.
37419 .next
37420 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37421 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37422 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37423 .next
37424 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37425 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37426 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37427 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37428 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37429 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37430 .next
37431 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37432 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37433 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37434 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37435 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37436 .next
37437 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37438 .cindex "size" "of message"
37439 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37440 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37441 .next
37442 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37443 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37444 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37445 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37446 .next
37447 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37448 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37449 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37450 .next
37451 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37452 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37453 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37454 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37455 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37456 .next
37457 .cindex log dnssec
37458 .cindex dnssec logging
37459 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37460 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37461 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37462 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37463 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37464 .next
37465 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37466 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37467 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37468 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37469 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37470 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37471 .next
37472 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37473 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37474 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37475 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37476 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37477 .next
37478 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37479 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37480 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37481 client's ident port times out.
37482 .next
37483 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37484 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37485 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37486 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37487 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37488 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37489 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37490 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37491 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37492 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37493 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37494 .next
37495 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37496 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37497 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37498 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37499 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37500 on a proxied connection
37501 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37502 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37503 .next
37504 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37505 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37506 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37507 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37508 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37509 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37510 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37511 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37512 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37513 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37514 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37515 .next
37516 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37517 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37518 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37519 .next
37520 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37521 .cindex millisecond logging
37522 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37523 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37524 appended to the seconds value.
37525 .next
37526 .new
37527 .cindex "log" "message id"
37528 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37529 .next
37530 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37531 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37532 (submission mode) without one.
37533 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37534 .wen
37535 .next
37536 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37537 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37538 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37539 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37540 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37541 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37542 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37543 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37544 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37545 .next
37546 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37547 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37548 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37549 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37550 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37551 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37552 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37553 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37554 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37555 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37556 .next
37557 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37558 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37559 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37560 immediately after the time and date.
37561 .next
37562 .cindex log pipelining
37563 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37564 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37565 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37566 The field is a single "L".
37567
37568 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37569 the field has a minus appended.
37570
37571 .new
37572 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37573 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37574 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37575 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37576 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37577 .wen
37578
37579 .next
37580 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37581 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37582 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37583 .next
37584 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37585 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37586 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37587 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37588 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37589 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37590 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37591 message has been successfully received.
37592 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37593 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37594 .next
37595 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37596 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37597 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37598 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37599 .next
37600 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37601 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37602 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37603 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37604 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37605 .next
37606 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37607 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37608 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37609 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37610 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37611 has taken place.
37612 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37613 in the list.
37614 .next
37615 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37616 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37617 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37618 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37619 .next
37620 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37621 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37622 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37623 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37624 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37625 .next
37626 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37627 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37628 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37629 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37630 attempt.
37631 .next
37632 .cindex "log" "return path"
37633 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37634 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37635 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37636 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37637 .next
37638 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37639 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37640 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37641 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37642 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37643 .next
37644 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37645 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37646 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37647 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37648 detail is lost.
37649 .next
37650 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37651 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37652 it is too big.
37653 .next
37654 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37655 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37656 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37657 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37658 it.
37659 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37660 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37661 .next
37662 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37663 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37664 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37665 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37666 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37667 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37668 response.
37669 .next
37670 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37671 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37672 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37673 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37674 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37675 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37676 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37677 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37678 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37679 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37680
37681 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37682 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37683 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37684 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37685 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37686 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37687 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37688 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37689 .next
37690 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37691 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37692 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37693 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37694 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37695 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37696 .next
37697 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37698 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37699 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37700 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37701 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37702 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37703 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37704 already have their own log lines.
37705
37706 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37707 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37708 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37709 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37710 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37711 the same logging options.
37712
37713 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37714 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37715 .code
37716 C=EHLO,QUIT
37717 .endd
37718 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37719 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37720 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37721 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37722 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37723 .next
37724 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37725 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37726 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37727 was accepted or used.
37728 .next
37729 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37730 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37731 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37732 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37733 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37734 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37735 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37736 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37737 .next
37738 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37739 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37740 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37741 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37742 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37743 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37744 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37745 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37746 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37747 .next
37748 .cindex "log" "subject"
37749 .cindex "subject, logging"
37750 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37751 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37752 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37753 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37754 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37755 .next
37756 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37757 .cindex log DANE
37758 .cindex DANE logging
37759 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37760 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37761 verified
37762 using a CA trust anchor,
37763 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37764 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37765 .next
37766 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37767 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37768 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37769 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37770 .next
37771 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37772 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37773 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37774 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37775 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37776 .next
37777 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37778 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37779 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37780 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37781 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37782 .next
37783 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37784 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37785 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37786 .endlist
37787
37788
37789 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37790 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37791 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37792 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37793 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37794 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37795 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37796 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37797 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37798 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37799 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37800 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37801 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37802
37803 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37804 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37805 &%message_logs%& option false.
37806 .ecindex IIDloggen
37807
37808
37809
37810
37811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37813
37814 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37815 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37816 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37817 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37818 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37819
37820 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37821 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37822 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37823 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37824 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37825 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37826 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37827 various criteria"
37828 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37829 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37830 "extract statistics from the log"
37831 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37832 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37833 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37834 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37835 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37836 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37837 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37838 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37839 .endtable
37840
37841 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37842 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37843 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37844
37845
37846
37847
37848 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37849 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37850 .cindex "process, querying"
37851 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
37852 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37853 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37854 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37855 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37856 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37857 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37858 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37859 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37860
37861 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37862 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37863 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37864
37865
37866 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37867 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37868 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37869 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37870 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37871 options:
37872 .display
37873 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37874 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37875 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37876 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37877 .endd
37878 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37879 .code
37880 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37881 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37882 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37883 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37884 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37885 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37886 .endd
37887 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37888 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37889
37890
37891
37892 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37893 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37894 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37895 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37896 .code
37897 exim -bpu
37898 .endd
37899 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37900 .code
37901 exim -bp
37902 .endd
37903 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37904 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37905
37906 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37907 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37908
37909 .vlist
37910 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37911 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37912 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37913 .code
37914 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37915 .endd
37916 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37917 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37918 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37919
37920 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37921 Match against the size field.
37922
37923 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37924 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37925
37926 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37927 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37928
37929 .vitem &*-z*&
37930 Match only frozen messages.
37931
37932 .vitem &*-x*&
37933 Match only non-frozen messages.
37934
37935 .new
37936 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
37937 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
37938 .wen
37939 .endlist
37940
37941 The following options control the format of the output:
37942
37943 .vlist
37944 .vitem &*-c*&
37945 Display only the count of matching messages.
37946
37947 .vitem &*-l*&
37948 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37949 the default.
37950
37951 .vitem &*-i*&
37952 Display message ids only.
37953
37954 .vitem &*-b*&
37955 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37956
37957 .vitem &*-R*&
37958 Display messages in reverse order.
37959
37960 .vitem &*-a*&
37961 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37962 .endlist
37963
37964 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37965
37966
37967
37968 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37969 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37970 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37971 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37972 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37973 running a command such as
37974 .code
37975 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37976 .endd
37977 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37978 it, as in the following example:
37979 .code
37980 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37981 .endd
37982 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37983 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37984 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37985 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37986
37987 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37988 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37989 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37990 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37991 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37992 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37993 sender.
37994
37995 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37996 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37997 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37998 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37999 level"& addresses).
38000
38001
38002
38003
38004 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38005 "SECTextspeinf"
38006 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38007 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38008 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38009 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38010 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38011 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38012 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38013 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38014 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38015 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38016 .display
38017 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38018 .endd
38019 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38020
38021 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38022 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38023 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38024
38025 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38026 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38027 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38028 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38029 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38030
38031 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38032 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38033 regular expression.
38034
38035 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38036 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38037
38038 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38039 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38040 normally.
38041
38042 Example of &%-M%&:
38043 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38044 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38045 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38046 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38047 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38048 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38049 search term.
38050
38051 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38052 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38053 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38054 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38055 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38056
38057
38058 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38059 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38060 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38061 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38062 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38063 the &%--help%& option.
38064
38065
38066 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38067 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38068 .cindex "cycling logs"
38069 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38070 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38071 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38072 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38073 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38074 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38075 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38076 .ilist
38077 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38078 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38079 .next
38080 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38081 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38082 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38083 configuration.
38084 .endlist
38085
38086 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38087 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38088 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38089 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38090 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38091 logs are handled similarly.
38092
38093 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38094 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38095 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38096 any existing log files.
38097
38098 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38099 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38100 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38101 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38102 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38103 .code
38104 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38105 .endd
38106 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38107 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38108
38109
38110
38111 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38112 .cindex "statistics"
38113 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38114 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38115 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38116 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38117 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38118
38119 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38120 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38121 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38122 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38123 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38124 .code
38125 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38126 .endd
38127 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38128 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38129 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38130 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38131 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38132 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38133 also produced per user.
38134
38135 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38136 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38137 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38138 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38139 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38140
38141 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38142 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38143 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38144 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38145 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38146 an entirely separate message.
38147
38148 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38149 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38150 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38151 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38152 least one address that failed.
38153
38154 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38155 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38156 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38157 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38158 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38159 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38160 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38161
38162 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38163 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38164 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38165
38166 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38167 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38168 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38169 .code
38170 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38171 .endd
38172
38173 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38174 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38175 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38176 .cindex "checking access"
38177 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38178 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38179 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38180 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38181 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38182 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38183
38184 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38185 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38186 .code
38187 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38188 .endd
38189 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38190 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38191 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38192 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38193 .code
38194 Rejected:
38195 550 Relay not permitted
38196 .endd
38197 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38198 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38199 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38200 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38201 you can use:
38202 .code
38203 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38204 -f himself@there.example
38205 .endd
38206 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38207 mandatory arguments.
38208
38209 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38210 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38211 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38212
38213
38214
38215 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38216 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38217 .cindex "building DBM files"
38218 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38219 .cindex "lower casing"
38220 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38221 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38222 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38223 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38224 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38225 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38226
38227 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38228 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38229 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38230 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38231 files.
38232
38233 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38234 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38235 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38236 well.
38237
38238 .cindex "USE_DB"
38239 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38240 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38241 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38242 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38243 .code
38244 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38245 .endd
38246 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38247 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38248
38249 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38250 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38251 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38252 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38253 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38254 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38255
38256 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38257 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38258 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38259 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38260 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38261 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38262 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38263 return code is 2.
38264
38265
38266
38267
38268 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38269 .cindex "retry" "times"
38270 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38271 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38272 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38273 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38274 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38275 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38276 output. For example:
38277 .code
38278 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38279 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38280 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38281 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38282 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38283 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38284 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38285 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38286 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38287 past final cutoff time
38288 .endd
38289 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38290 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38291 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38292 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38293 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38294 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38295 run very often.
38296
38297 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38298 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38299 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38300 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38301 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38302 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38303
38304
38305
38306 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38307 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38308 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38309 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38310 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38311 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38312 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38313
38314 .ilist
38315 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38316 .next
38317 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38318 for remote hosts
38319 .next
38320 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38321 .next
38322 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38323 .next
38324 &'misc'&: other hints data
38325 .endlist
38326
38327 The &'misc'& database is used for
38328
38329 .ilist
38330 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38331 .next
38332 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38333 &(smtp)& transport)
38334 .next
38335 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38336 in a transport)
38337 .endlist
38338
38339
38340
38341 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38342 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38343 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38344 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38345 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38346 .code
38347 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38348 .endd
38349 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38350 .code
38351 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38352 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38353 .endd
38354 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38355 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38356 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38357 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38358 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38359 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38360 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38361 and a textual description of the error.
38362
38363 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38364 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38365 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38366 exceeded.
38367
38368 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38369 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38370 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38371 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38372 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38373 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38374 cross-references.
38375
38376
38377
38378 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38379 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38380 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38381 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38382 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38383 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38384 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38385 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38386 updated sufficiently often.
38387
38388 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38389 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38390 the retry database:
38391 .code
38392 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38393 .endd
38394 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38395 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38396 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38397 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38398 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38399 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38400 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38401 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38402 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38403 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38404 whenever it removes information from the database.
38405
38406 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38407 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38408 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38409 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38410 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38411
38412 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38413 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38414 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38415 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38416 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38417 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38418 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38419 tidied.
38420
38421 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38422 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38423
38424
38425
38426
38427 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38428 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38429 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38430 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38431 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38432 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38433 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38434 displayed.
38435
38436 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38437 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38438 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38439 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38440 by new data, for example:
38441 .code
38442 > 4 951102:1000
38443 .endd
38444 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38445 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38446 used as optional separators.
38447
38448
38449
38450
38451 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38452 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38453 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38454 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38455 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38456 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38457 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38458 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38459 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38460 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38461 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38462 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38463 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38464
38465 .vlist
38466 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
38467 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38468
38469 .vitem &%-flock%&
38470 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38471 supports it.
38472
38473 .vitem &%-interval%&
38474 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38475 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38476
38477 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38478 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38479
38480 .vitem &%-mbx%&
38481 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38482
38483 .vitem &%-q%&
38484 Suppress verification output.
38485
38486 .vitem &%-retries%&
38487 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38488 the lock (default 10).
38489
38490 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38491 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38492 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38493 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38494 subsequently sees.
38495
38496 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38497 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38498 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38499 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38500
38501 .vitem &%-v%&
38502 Generate verbose output.
38503 .endlist
38504
38505 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38506 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38507 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38508 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38509 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38510 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38511 more than 30 minutes old.
38512
38513 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38514 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38515 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38516 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38517 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38518 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38519
38520 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38521 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38522 suppresses all output except error messages.
38523
38524 A command such as
38525 .code
38526 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38527 .endd
38528 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38529 .display
38530 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38531 <&'some commands'&>
38532 &`End`&
38533 .endd
38534 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38535 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38536 such as
38537 .code
38538 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38539 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38540 .endd
38541 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38542 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38543 .ecindex IIDutils
38544
38545
38546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38548
38549 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38550 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38551 .cindex "X-windows"
38552 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38553 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38554 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38555 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38556 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38557 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38558 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38559 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38560
38561
38562
38563 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38564 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38565 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38566 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38567 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38568 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38569 parameters are for.
38570
38571 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38572 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38573 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38574 .code
38575 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38576 .endd
38577 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38578 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38579 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38580 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38581 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38582
38583 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38584 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38585 .code
38586 Eximon*background: gray94
38587 .endd
38588 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38589 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38590 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38591 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38592 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38593 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38594 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38595 .code
38596 xrdb -merge <<End
38597 Eximon*highlight: gray
38598 End
38599 .endd
38600 .cindex "admin user"
38601 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38602 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38603
38604 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38605 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38606 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38607 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38608 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38609
38610 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38611 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38612 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38613 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38614 different parts of the display.
38615
38616
38617
38618
38619 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38620 .cindex "stripchart"
38621 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38622 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38623 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38624 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38625 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38626 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38627 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38628 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38629 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38630
38631 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38632 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38633 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38634 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38635
38636 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38637 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38638 to a single partition.
38639
38640 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38641 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38642 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38643 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38644 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38645 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38646 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38647
38648
38649
38650
38651 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38652 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38653 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38654 .cindex "window size"
38655 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38656 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38657 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38658 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38659 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38660 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38661
38662 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38663 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38664 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38665 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38666
38667 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38668 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38669 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38670 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38671 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38672 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38673
38674 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38675 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38676 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38677
38678
38679
38680 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38681 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38682 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38683 the main log is maintained.
38684 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38685 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38686 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38687 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38688 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38689
38690 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38691 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38692 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38693 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38694 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38695 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38696 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38697 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38698 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38699 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38700 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38701
38702 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38703 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38704 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38705 It cannot go further back up the log.
38706
38707 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38708 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38709 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38710 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38711 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38712 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38713
38714 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38715 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38716 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38717 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38718 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38719 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38720
38721 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38722 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38723 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38724 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38725 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38726 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38727 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38728 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38729 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38730 window.
38731
38732
38733
38734 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38735 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38736 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38737 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38738 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38739 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38740 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38741 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38742 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38743 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38744
38745 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38746 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38747 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38748 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38749 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38750 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38751 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38752
38753 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38754 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38755 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38756 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38757 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38758 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38759 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38760
38761 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38762 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38763 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38764 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38765
38766 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38767 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38768 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38769 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38770 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38771 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38772 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38773 not shown.
38774
38775 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38776 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38777
38778 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38779 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38780 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38781 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38782 display is updated.
38783
38784
38785
38786 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38787 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38788 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38789 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38790 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38791 any selected text.
38792
38793 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38794 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38795 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38796 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38797 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38798 .code
38799 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38800 .endd
38801 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38802 follows:
38803
38804 .ilist
38805 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38806 in a new text window.
38807 .next
38808 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38809 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38810 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38811 .next
38812 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38813 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38814 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38815 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38816 .next
38817 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38818 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38819 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38820 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38821 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38822 .next
38823 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38824 that the message be frozen.
38825 .next
38826 .cindex "thawing messages"
38827 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38828 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38829 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38830 that the message be thawed.
38831 .next
38832 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38833 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38834 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38835 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38836 .next
38837 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38838 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38839 message.
38840 .next
38841 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38842 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38843 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38844 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38845 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38846 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38847 which case no action is taken.
38848 .next
38849 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38850 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38851 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38852 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38853 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38854 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38855 case no action is taken.
38856 .next
38857 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38858 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38859 .next
38860 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38861 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38862 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38863 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38864 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38865 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38866 the address is qualified with that domain.
38867 .endlist
38868
38869 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38870 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38871 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38872 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38873 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38874 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38875 if no output is generated.
38876
38877 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38878 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38879 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38880 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38881
38882 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38883 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38884 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38885 .ecindex IIDeximon
38886
38887
38888
38889
38890
38891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38893
38894 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38895 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38896 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38897 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38898
38899 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38900 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38901 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38902 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38903 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38904 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38905
38906 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38907 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38908 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38909 as soon as possible.
38910
38911
38912 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38913 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38914 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38915 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38916 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38917 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38918
38919 .ilist
38920 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38921 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38922 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38923 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38924 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38925 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38926
38927 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38928 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38929 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38930 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38931 .next
38932
38933 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38934 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38935 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38936 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38937 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38938 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38939 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38940 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38941 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38942 separate commands.
38943
38944 .next
38945 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38946 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38947 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38948 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38949 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38950 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38951 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38952 .next
38953 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38954 is disabled.
38955 .next
38956 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38957 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38958 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38959 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38960 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38961 .endlist
38962
38963
38964
38965 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38966 .cindex "setuid"
38967 .cindex "root privilege"
38968 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38969 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38970 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38971 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38972 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38973 is required for two things:
38974
38975 .ilist
38976 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38977 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38978 not required.
38979 .next
38980 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38981 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38982 configuration.
38983 .endlist
38984
38985 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38986 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38987 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38988 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38989 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38990 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38991 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38992 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38993
38994 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38995 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38996 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38997
38998 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38999 uid and gid in the following cases:
39000
39001 .ilist
39002 .oindex "&%-C%&"
39003 .oindex "&%-D%&"
39004 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39005 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39006 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39007 the calling process.
39008 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39009 option may not be used at all.
39010 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39011 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39012 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39013 .next
39014 .oindex "&%-be%&"
39015 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
39016 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
39017 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39018 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39019 calling process.
39020 .next
39021 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39022 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39023 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39024 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39025 testing address verification
39026 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
39027 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
39028 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39029 option).
39030 .next
39031 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39032 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39033 .endlist
39034
39035 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39036
39037 .ilist
39038 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39039 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39040 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39041 will be used during message reception.
39042 .next
39043 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39044 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39045 .next
39046 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39047 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39048 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39049 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39050 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39051 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39052 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39053 generating bounce and warning messages.
39054
39055 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39056 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39057 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39058 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39059 .next
39060 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39061 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39062 .endlist
39063
39064
39065
39066
39067 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39068 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39069 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39070 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39071 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39072 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39073 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39074 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39075 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39076 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39077 to any other uid.
39078
39079 .cindex SIGHUP
39080 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39081 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39082 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39083 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39084
39085 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39086 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39087 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39088 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39089 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39090
39091 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39092 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39093 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39094 effect.
39095
39096 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39097 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39098 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39099
39100 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39101 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39102 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39103 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39104 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39105 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39106 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39107 address this problem at this time.
39108
39109 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39110 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39111 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39112 be used in the most straightforward way.
39113
39114 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39115 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39116
39117 .ilist
39118 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39119 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39120 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39121 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39122 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39123 .next
39124 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39125 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39126 .next
39127 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39128 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39129 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39130 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39131 .next
39132 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39133 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39134
39135 .olist
39136 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39137 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39138 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39139 .next
39140 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39141 owned by the Exim user.
39142 .next
39143 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39144 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39145 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39146 .endlist olist
39147 .endlist ilist
39148
39149
39150 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39151 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39152 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39153 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39154
39155 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39156 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39157
39158
39159
39160
39161 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39162 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39163 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39164
39165
39166
39167 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39168 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39169 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39170 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39171 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39172 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39173 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39174
39175 .ilist
39176 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39177 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39178 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39179 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39180 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39181 .next
39182 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39183 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39184 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39185 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39186 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39187 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39188 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39189 .next
39190 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39191 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39192 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39193 .next
39194 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39195 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39196 .next
39197 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39198 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39199 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39200 .next
39201 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39202 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39203 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39204 of opaque strings.
39205 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39206 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39207 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39208 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39209 .endlist
39210
39211
39212
39213
39214 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39215 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39216 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39217 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39218 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39219 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39220 are some issues to be aware of:
39221
39222 .ilist
39223 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39224 .next
39225 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39226 .next
39227 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39228 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39229 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39230 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39231 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39232 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39233 data.
39234 .next
39235 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39236 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39237 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39238 .next
39239 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39240 expected to yield one result.
39241 .endlist
39242
39243
39244
39245
39246 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39247 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39248 .cindex "IP source routing"
39249 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39250 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39251 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39252 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39253
39254
39255
39256 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39257 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39258 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39259
39260
39261
39262
39263 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39264 .cindex "trusted users"
39265 .cindex "admin user"
39266 .cindex "privileged user"
39267 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39268 .cindex "user" "admin"
39269 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39270 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39271 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39272 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39273 permit a remote host to be specified.
39274
39275 .oindex "&%-f%&"
39276 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39277 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39278 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39279 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39280 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39281 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39282
39283 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39284 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39285 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39286 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39287 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39288
39289 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39290 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39291 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39292 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39293 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39294
39295 .oindex "&%-M%&"
39296 .oindex "&%-q%&"
39297 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39298 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39299 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39300 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39301 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39302 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39303
39304 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39305 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39306 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39307 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39308 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39309 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39310 files.
39311
39312 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39313 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39314 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39315 This affects most of the checking options,
39316 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39317
39318
39319 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39320 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39321 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39322 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39323 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39324 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39325
39326
39327
39328 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39329 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39330 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39331 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39332 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39333 this.
39334
39335
39336
39337 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39338 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39339 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39340 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39341 converted output.
39342
39343
39344
39345 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39346 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39347 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39348 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39349 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39350
39351
39352
39353 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39354 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39355 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39356 loading it.
39357
39358
39359 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39360 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39361 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39362 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39363 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39364 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39365 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39366
39367 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39368 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39369 string.
39370
39371
39372
39373 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39374 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39375 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39376 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39377
39378
39379
39380 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39381 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39382 enough to hold the result.
39383 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39384
39385
39386
39387
39388 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39390
39391 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39392 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39393 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39394 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39395 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39396 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39397 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39398 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39399 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39400 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39401 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39402 themselves are recoverable.
39403
39404 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39405 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39406 and should not be used as such.
39407
39408 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39409 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39410 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39411
39412 .ilist
39413 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39414 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39415 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39416 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39417 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39418 .next
39419 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39420 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39421 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39422 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39423 .next
39424 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39425 .next
39426 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39427 signature.
39428 .endlist
39429 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39430
39431 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39432 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39433 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39434 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39435 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39436 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39437 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39438 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39439 attempt.
39440
39441 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39442 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39443 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39444 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39445
39446 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39447 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39448 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39449 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39450 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39451 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39452 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39453 normally the Exim user.
39454
39455 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39456 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39457 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39458 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39459 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39460 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39461 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39462 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39463
39464 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39465 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39466 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39467 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39468
39469 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39470 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39471
39472 .vlist
39473 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39474 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39475 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39476 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39477 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39478 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39479 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39480 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39481 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39482 newlines.
39483
39484 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39485 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39486 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39487 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39488 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39489 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39490
39491 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39492 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39493 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39494 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39495 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39496 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39497
39498 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39499 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39500 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39501
39502 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39503 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39504 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39505 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39506 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39507
39508 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39509 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39510 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39511 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39512 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39513
39514 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39515 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39516 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39517
39518 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39519 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39520 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39521
39522 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39523 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39524 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39525
39526 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39527 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39528 present if the number is greater than zero.
39529
39530 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39531 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39532 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39533
39534 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39535 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39536 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39537
39538 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39539 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39540 command.
39541
39542 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39543 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39544 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39545 messages.
39546
39547 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39548 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39549 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39550 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39551
39552 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39553 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39554 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39555
39556 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39557 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39558 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39559 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39560 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39561 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39562
39563 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39564 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39565 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39566 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39567 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39568
39569 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39570 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39571 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39572 generated messages.
39573
39574 .vitem &%-local%&
39575 The message is from a local sender.
39576
39577 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39578 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39579
39580 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39581 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39582 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39583 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39584
39585 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39586 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39587 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39588
39589 .vitem &%-N%&
39590 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39591 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39592 &%-N%& is assumed.
39593
39594 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39595 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39596 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39597
39598 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39599 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39600 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39601
39602 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39603 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39604 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39605
39606 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39607 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39608 rather than Unix-format.
39609 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39610 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39611
39612 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39613 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39614 certificate was verified by the server.
39615
39616 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39617 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39618 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39619
39620 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39621 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39622 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39623 certificate.
39624 .endlist
39625
39626 .new
39627 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39628 corresponding data is untrusted.
39629 .wen
39630
39631 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39632 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39633 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39634 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39635 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39636 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39637 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39638 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39639 addresses are complete.
39640
39641 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39642 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39643 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39644 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39645 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39646 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39647 .code
39648 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39649 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39650 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39651 .endd
39652 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39653 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39654 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39655 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39656 example:
39657 .code
39658 4
39659 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39660 darcy@austen.fict.example
39661 rdo@foundation
39662 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39663 .endd
39664 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39665 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39666 line is of the following form:
39667 .display
39668 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39669 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39670 .endd
39671 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39672 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39673 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39674 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39675 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39676 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39677 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39678 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39679
39680
39681 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39682 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39683 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39684 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39685 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39686 following:
39687
39688 .table2 50pt
39689 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39690 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39691 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39692 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39693 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39694 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39695 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39696 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39697 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39698 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39699 .endtable
39700
39701 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39702 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39703 typical set of headers:
39704 .code
39705 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39706 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39707 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39708 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39709 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39710 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39711 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39712 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39713 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39714 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39715 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39716 .endd
39717 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39718 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39719 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39720 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39721 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39722 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39723
39724 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39725 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39726 an ASCII newline character.
39727 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39728 can have an alternate format.
39729 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39730 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39731 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39732 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39733 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39734 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39735
39736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39738
39739 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39740 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39741 .cindex "DKIM"
39742
39743 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39744
39745 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39746 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39747 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39748 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39749
39750 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39751 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39752 any original DKIM signature.
39753
39754 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39755 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39756
39757 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39758 .olist
39759 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39760 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39761 (including transport filters)
39762 except cutthrough delivery.
39763 .next
39764 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39765 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39766 different signature contexts.
39767 .endlist
39768
39769 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39770 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39771 Exim's standard controls.
39772
39773 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39774 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39775
39776 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39777 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39778 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39779 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39780 .code
39781 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39782 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39783 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39784 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39785 .endd
39786
39787 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39788 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39789 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39790 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39791 senders).
39792
39793
39794 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39795 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39796
39797 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39798 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39799 .code
39800 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39801
39802 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39803 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39804 .endd
39805
39806 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39807 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39808 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39809 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39810 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39811
39812 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39813 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39814
39815 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39816 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39817 After expansion, this can be a list.
39818 Each element in turn,
39819 .new
39820 lowercased,
39821 .wen
39822 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39823 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39824 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39825 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39826
39827 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39828 This sets the key selector string.
39829 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39830 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39831 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39832 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39833 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39834 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39835
39836 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39837 This sets the private key to use.
39838 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39839 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39840 The result can either
39841 .ilist
39842 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39843 .next
39844 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39845 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39846 .next
39847 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39848 the private key
39849 .next
39850 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39851 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39852 is set.
39853 .endlist
39854
39855 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39856 .code
39857 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39858 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39859 .endd
39860 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39861 for the DNS TXT record.
39862 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39863
39864 Under GnuTLS:
39865 .code
39866 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39867 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39868 .endd
39869
39870 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39871 .code
39872 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39873 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39874 .endd
39875
39876 .new
39877 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39878 .wen
39879 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39880 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39881 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39882 for some transition period.
39883 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39884 for EC keys.
39885
39886 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39887 .code
39888 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39889 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39890 .endd
39891
39892 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39893 .code
39894 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39895 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39896 .endd
39897
39898 .new
39899 Exim also supports an alternate format
39900 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39901 of the standard, but not adopted.
39902 A future release will probably drop that support.
39903 .wen
39904
39905 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39906 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39907 .ilist
39908 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39909 .next
39910 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39911 .next
39912 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39913 .endlist
39914
39915 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39916 .code
39917 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39918 .endd
39919
39920 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39921 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39922 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39923 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39924 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39925 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39926
39927 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39928 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39929 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39930 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39931 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39932
39933 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39934 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39935 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39936 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39937 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39938 variables here.
39939
39940 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39941 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39942 list of header names.
39943 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39944 in the message signature.
39945 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39946 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39947 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39948 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39949
39950 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39951 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39952 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39953
39954 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39955 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39956 will be signed.
39957 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39958 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39959 name will be appended.
39960
39961 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39962 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39963 If not set, no such information will be included.
39964 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39965 for the expiry tag
39966 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39967 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39968
39969 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39970
39971
39972 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39973 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39974
39975 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39976 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39977 .new
39978 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
39979 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
39980 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
39981 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
39982 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
39983 .wen
39984
39985 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39986 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39987 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39988
39989 .new
39990 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
39991 of this section can be ignored.
39992 .wen
39993
39994 The results of verification are made available to the
39995 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39996 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39997 By default, the ACL is called once for each
39998 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39999 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40000 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40001 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40002
40003 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40004 a large number of expansion variables
40005 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40006 runtime of the ACL.
40007
40008 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40009 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40010 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40011 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40012
40013 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40014 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40015 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40016 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40017 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40018 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40019 it defaults as:
40020 .code
40021 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40022 .endd
40023 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40024 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40025 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40026 .code
40027 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40028 .endd
40029 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40030 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40031 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40032 .code
40033 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40034 .endd
40035
40036 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40037 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40038
40039 .new
40040 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40041 (such as the From: header)
40042 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40043 and for the domain part if identities.
40044 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40045 .wen
40046
40047 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40048 for each matching signature.
40049
40050
40051 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40052 available (from most to least important):
40053
40054
40055 .vlist
40056 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40057 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40058 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40059 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40060
40061 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40062 Within the DKIM ACL,
40063 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40064 .ilist
40065 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40066 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40067 .next
40068 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40069 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40070 .next
40071 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40072 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40073 .next
40074 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40075 .endlist
40076
40077 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40078 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40079 hash-method or key-size:
40080 .code
40081 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40082 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40083 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40084 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40085 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40086 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40087 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40088 .endd
40089
40090 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40091 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40092 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40093 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40094
40095 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40096 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40097 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40098 .ilist
40099 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40100 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40101 .next
40102 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40103 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40104 .next
40105 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40106 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40107 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40108 .next
40109 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40110 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40111 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40112 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40113 .endlist
40114
40115 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40116
40117 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40118 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40119 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40120 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40121
40122 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40123 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40124 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40125 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40126
40127 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40128 The key record selector string.
40129
40130 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40131 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40132 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40133 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40134 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40135 for EC keys.
40136
40137 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40138 .code
40139 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40140
40141 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40142 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40143 .endd
40144
40145 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40146 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40147 .new
40148 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40149 processing of such signatures.
40150 .wen
40151
40152 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40153 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40154
40155 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40156 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40157
40158 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40159 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40160 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40161 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40162 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40163 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40164
40165 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40166 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40167 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40168 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40169 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40170 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40171 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40172 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40173
40174 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40175 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40176 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40177
40178 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40179 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40180 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40181 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40182 integer size comparisons against this value.
40183 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40184
40185 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40186 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40187
40188 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40189 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40190
40191 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40192 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40193
40194 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40195 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40196 in the key record.
40197
40198 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40199 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40200 in the key record.
40201
40202 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40203 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40204
40205 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40206 Number of bits in the key.
40207
40208 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40209 .code
40210 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40211 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40212 .endd
40213
40214 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40215 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40216 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40217
40218 .endlist
40219
40220 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40221
40222 .vlist
40223 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40224 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40225 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40226 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40227 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40228
40229 .code
40230 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40231 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40232 sender_domains = gmail.com
40233 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40234 dkim_status = none
40235 .endd
40236
40237 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40238 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40239
40240 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40241 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40242 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40243 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40244
40245 .code
40246 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40247 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40248 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40249 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40250 .endd
40251
40252 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40253 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40254 for more information of what they mean.
40255 .endlist
40256
40257
40258
40259
40260 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40261 .cindex SPF verification
40262
40263 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40264 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40265 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40266 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40267
40268 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40269 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40270
40271 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40272 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40273 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40274 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40275 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40276
40277 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40278 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40279 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40280 &$authresults$& expansion item.
40281
40282
40283 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40284 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40285 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40286 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40287 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40288 Valid strings are:
40289 .vlist
40290 .vitem &%pass%&
40291 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40292
40293 .vitem &%fail%&
40294 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40295 domain in the envelope-from address.
40296
40297 .vitem &%softfail%&
40298 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40299 is a forgery.
40300
40301 .vitem &%none%&
40302 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40303
40304 .vitem &%neutral%&
40305 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40306 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40307 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40308
40309 .vitem &%permerror%&
40310 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40311 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40312
40313 .vitem &%temperror%&
40314 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40315 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40316 .endlist
40317
40318 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40319 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40320 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40321 short-circuit fashion.
40322
40323 Example:
40324 .code
40325 deny spf = fail
40326 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40327 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40328 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40329 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40330 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40331 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40332 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40333 ip=$sender_host_address
40334 .endd
40335
40336 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40337 variables:
40338
40339 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40340 .vlist
40341 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40342 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40343 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40344 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40345 it for logging purposes.
40346
40347 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40348 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40349 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40350 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40351 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40352 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40353
40354 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40355 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40356
40357 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40358 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40359 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40360 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40361 temperror.
40362
40363 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40364 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40365 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40366 and required in order to obtain a result.
40367
40368 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40369 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40370 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40371 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40372 .endlist
40373
40374
40375 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40376 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40377 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40378 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40379 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40380 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40381 capability.
40382 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40383 for a description of what it means.
40384 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40385
40386 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40387 of the spf one. For example:
40388
40389 .code
40390 deny spf_guess = fail
40391 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40392 .endd
40393
40394 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40395 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40396 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40397 reject message.
40398
40399 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40400 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40401
40402 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40403 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40404 &%spf_guess%& option.
40405 For example, the following:
40406
40407 .code
40408 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40409 .endd
40410
40411 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40412
40413
40414 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40415 .cindex lookup spf
40416 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40417 address as the key and an IP address
40418 .new
40419 (v4 or v6)
40420 .wen
40421 as the database:
40422
40423 .code
40424 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40425 .endd
40426
40427 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40428 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40429
40430
40431
40432
40433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40435
40436 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40437 "Proxy support"
40438 .cindex "proxy support"
40439 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40440
40441 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40442 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40443
40444
40445 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40446 .cindex proxy inbound
40447 .cindex proxy "server side"
40448 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40449 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40450
40451 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40452 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40453 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40454 in Local/Makefile.
40455
40456 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40457 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40458
40459 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40460 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40461 to distribute load.
40462 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40463 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40464 There is no logging if a host passes or
40465 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40466 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40467
40468 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40469 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40470 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40471 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40472 automatically determines which version is in use.
40473
40474 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40475 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40476 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40477 Exim and the proxy server.
40478
40479 The following expansion variables are usable
40480 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40481 of the proxy):
40482 .display
40483 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40484 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40485 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40486 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40487 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40488 .endd
40489 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40490 there was a protocol error.
40491 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40492 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40493
40494 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40495 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40496 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40497 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40498 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40499 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40500 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40501 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40502 A possible solution is:
40503 .display
40504 # Set max number of connections per host
40505 LIMIT = 5
40506 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40507 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40508
40509 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40510 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40511 .endd
40512
40513
40514
40515 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40516 .cindex proxy outbound
40517 .cindex proxy "client side"
40518 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40519 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40520 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40521 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40522 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40523 Local/Makefile.
40524
40525 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40526 on an smtp transport.
40527 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40528 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40529 Each proxy specifier is a list
40530 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40531 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40532
40533 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40534 The list of options is in the following table:
40535 .display
40536 &'auth '& authentication method
40537 &'name '& authentication username
40538 &'pass '& authentication password
40539 &'port '& tcp port
40540 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40541 &'pri '& priority
40542 &'weight '& selection bias
40543 .endd
40544
40545 More details on each of these options follows:
40546
40547 .ilist
40548 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40549 .cindex proxy authentication
40550 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40551 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40552 for access to the proxy.
40553 Default is &"none"&.
40554 .next
40555 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40556 Default is empty.
40557 .next
40558 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40559 Default is empty.
40560 .next
40561 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40562 Default is 1080.
40563 .next
40564 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40565 Default is 5.
40566 .next
40567 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40568 higher values being tried first.
40569 The default priority is 1.
40570 .next
40571 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40572 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40573 weighted by this value.
40574 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40575 .endlist
40576
40577 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40578 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40579 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40580
40581 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40582 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40583 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40584 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40585
40586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40588
40589 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40590 "Internationalisation""
40591 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40592 .cindex EAI
40593 .cindex i18n
40594 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40595
40596 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40597 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40598 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40599
40600 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40601 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40602 requirement, upon libidn2.
40603
40604 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40605 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40606 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40607 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40608 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40609 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40610
40611 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40612 international handling for the message is enabled and
40613 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40614
40615 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40616 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40617 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40618 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40619
40620 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40621 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40622 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40623 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40624
40625 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40626 components expanded to a-label form,
40627 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40628 form of the name.
40629
40630 .cindex log protocol
40631 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40632 .cindex i18n logging
40633 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40634 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40635
40636 The following expansion operators can be used:
40637 .code
40638 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40639 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40640 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40641 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40642 .endd
40643
40644 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40645 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40646 The RCPT ACL
40647 may use the following modifier:
40648 .display
40649 control = utf8_downconvert
40650 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40651 .endd
40652 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40653 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40654 Message Submission Agent context.
40655 If a value is appended it may be:
40656 .display
40657 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40658 &`0 `& no downconversion
40659 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40660 .endd
40661
40662 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40663 is initially set to -1.
40664
40665 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40666 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40667 and it overrides any previously set value.
40668
40669
40670 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40671 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40672 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40673
40674 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40675 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40676 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40677
40678 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40679 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40680
40681
40682
40683 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40684 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40685 the following expansion operator can be used:
40686 .code
40687 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40688 .endd
40689
40690 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40691 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40692 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40693 to the
40694 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40695 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40696 (which has to be a single character)
40697 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40698 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40699
40700 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40701 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40702
40703 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40704 by many other IMAP servers.
40705
40706 Examples:
40707 .display
40708 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40709 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40710 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40711 .endd
40712
40713 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40714 must be representable in UTF-16.
40715
40716
40717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40719
40720 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40721 "Events"
40722 .cindex events
40723
40724 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40725 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40726 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40727 processing actions.
40728
40729 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40730 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40731 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40732
40733 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40734 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40735 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40736
40737 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40738 An example might look like:
40739 .cindex logging custom
40740 .code
40741 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40742 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40743 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40744 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40745 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40746 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40747 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40748 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40749 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40750 } {}}
40751 .endd
40752
40753 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40754 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40755 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40756
40757 The current list of events is:
40758 .display
40759 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40760 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40761 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40762 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40763 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40764 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40765 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40766 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40767 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40768 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40769 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40770 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40771 .endd
40772 New event types may be added in future.
40773
40774 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40775 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40776 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40777
40778 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40779 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40780 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40781
40782 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40783 should define the event action.
40784
40785 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40786 with the event type:
40787 .display
40788 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40789 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40790 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40791 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40792 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40793 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40794 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40795 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40796 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40797 .endd
40798
40799 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40800
40801 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40802 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40803 the course of its processing:
40804 .ilist
40805 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40806 transport call
40807 .next
40808 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40809 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40810 .endlist
40811 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40812 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40813
40814 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40815 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40816 following will be forced:
40817 .display
40818 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40819 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40820 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40821 .endd
40822 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40823 no other use is made of it.
40824
40825 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40826 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40827 the target system.
40828
40829 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40830 chain element received on the connection.
40831 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40832 loaded locally.
40833
40834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40836
40837 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40838 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40839 .cindex "adding drivers"
40840 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40841 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40842 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40843 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40844
40845 .olist
40846 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40847 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40848 .next
40849 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40850 .display
40851 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40852 .endd
40853 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40854 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40855 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40856 .next
40857 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40858 .code
40859 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40860 .endd
40861 .next
40862 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40863 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40864 .next
40865 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40866 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40867 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40868 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40869 simple form that most lookups have.
40870 .next
40871 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40872 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40873 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40874 .next
40875 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40876 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40877 .next
40878 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40879 &_src_&.
40880 .next
40881 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40882 as for other drivers and lookups.
40883 .endlist
40884
40885 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40886 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40887 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40888 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40889 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40890
40891 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40892 the interface that is expected.
40893
40894
40895
40896
40897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40899
40900 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40901 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40902 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40903 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40904 . processors.
40905 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40906
40907 .literal xml
40908 <?sdop
40909 format="newpage"
40910 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40911 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40912 ?>
40913 .literal off
40914
40915 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40916 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40917 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40918
40919
40920 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40921 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////